5 30259 33 Moves the cursor to the next marker (to the right). 5 30260 36 Moves the cursor to the previous marker (to the left). 5 30257 32 Moves the cursor to the next error (moving right). 5 30258 35 Moves the cursor to the previous error (moving left). 5 30266 32 Increases the display scale of the formula by 25%. 5 30267 2f Decreases the display scale of formulas by 25%. 5 30269 100 Displays the entire formula in the maximum size possible so that all elements are included. The formula is reduced or enlarged so that all formula elements can be displayed in the work area. Show All is equivalent to the Entire Formula icon on the toolbar. 5 30268 3a This command refreshes the formula in the document window. 5 30311 b3 Choose this command to automatically refresh a modified formula. If you do not select this option, the formula will only be refreshed after you choose View - Refresh and press F9. 5 30270 69 This is a list of operators, functions, symbols and format options that can be inserted into the formula. 5 63074 24 Inserts a plus with one placeholder. 5 63172 33 Inserts a concatenation sign with two placeholders. 5 63093 2b Inserts a Boolean OR with two placeholders. 5 63075 25 Inserts a minus with one placeholder. 5 63836 7f Type a wideslash b in the Commands window to produce two characters with a slash (from lower left to upper right) between them. 5 63084 2a Inserts a slash '/' with two placeholders. 5 63079 25 Inserts a plus with two placeholders. 5 63081 2d Inserts a dot operator with two placeholders. 5 63083 3e Inserts an asterisk multiplication sign with two placeholders. 5 63179 11d You can choose various unary and binary operators to build your $[officename] Math formula. Unary refers to operators that affect one placeholder. Binary refers to operators that connect two placeholders. The lower area of the Formula Elements window displays the individual operators. 5 63188 11d You can choose various unary and binary operators to build your $[officename] Math formula. Unary refers to operators that affect one placeholder. Binary refers to operators that connect two placeholders. The lower area of the Formula Elements window displays the individual operators. 5 63077 2a Inserts a minus/plus with one placeholder. 5 63076 2a Inserts a plus/minus with one placeholder. 5 63082 34 Inserts an 'x' multiplication with two placeholders. 5 63092 2c Inserts a Boolean AND with two placeholders. 5 63080 31 Inserts a subtraction sign with two placeholders. 5 63086 29 Inserts a fraction with two placeholders. 5 63078 2b Inserts a Boolean NOT with one placeholder. 5 63085 2e Inserts a division sign with two placeholders. 5 63837 80 Type a widebslash b in the Commands window to produce two characters with a slash (from upper left to lower right) between them. 5 63109 3b Inserts the proportional to relation with two placeholders. 5 63175 41 Inserts the logical relation arrow with double bar pointing left. 5 63189 ab You can choose among various relations to structure your $[officename] Math formula. The relation functions are displayed in the lower part of the Formula Elements window. 5 63098 41 Inserts the less than or equal to relation with two placeholders. 5 63180 ab You can choose among various relations to structure your $[officename] Math formula. The relation functions are displayed in the lower part of the Formula Elements window. 5 63094 30 Inserts an equal sign (=) with two placeholders. 5 63112 37 Inserts a toward relation symbol with two placeholders. 5 63176 5e Inserts the logical relation arrow with double bar pointing left and right with two operators. 5 63099 44 Inserts the greater than or equal to relation with two placeholders. 5 63095 44 The neq icon or command inserts an inequality with two placeholders. 5 63106 3f Inserts the approximately equal relation with two placeholders. 5 63111 32 Inserts a parallel relation with two placeholders. 5 63174 30 This icon inserts the does not divide character. 5 63107 40 This icon inserts the similar to relation with two placeholders. 5 63105 54 Inserts a character for the identical to (congruent) relation with two placeholders. 5 63108 3f Inserts the similar or equal to relation with two placeholders. 5 63173 1e Inserts the divides character. 5 63097 22 Inserts the greater than relation. 5 63177 58 Inserts the logical operator arrow with double bar pointing right with two placeholders. 5 63101 44 Inserts the greater than or equal to relation with two placeholders. 5 63110 54 Inserts a character for an orthogonal (right angled) relation with two placeholders. 5 63096 1f Inserts the less than relation. 5 63100 3f Inserts a less than or equal to relation with two placeholders. 5 63168 3a Inserts a triple curve integral sign with one placeholder. 5 63183 a5 You can choose among various operators to structure your $[officename] Math formula. All available operators appear in the lower part of the Formula Elements window. 5 63171 60 Inserts a range statement upper and lower limit for integral and summation with one placeholder. 5 63154 2e Inserts a summation sign with one placeholder. 5 63169 4d Inserts a lower limit range statement for integral and sum with placeholders. 5 63170 54 Inserts the range statement upper limit for integral and summation with placeholders 5 63167 3c Inserts a double curve integral symbol with one placeholder. 5 63165 34 Inserts a triple integral sign with one placeholder. 5 63164 36 Inserts a double integral symbol with one placeholder. 5 63156 30 Inserts a coproduct symbol with one placeholder. 5 63163 2e Inserts an integral sign with one placeholder. 5 63192 a5 You can choose among various operators to structure your $[officename] Math formula. All available operators appear in the lower part of the Formula Elements window. 5 63157 2c Inserts the limit sign with one placeholder. 5 63166 35 Inserts a curve integral symbol with one placeholder. 5 63155 2c Inserts a product sign with one placeholder. 5 63144 35 Inserts an arc tangent function with one placeholder. 5 63151 40 Inserts an area hyperbolic cosine function with one placeholder. 5 63143 32 Inserts an arc cosine symbol with one placeholder. 5 63142 32 Inserts an arc sine function with one placeholder. 5 63152 41 Inserts an area hyperbolic tangent function with one placeholder. 5 63148 39 Inserts a hyperbolic tangent symbol with one placeholder. 5 63133 33 Inserts an nth root function with two placeholders. 5 63138 2d Inserts a sine function with one placeholder. 5 63147 38 Inserts a hyperbolic cosine symbol with one placeholder. 5 63141 2e Inserts a cotangent symbol with a placeholder. 5 63153 43 Inserts an area hyperbolic cotangent function with one placeholder. 5 63139 2f Inserts a cosine function with one placeholder. 5 63130 34 Inserts an absolute value sign with one placeholder. 5 63182 32 Choose a function in the lower part of the window. 5 63136 3a Inserts a natural (base e) logarithm with one placeholder. 5 63191 32 Choose a function in the lower part of the window. 5 63135 35 Inserts an exponential function with one placeholder. 5 63132 32 Inserts a square root symbol with one placeholder. 5 63131 30 Inserts the factorial sign with one placeholder. 5 63145 37 Inserts an arc cotangent function with one placeholder. 5 63140 30 Inserts a tangent function with one placeholder. 5 63149 3b Inserts a hyperbolic cotangent symbol with one placeholder. 5 63150 3e Inserts an area hyperbolic sine function with one placeholder. 5 63137 3a Inserts a common (base 10) logarithm with one placeholder. 5 63146 2f Inserts a hyperbolic sine with one placeholder. 5 63134 27 Inserts a natural exponential function. 5 63185 a3 You can choose among various bracket types to structure a $[officename] Math formula. Bracket types are displayed in the lower part of the Formula Elements window. 5 63230 4f To insert ceiling brackets, type lceilrceil directly in the Commands window. 5 63841 3a Inserts scalable double square brackets with placeholders. 5 63240 39 Inserts scalable single vertical bars with a placeholder. 5 63226 41 Inserts a placeholder within normal round brackets (parentheses). 5 63228 36 Inserts a placeholder withing braces (curly brackets). 5 63237 33 Inserts scalable angle brackets with a placeholder. 5 63225 17 Inserts group brackets. 5 63238 63 To insert scalable ceiling brackets, type left lceilright rceil directly in the Commands window. 5 63241 39 Inserts scalable double vertical bars with a placeholder. 5 63232 2b Inserts a placeholder within vertical bars. 5 63233 32 Inserts a placeholder within double vertical bars. 5 63235 33 Inserts scalable square brackets with placeholders. 5 63194 a3 You can choose among various bracket types to structure a $[officename] Math formula. Bracket types are displayed in the lower part of the Formula Elements window. 5 63840 34 Inserts a placeholder within double square brackets. 5 63229 2c Inserts a placeholder within angle brackets. 5 63839 3c Inserts a scalable horizontal lower brace with placeholders. 5 63236 2b Inserts scalable braces with a placeholder. 5 63838 3c Inserts a scalable horizontal upper brace with placeholders. 5 63227 2d Inserts a placeholder within square brackets. 5 63834 2f Inserts a placeholder within operator brackets. 5 63234 37 Inserts scalable rounded brackets with one placeholder. 5 63239 63 To insert scalable floor brackets, type left lfloorright rfloor directly in the Commands window. 5 63231 4f To insert floor brackets, type lfloorrfloor directly in the Commands window. 5 63835 35 Inserts scalable operator brackets with placeholders. 5 63208 2c Inserts a placeholder with a circle over it. 5 63216 23 Inserts a line below a placeholder. 5 63799 28 Inserts a wide tilde with a placeholder. 5 63219 74 Inserts a placeholder for a transparent character. This character takes up the space of "a" but does not display it. 5 63215 2a Inserts a placeholder with a vector arrow. 5 63206 2b Inserts a placeholder with an accent breve. 5 63212 32 Inserts a placeholder with a grave accent (grave). 5 63221 2d Inserts a placeholder with italic formatting. 5 63204 2b Inserts a placeholder with an acute accent. 5 63222 aa Inserts a command for modifying the font size with two placeholders. The first placeholder refers to the font size (for example, 12) and the second one contains the text. 5 63798 35 Inserts a wide circumflex ("hat") with a placeholder. 5 63211 26 Inserts three dots over a placeholder. 5 63218 3d Inserts a placeholder with a line (or overstrike) through it. 5 63209 29 Inserts a placeholder with a dot over it. 5 63223 d0 Inserts a command for changing the font type, with two placeholders. Replace the first placeholder with the name of one of the custom fonts, Serif, Sans or Fixed. Replace the second placeholder with the text. 5 63193 a2 You can choose from various attributes for %PRODUCTNAME Math formulas. Some attributes are displayed in the lower part of the Formula Elements window. 5 63213 30 Inserts a placeholder with a circumflex ("hat"). 5 63205 2c Inserts a line ("bar") above a placeholder . 5 63220 2b Inserts a placeholder with bold formatting. 5 63214 23 Inserts a placeholder with a tilde. 5 63184 a2 You can choose from various attributes for %PRODUCTNAME Math formulas. Some attributes are displayed in the lower part of the Formula Elements window. 5 63800 2f Inserts a wide vector arrow with a placeholder. 5 63207 46 Inserts a placeholder with a reverse circumflex ("checkmark") over it. 5 63210 2c Inserts a placeholder with two dots over it. 5 63217 22 Inserts a line over a placeholder. 5 63250 31 Inserts a vertical stack with three placeholders. 5 63195 a4 You can choose among various options for formatting a $[officename] Math formula. The format options are displayed in the lower half of the Formula Elements window. 5 63245 33 Inserts a superscript to the left of a placeholder. 5 63247 36 This icon inserts a gap or space between placeholders. 5 63249 3a Inserts a vertical stack (binomial) with two placeholders. 5 63252 42 This icon assigns left-alignment to "a" and inserts a placeholder. 5 63186 a4 You can choose among various options for formatting a $[officename] Math formula. The format options are displayed in the lower half of the Formula Elements window. 5 63254 3a Inserts the command for right alignment and a placeholder. 5 63251 32 This icon inserts a matrix with four placeholders. 5 63801 31 Inserts a subscript directly under a placeholder. 5 63248 24 Inserts a new line in your document. 5 63242 32 Inserts a subscript to the right of a placeholder. 5 63802 33 Inserts a superscript directly above a placeholder. 5 63244 31 Inserts a subscript to the left of a placeholder. 5 63246 3f Inserts a small gap between a placeholder and the next element. 5 63243 34 Inserts a superscript to the right of a placeholder. 5 63253 46 Assigns horizontal central alignment to "a" and inserts a placeholder. 5 63256 25 Use this icon to insert an empty set. 5 63793 43 Use this icon to insert a character for the set of natural numbers. 5 63255 2a Use this icon to insert a cardinal number. 5 63123 57 Use this icon to insert the is a subset or equal to set operator with two placeholders. 5 63125 5a Use this icon to insert the set operator is a super set or equal to with two placeholders. 5 63795 44 Use this icon to insert a character for the set of rational numbers. 5 63116 52 Use this icon to insert the is not included in set operator with two placeholders. 5 63126 4a Use this icon to insert the not subset set operator with two placeholders. 5 63120 34 Use this icon to insert the difference set operator. 5 63119 55 Use this icon to insert two placeholders with the set operator intersection of sets . 5 63117 48 Use this icon to insert the set operator includes with two placeholders. 5 63129 55 Use this icon to insert the not superset or equal set operator with two placeholders. 5 63121 52 Use this icon to insert a slash for creating a quotient set with two placeholders. 5 63124 4f Use this icon to insert the set operator is a superset of and two placeholders. 5 63181 ab Assign different set operators to the characters in your $[officename] Math formula. The individual operators are shown in the lower section of the Formula Elements window 5 63122 38 Use this icon to insert the is a subset of set operator. 5 63127 53 Use this icon to insert the not subset or equal set operator with two placeholders. 5 63118 45 Use this icon to insert the union set operator with two placeholders. 5 63797 43 Use this icon to insert a character for the set of complex numbers. 5 63190 ab Assign different set operators to the characters in your $[officename] Math formula. The individual operators are shown in the lower section of the Formula Elements window 5 63796 40 Use this icon to insert a character for the set of real numbers. 5 63128 4c Use this icon to insert the not superset set operator with two placeholders. 5 63115 4d Use the icon to insert the is included in set operator with two placeholders. 5 63794 41 Use this icon to insert a character for the set of whole numbers. 5 63806 20 This icon inserts a right arrow. 5 63198 29 Shows miscellaneous mathematical symbols. 5 63264 6b This icon inserts a downward diagonal ellipsis (three dots on the diagonal from upper left to lower right). 5 63260 31 Inserts the symbol for a partial differentiation. 5 63266 3c This icon inserts a vertical ellipsis (three vertical dots). 5 63803 2a Inserts the symbol for the h-bar constant. 5 63807 1e This icon inserts an up arrow. 5 63259 20 Inserts the symbol for infinity. 5 63262 4f This icon inserts an axis-ellipsis (three vertically centered horizontal dots). 5 63178 29 Shows miscellaneous mathematical symbols. 5 63161 38 Inserts the symbol for a universal quantifier "for all". 5 63160 2c Inserts the symbol for an Existence quantor. 5 63265 3a This icon inserts an ellipsis (three low horizontal dots). 5 63804 24 Inserts the symbol for a lambda-bar. 5 63805 1f This icon inserts a left arrow. 5 63808 1f This icon inserts a down arrow. 5 63257 39 Inserts the symbol for the real part of a complex number. 5 63162 2f Inserts the symbol for a Nabla vector operator. 5 63263 70 This icon inserts an upward diagonal ellipsis (three dots on the diagonal from the bottom left to the top right) 5 63258 3e Inserts the symbol for the imaginary part of a complex number. 5 63261 32 This icon inserts a Weierstrass p-function symbol. a 1401499649 a8 Click one of the choices from this pop-up menu to access the Fonts dialog, where you can define the font and attributes for the respective formula and for custom fonts. a 1401490950 3d You can specify the font to be used for sans font formatting. a 1401490946 37 Select the fonts for names and properties of functions. a 1401490951 3e You can specify the font to be used for fixed font formatting. a 1401490945 3b You can select the fonts for the variables in your formula. a 1401490947 39 You can select the fonts for the numbers in your formula. a 1401490949 3e You can specify the font to be used for the font serif format. a 1401490948 33 Define the fonts for the text in your formula here. 5 30306 3a Defines the fonts that can be applied to formula elements. a 1401491970 4b Click this button to save your changes as the default for all new formulas. a 1401455618 3a Check this box to assign the italic attribute to the font. a 1401458689 1c Select a font from the list. a 1401455617 38 Check this box to assign the bold attribute to the font. a 1401454592 53 Use this dialog to select the font for the respective category in the Fonts dialog. a 1401477637 55 Select the relative size for the indexes in a formula in proportion to the base size. a 1401477638 6b Select the relative size for names and other function elements in a formula in proportion to the base size. a 1401477639 63 Select the relative size of the mathematical operators in a formula in proportion to the base size. 5 30307 97 Use this dialog to specify the font sizes for your formula. Select a base size and all elements of the formula will be scaled in relation to this base. a 1401477640 54 Select the relative size for the limits in a formula in proportion to the base size. a 1401477633 f9 All elements of a formula are proportionally scaled to the base size. To change the base size, select or type in the desired point (pt) size. You can also use other units of measure or other metrics, which are then automatically converted to points. a 1401475585 49 Click this button to save your changes as a default for all new formulas. a 1401477636 40 Select the size for text in a formula relative to the base size. a 1401516033 5d This button allows you to select the category for which you would like to change the spacing. 5 63823 3b Determines the spacing between matrix elements in a column. 5 63822 38 Determines the spacing between matrix elements in a row. 5 63826 45 Determines the height from the variable to the operator's upper edge. 5 63811 3a Determines the spacing between the root sign and radicals. 5 63819 42 Determines the spacing between the sum symbol and the lower limit. 5 63829 42 The right border is positioned between the formula and background. 5 63817 2b Determines the weight of the fraction line. a 1401504769 1d Scales all types of brackets. 5 63820 6a Determines the vertical distance between the upper edge of the contents and the upper end of the brackets. 5 63825 3e Determines the minimum distance between a symbol and variable. 5 63821 5a Determines the horizontal distance between the contents and the upper end of the brackets. 5 63814 42 Determines the spacing between the fraction bar and the numerator. 5 63810 25 Determines the spacing between lines. 5 63831 43 The bottom border is positioned between the formula and background. 5 63815 44 Determines the spacing between the fraction bar and the denominator. 5 63813 2d Determines the spacing for subscript indexes. 5 63830 40 The top border is positioned between the formula and background. 5 63828 41 The left border is positioned between the formula and background. a 1088328193 41 Saves your changes as your default settings for all new formulas. 5 63812 2f Determines the spacing for superscript indexes. 5 63816 32 Determines the excess length of the fraction line. 5 63809 34 Defines the spacing between variables and operators. 5 30308 aa Use this dialog to determine the spacing between formula elements. The spacing is specified as a percentage in relation to the base size defined under Format - Font Size. 5 63833 23 Adjusts the percentage excess size. 5 63818 42 Determines the spacing between the sum symbol and the upper limit. 5 63824 3e Defines the height of the symbols in relation to the baseline. 5 63827 43 Determines the horizontal distance between operators and variables. a 1401520643 2e Aligns the elements of a formula to the right. a 1401520641 36 Aligns the selected elements of a formula to the left. 5 30309 6a You can define the alignment of multi-line formulas as well as formulas with several elements in one line. a 1401520642 2f Aligns the elements of a formula to the center. a 1401524737 49 Click here to save your changes as the default settings for new formulas. 5 30313 6c Switches the text mode on or off. In text mode, formulas are displayed as the same height as a line of text. 5 30312 54 Opens the Symbols dialog, in which you can select a symbol to insert in the formula. a 1401552896 54 Opens the Symbols dialog, in which you can select a symbol to insert in the formula. a 1401557505 2b Click here to open the Edit Symbols dialog. 5 30261 54 Opens the Symbols dialog, in which you can select a symbol to insert in the formula. a 1401556481 9a All symbols are organized into symbol sets. Select the desired symbol set from the list box. The corresponding group of symbols appear in the field below. a 1401572865 51 Displays the name of the current font and enables you to select a different font. a 1401573378 73 This list box contains the name of the current symbol set. If you want, you can also select a different symbol set. a 1401573377 26 Select the name of the current symbol. a 1401573379 62 The current typeface is displayed. You can change the typeface by selecting one from the list box. a 1401573381 78 The Symbol set list box contains the names of all existing symbol sets. You can modify a symbol set or create a new one. a 1401573890 c6 Click this button to replace the name of the symbol shown in the left preview window (the old name is displayed in the Old symbol list box) with the new name you have entered in the Symbol list box. a 1401573891 58 Click to remove the symbol shown in the left preview window from the current symbol set. a 1401573380 7f Lists the names for the symbols in the current symbol set. Select a name from the list or type a name for a newly added symbol. a 1401572975 10d If you selected a non-symbol font in the Font list box, you can select a Unicode subset in which to place your new or edited symbol. When a subset has been selected, all symbols belonging to this subset of the current symbol set are displayed in the symbols list above. a 1401573889 60 Click this button to add the symbol shown in the right preview window to the current symbol set. a 1401569280 63 Use this dialog to add symbols to a symbol set, to edit symbol sets, or to modify symbol notations. 5 30314 34 This command opens a dialog for importing a formula. 5 30271 44 Use this icon on the Tools bar to turn the Formula Cursor on or off. 5 63069 97 Use the $[officename] Math Commands window to enter and edit formulas. As you make entries in the Commands window, you see the results in the document. 9 780800520 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation. a 2568793618 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. a 2568793614 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. 5 34813 63 View the selections in the dialog made in the previous step. The current settings remain unchanged. 9 780784136 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation. a 1428722180 48 Deletes the selected element or elements without requiring confirmation. 5 34403 9e Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialog settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create. 9 701665796 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation. 5 33882 2c Displays a preview of the current selection. a 2568531464 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. a 1087558147 48 Deletes the selected element or elements without requiring confirmation. 5 40975 40 Clicking Cancel closes a dialog without saving any changes made. 5 39056 9e Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialog settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create. a 2568285718 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. 5 41185 40 Clicking Cancel closes a dialog without saving any changes made. a 2567384577 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. a 2567515672 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. a 2567384578 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. 5 40972 63 View the selections in the dialog made in the previous step. The current settings remain unchanged. 5 34192 2c Displays a preview of the current selection. 13 HID_SC_FAP_BTN_REF4 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. 5 34402 63 View the selections in the dialog made in the previous step. The current settings remain unchanged. 9 808915481 48 Deletes the selected element or elements without requiring confirmation. 13 HID_SC_FAP_BTN_REF2 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. 2d SC%3AIMAGEBUTTON%3ARID_SCDLG_FORMULA%3ARB_REF f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. 9 808899108 48 Deletes the selected element or elements without requiring confirmation. 5 41203 9e Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialog settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create. 5 40974 2a Applies all changes and closes the wizard. 5 34205 40 Clicking Cancel closes a dialog without saving any changes made. a 2567335438 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. 5 34814 9e Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialog settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create. 5 33158 50 Resets the values visible in the dialog back to the default installation values. 5 41204 2a Applies all changes and closes the wizard. 5 33157 97 Resets changes made to the current tab to those applicable when this dialog was opened. A confirmation query does not appear when you close the dialog. 5 34405 40 Clicking Cancel closes a dialog without saving any changes made. 5 40973 9e Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialog settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create. 5 34818 9e Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialog settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create. a 1401557506 43 Applies the modified or selected values without closing the dialog. 46 OFFMGR%3APUSHBUTTON%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_REPLACE%3APB_DELETE_REPLACE 48 Deletes the selected element or elements without requiring confirmation. 9 700748339 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation. 13 HID_SC_FAP_BTN_REF3 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. a 2568285708 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. 9 956846595 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation. a 2567106101 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. a 2567319056 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. a 1493537386 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation. 5 41202 63 View the selections in the dialog made in the previous step. The current settings remain unchanged. a 2567532076 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. 44 OFFMGR%3APUSHBUTTON%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_EXCEPT%3APB_DELDOUBLECAPS 48 Deletes the selected element or elements without requiring confirmation. a 2568531461 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. a 2567089672 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. 9 780816904 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation. 9 701583875 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation. 5 34202 9e Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialog settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create. 1e HID_DLGREPORT_0_CMDNEXTORREADY 9e Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialog settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create. a 2568531481 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. 9 701649412 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation. a 1240879631 48 Deletes the selected element or elements without requiring confirmation. 5 34572 40 Clicking Cancel closes a dialog without saving any changes made. a 2567106056 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. 9 808915476 48 Deletes the selected element or elements without requiring confirmation. 9 701682180 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation. a 2568531471 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. a 2567311876 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation. 5 34203 63 View the selections in the dialog made in the previous step. The current settings remain unchanged. a 2567908865 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. 5 34817 63 View the selections in the dialog made in the previous step. The current settings remain unchanged. 31 OFFMGR_PUSHBUTTON_RID_OFADLG_OPTIONS_TREE_PB_BACK 40 Resets modified values back to the $[officename] default values. a 2568786436 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation. a 2567908867 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. 5 34325 40 Clicking Cancel closes a dialog without saving any changes made. 40 OFFMGR%3APUSHBUTTON%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_EXCEPT%3APB_DELABBREV 48 Deletes the selected element or elements without requiring confirmation. 5 34815 40 Clicking Cancel closes a dialog without saving any changes made. 13 HID_SC_FAP_BTN_REF1 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. 5 39055 63 View the selections in the dialog made in the previous step. The current settings remain unchanged. 5 53427 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation. a 2568531484 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. 5 34819 40 Clicking Cancel closes a dialog without saving any changes made. a 1085657602 50 Resets the values visible in the dialog back to the default installation values. 9 701698564 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation. a 2567328260 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation. a 1345966596 40 Resets modified values back to the $[officename] default values. a 2567908866 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. 5 34322 63 View the selections in the dialog made in the previous step. The current settings remain unchanged. a 2567532066 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. a 2567524870 48 Deletes the selected element or elements without requiring confirmation. 5 41205 40 Clicking Cancel closes a dialog without saving any changes made. a 2568531474 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. 9 701567491 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation. a 2568285728 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size. 9 878432869 50 Resets the values visible in the dialog back to the default installation values. 5 33958 35 Inserts the selected picture as a background graphic. 4 6328 46 Inserts the element that you moved to the clipboard into the document. 4 6324 99 Deletes the current selection. If multiple objects are selected, all will be deleted. In most cases, a security query appears before objects are deleted. 4 6327 2d Copies the selected element to the clipboard. 4 6322 3f Use the Open command to open the selected object in a new task. 4 6542 3f Use the Open command to open the selected object in a new task. 5 33774 39 Updates the view in the window or in the selected object. 4 6543 3f Use the Open command to open the selected object in a new task. 4 6326 28 Enables a selected object to be renamed. 5 33368 50 By default, $[officename] loads and saves files in the OpenDocument file format. 11 .uno%3AActiveHelp 53 Enables the display of a brief description of menus and icons at the mouse pointer. 4 5962 95 Allows you to activate the automatic Help Agent. You can also activate the Help Agent through Tools - Options - $[officename] - General - Help Agent. 13 .uno%3AHelperDialog 95 Allows you to activate the automatic Help Agent. You can also activate the Help Agent through Tools - Options - $[officename] - General - Help Agent. 4 5403 53 Enables the display of a brief description of menus and icons at the mouse pointer. e .uno%3AHelpTip 4f Enables the display of icon names at the mouse pointer and other Help contents. 4 5404 4f Enables the display of icon names at the mouse pointer and other Help contents. a 1336393728 43 Defines the settings for the import/export of files in JPEG format. a 1336399873 8d Sets the quality for the import/export. The value 1 denotes minimum quality and minimal file size, 100 denotes maximum quality and file size. a 1336394242 5d Specifies whether to retain the original colors of the JPEG file when importing or exporting. a 1336394241 46 Specifies whether to export or import a graphic object in a grayscale. a 1337524737 1a Retains the original size. a 1337556992 39 Defines the settings for SVM/WMF/PICT/MET export options. a 1337563650 15 Specifies the height. a 1334608386 21 Specifies whether to modify size. a 1334614530 15 Specifies the height. a 1337530881 14 Specifies the width. a 1334614529 14 Specifies the width. a 1337557505 1a Retains the original size. a 1334608385 1a Retains the original size. a 1337530882 15 Specifies the height. a 1334607872 39 Defines the settings for SVM/WMF/PICT/MET export options. a 1337563649 14 Specifies the width. a 1337557506 21 Specifies whether to modify size. a 1337524738 21 Specifies whether to modify size. a 1337524224 39 Defines the settings for SVM/WMF/PICT/MET export options. a 1334592001 1a Retains the original mode. 5 27167 52 Allows the object to be converted to a palette of approximately 16 million colors. a 1334592002 66 Allows you to define the resolution for an image. Select the desired DPI from the Resolution list box. 5 27162 44 Allows the object to be converted to a grid of black and white dots. 19 .uno%3AConvertToTrueColor 52 Allows the object to be converted to a palette of approximately 16 million colors. 5 27165 77 Allows the object to be converted to a palette of 256 gray scale tones corresponding to the brightness of the original. 5 27161 91 Converts the object to black and white. All brightness levels below the middle value become black, while all above the middle value become white. 19 .uno%3AConvertTo4BitGrays 76 Allows the object to be converted to a palette of 16 gray scale tones corresponding to the brightness of the original. 1d .uno%3AConvertTo1BitThreshold 91 Converts the object to black and white. All brightness levels below the middle value become black, while all above the middle value become white. a 1334592515 35 Applies RLE (Run Length Encoding) to the BMP graphics a 1334598145 1a Specifies the image width. a 1334592003 38 Allows you modify the image size by a given measurement. 1a .uno%3AConvertTo1BitMatrix 44 Allows the object to be converted to a grid of black and white dots. a 1334595073 53 In the Color Resolution list you will find the following color resolution variants: 1a .uno%3AConvertTo4BitColors 72 Allows the object to be converted to a palette of 16 colors that match the original colors as closely as possible. a 1334598146 1b Specifies the image height. 19 .uno%3AConvertTo8BitGrays 77 Allows the object to be converted to a palette of 256 gray scale tones corresponding to the brightness of the original. a 1334591488 3b Defines the import/export settings for files in BMP format. 5 27163 76 Allows the object to be converted to a palette of 16 gray scale tones corresponding to the brightness of the original. a 1334595585 66 Allows you to define the resolution for an image. Select the desired DPI from the Resolution list box. 1a .uno%3AConvertTo8BitColors 73 Allows the object to be converted to a palette of 256 colors that match the original colors as closely as possible. 5 27166 73 Allows the object to be converted to a palette of 256 colors that match the original colors as closely as possible. 5 27164 72 Allows the object to be converted to a palette of 16 colors that match the original colors as closely as possible. 31 VCL%3ACHECKBOX%3ADLG_EXPORT_GIF%3ACBX_TRANSLUCENT b6 Specifies whether to save the background of the picture as transparent. Only objects will be visible in the GIF image. Use the Eyedropper to set the transparent color in the picture. a 1337541634 b6 Specifies whether to save the background of the picture as transparent. Only objects will be visible in the GIF image. Use the Eyedropper to set the transparent color in the picture. 22 VCL%3AMODALDIALOG%3ADLG_EXPORT_GIF 5d In the GIF Options dialog, you can select the settings for the export of files in GIF format. 30 VCL%3ACHECKBOX%3ADLG_EXPORT_GIF%3ACBX_INTERLACED 42 Specifies whether to use interlaced mode for saving the GIF image. a 1337541633 42 Specifies whether to use interlaced mode for saving the GIF image. a 1494175242 41 Select the character set from the options used for import/export. a 1494175241 2c Specifies the character set for text export. a 1494175749 41 Choose or enter the field delimiter, which separates data fields. a 1494172685 bc Enabled by default, data will be saved as displayed, including applied number formats. If this checkbox is not marked, raw data content will be saved, as in older versions of %PRODUCTNAME. a 1494175751 44 Choose or enter the text delimiter, which encloses every data field. a 1494172684 2b Exports all data fields with a fixed width. a 1494697013 34 Separates data delimited by semicolons into columns. a 1494699524 3c Specifies the character set to be used in the imported file. a 1494699543 5f Choose a column in the preview window and select the data type to be applied the imported data. a 1494697012 30 Separates data delimited by spaces into columns. a 1494698040 88 Separates data into columns using the custom separator that you specify. Note: The custom separator must also be contained in your data. a 1494697015 88 Separates data into columns using the custom separator that you specify. Note: The custom separator must also be contained in your data. a 1494695936 2b Sets the import options for delimited data. a 1494697014 30 Separates data delimited by commas into columns. a 1494696449 27 Select the separator used in your data. a 1494697011 2e Separates data delimited by tabs into columns. a 1494702140 35 Specifies the row where you want to start the import. a 1494697050 3e Combines consecutive delimiters and removes blank data fields. a 1494696450 45 Separates fixed-width data (equal number of characters) into columns. a 1494700041 5c Select a character to delimit text data. You can can also enter a character in the text box. a 1087307776 64 The Warning Print Options dialog appears when the page setup does not match the defined print range. a 1087308289 3f Specifies whether to distribute the printout on multiple pages. a 1087308290 3f Specifies whether to distribute the printout on multiple pages. a 1087308291 72 Specifies that anything extending beyond the maximum print range will be cut off and not included in the printing. 31 VCL%3ACHECKBOX%3ADLG_EXPORT_EPNG%3ACBX_INTERLACED 40 Specifies whether the graphic is to be saved in interlaced mode. 36 VCL%3ANUMERICFIELD%3ADLG_EXPORT_EPNG%3ANUM_COMPRESSION be Specifies the compression setting from 0 (no compression) to 9 (maximum compression). The calculation time increases with the compression value, while the resulting file is smaller in bytes. a 1336476673 40 Specifies whether the graphic is to be saved in interlaced mode. a 1336481793 be Specifies the compression setting from 0 (no compression) to 9 (maximum compression). The calculation time increases with the compression value, while the resulting file is smaller in bytes. a 1337655812 24 Exports the file in grayscale tones. a 1337655813 dd LZW compression is the compression of a file into a smaller file using a table-based lookup algorithm invented by Abraham Lempel, Jacob Ziv, and Terry Welch. If you choose to activate this, select the LZW encoding option. a 1337655809 8c Compression is not available at this level. Select the Level 1 option if your PostScript printer does not offer the capabilities of Level 2. a 1337655810 73 Select the Level 2 option if your output device supports colored bitmaps, palette graphics and compressed graphics. a 1337656322 6c Specifies whether a monochrome preview graphic in EPSI format is exported together with the PostScript file. a 1337655814 32 Specifies that you do not wish to use compression. a 1337656321 6a Specifies whether a preview image is exported in the TIFF format together with the actual PostScript file. a 1337655811 1a Exports the file in color. a 1337704962 52 Exports the file in the ASCII text format. This file type is larger than a binary. a 1337688578 52 Exports the file in the ASCII text format. This file type is larger than a binary. a 1337704961 5a Exports the file in binary format. The resulting file is smaller than a (ASCII) text file. a 1337688577 5a Exports the file in binary format. The resulting file is smaller than a (ASCII) text file. a 1337672193 5a Exports the file in binary format. The resulting file is smaller than a (ASCII) text file. a 1337672194 52 Exports the file in the ASCII text format. This file type is larger than a binary. a 1404849669 93 By setting a default font, you specify that the text should be displayed in a specific font. The default fonts can only be selected when importing. a 1404849671 78 Specifies the language of the text, if this has not already been defined. This setting is only available when importing. a 1404849667 3d Specifies the character set of the file for export or import. a 1404846602 34 Produces a "Carriage Return" as the paragraph break. a 1404846603 2d Produces a "Linefeed" as the paragraph break. a 1404846601 4a Produces a "Carriage Return" and a "Linefeed". This option is the default. 5 33960 30 Deletes the selected graphic after confirmation. 5 33957 27 Inserts the selected graphic as a link. 5 33959 32 The Preview command displays the selected graphic. 31 SVX%3AEDIT%3ARID_SVXDLG_GALLERY_TITLE%3AEDT_TITLE 2d Assigns a title to a selected Gallery object. 5 33956 49 Inserts a copy of the selected graphic object directly into the document. 5 33955 42 Defines how a selected graphic object is inserted into a document. 5 33961 2d Assigns a title to a selected Gallery object. 5 53421 64 If you have deactivated the graphics display, choose the Load Graphics command to make them visible. 5 53419 36 Copies the link at the mouse pointer to the clipboard. 5 53413 38 Opens a dialog where you can save the selected graphics. 5 53420 2b Copies a selected graphic to the clipboard. 5 53417 30 Allows you to save the background of a Web page. 5 53422 32 Sets all graphics in the document to be invisible. 5 53423 1b Disables inserted plug-ins. 9 706627585 1f Displays the name of the theme. 2a SVX_TABPAGE_RID_SVXTABPAGE_GALLERY_GENERAL 47 The General tab page lists the general properties of the current theme. 1b private%3Afactory%2Fswriter 33 Creates a new text document ($[officename] Writer). 2b private%3Afactory%2Fsdatabase%3FInteractive 34 Opens the Database Wizard to create a database file. 19 private%3Afactory%2Fscalc 38 Creates a new spreadsheet document ($[officename] Calc). 5 33360 52 Creates a new $[officename] document. Click the arrow to select the document type. d .uno%3ANewDoc 57 If you want to create a document from a template, choose New - Templates and Documents. 28 private%3Afactory%2Fswriter%3Fslot=21053 1e Creates a new XForms document. 28 private%3Afactory%2Fsimpress%3Fslot=6686 64 Creates a new presentation document ($[officename] Impress). The Presentation Wizard dialog appears. 28 private%3Afactory%2Fswriter%3Fslot=21052 93 Opens the Business Cards dialog where you can set the options for your business cards, and then creates a new text document ($[officename] Writer). 4 5537 25 Creates a new $[officename] document. 19 private%3Afactory%2Fsmath 34 Creates a new formula document ($[officename] Math). b slot%3A5500 4d Creates a new document using an existing template or opens a sample document. 28 private%3Afactory%2Fswriter%3Fslot=21051 92 Opens the Labels dialog where you can set the options for your labels, and then creates a new text document for the labels ($[officename] Writer). 21 private%3Afactory%2Fswriter%2Fweb 1c Creates a new HTML document. 2f service%3Acom.sun.star.sdb.DatabaseWizardDialog 34 Opens the Database Wizard to create a database file. 10 .uno%3AAddDirect 25 Creates a new $[officename] document. 2c private%3Afactory%2Fswriter%2FGlobalDocument 1e Creates a new master document. 19 private%3Afactory%2Fsdraw 34 Creates a new drawing document ($[officename] Draw). 5 32993 28 Moves up one folder level, if available. 5 32995 3e Displays the properties for the selected template or document. 5 32996 38 Allows you to preview the selected template or document. a 1335398924 28 Opens the selected template for editing. 5 32992 30 Moves back to the previous window in the dialog. 5 32994 29 Prints the selected template or document. a 1335398923 3b Adds, removes, or rearranges templates or sample documents. 5 32990 ad Categories are shown in the box on the left side of the Templates and Documents dialog. Click a category to display the files associated with that category in the Title box. 5 32991 c7 Lists the available templates or documents for the selected category. Select a template or document and, then click Open. To preview the document, click the Preview button above the box on the right. 13 .uno%3AInsertLabels 43 Allows you to create labels. Labels are created in a text document. 5 21051 43 Allows you to create labels. Labels are created in a text document. 5 54839 23 Creates a new document for editing. 9 909689354 23 Prints labels on individual sheets. 9 909689858 66 Creates a label with your return address. Text that is currently in the Label text box is overwritten. 9 909691395 5a Enter the text that you want to appear on the label. You can also insert a database field. 5 53182 3f Specify the label text and choose the paper size for the label. 9 909692434 86 Select the database field that you want, and then click the arrow to the left of this box to insert the field into the Label text box. 9 909692428 2f Select the brand of paper that you want to use. 9 909692421 4b Select the database that you want to use as the data source for your label. 9 909692423 55 Select the database table containing the field(s) that you want to use in your label. 9 909689353 22 Prints labels on continuous paper. 9 909692430 eb Select the size format that you want to use. The available formats depend on the brand on what you selected in the Brand list. If you want to use a custom label format, select [User], and then click the Format tab to define the format. 9 909700627 86 Select the database field that you want, and then click the arrow to the left of this box to insert the field into the Label text box. 9 909711877 c8 Displays the distance between the upper edge of a label or a business card and the upper edge of the label or the business card directly below. If you are defining a custom format, enter a value here. 9 909711885 98 Displays distance from the top edge of the page to the top of the first label or business card. If you are defining a custom format, enter a value here. 9 909711875 8b Displays the distance between the left edges of adjacent labels or business cards. If you are defining a custom format, enter a value here. 9 909711879 6f Displays the width for the label or the business card. If you are defining a custom format, enter a value here. a 1446643717 1d Enter or select a label type. 9 909709843 30 Saves the current label or business card format. a 1446645763 22 Enter or select the desired brand. 9 909711883 a3 Displays the distance from the left edge of the page to the left edge of the first label or business card. If you are defining a custom format, enter a value here. 9 909711377 5a Enter the number of labels or business cards that you want to span the height of the page. 9 909711375 59 Enter the number of labels or business cards that you want to span the width of the page. 5 53185 1d Set paper formatting options. 9 909711881 6c Displays the height for the label or business card. If you are defining a custom format, enter a value here. 9 909722635 af Allows you to edit a single label or business card and updates the contents of the remaining labels or business cards on the page when you click the Synchronize Labels button. 5 53183 6f Sets additional options for your labels or business cards, including text synchronization and printer settings. 9 909727749 59 Enter the number of labels or business cards that you want to have in a row on your page. 9 909722113 31 Creates a full page of labels or business cards. a 1983500820 71 Copies the contents of the top left label or business card to the remaining labels or business cards on the page. 9 909727751 58 Enter the number of rows of labels or business cards that you want to have on your page. 9 909722114 32 Prints a single label or business card on a page. 9 909726216 1f Opens the Printer Setup dialog. 5 21052 2a Design and create your own business cards. 19 .uno%3AInsertBusinessCard 2a Design and create your own business cards. 5 54924 dd Select the size format that you want to use. The available formats depend on what you selected in the Brand list. If you want to use a custom size format, select [User], and then click the Format tab to define the format. 5 54921 2a Prints business cards on continuous paper. 5 54923 2f Select the brand of paper that you want to use. 5 54922 2b Prints business cards on individual sheets. 5 54918 67 Select a business card category in AutoText - Section box, and then click a layout in the Content list. 9 879185413 4d Select a business card category, and then click a layout in the Content list. 9 879216686 21 Enter your home telephone number. 9 879216687 23 Enter your mobile telephone number. 9 879216691 2c Enter the address of your internet homepage. 9 879216683 23 Enter the title of your profession. 9 879216708 4b Enter the initials of the person, whom you want to use as a second contact. 9 879216706 4d Enter the first name of the person, whom you want to use as a second contact. 9 879216707 4c Enter the last name of the person, whom you want to use as a second contact. 9 879216693 30 Enter the name of the country in which you live. 9 879233070 25 Enter your business telephone number. 9 879233081 21 Enter additional company details. 9 879233075 36 Enter the address of your company's internet homepage. 9 879233071 23 Enter your mobile telephone number. 9 879233077 3d Enter the name of the country where your business is located. 9 879233083 21 Enter the slogan of your company. 5 33017 5e If there are multiple versions of the selected file, select the version that you want to open. 3b SVTOOLS_MENUBUTTON_DLG_SVT_EXPLORERFILE_BTN_EXPLORERFILE_UP 61 Move up one directory in the directory hierarchy. Long-click to see the higher level directories. a 1334652942 61 Move up one directory in the directory hierarchy. Long-click to see the higher level directories. 5 33290 4b Inserts the selected file into the current document at the cursor position. a 1334652427 18 Creates a new directory. 3d SVTOOLS_PUSHBUTTON_DLG_SVT_EXPLORERFILE_BTN_EXPLORERFILE_OPEN 1f Opens the selected document(s). 41 svtools_MenuButton_DLG_SVT_EXPLORERFILE_BTN_EXPLORERFILE_STANDARD 31 Displays the files in the default user directory. 5 33016 21 Opens the file in read-only mode. 3e svtools_PushButton_DLG_SVT_EXPLORERFILE_BTN_EXPLORERFILE_LOCAL 1f Opens the selected document(s). b .uno%3AOpen 18 Opens or imports a file. 4 5501 18 Opens or imports a file. 5 33095 44 Displays the files and directories in the directory that you are in. a 1334678020 3c Click to delete the file with the name shown in this dialog. 5 32999 3f To delete a file, right-click the file, and then choose Delete. a 1334652943 31 Displays the files in the default user directory. 3d SVTOOLS_LISTBOX_DLG_SVT_EXPLORERFILE_LB_EXPLORERFILE_FILETYPE 7b Select the file type that you want to open, or select All Files (*) to display a list of all of the files in the directory. 5 33294 7a Enter a file name or a path for the file. You can also enter a URL that starts with the protocol name ftp, http, or https. 43 SVTOOLS_IMAGEBUTTON_DLG_SVT_EXPLORERFILE_BTN_EXPLORERFILE_NEWFOLDER 18 Creates a new directory. 5 32998 18 Opens or imports a file. 5 33286 7a Enter a file name or a path for the file. You can also enter a URL that starts with the protocol name ftp, http, or https. a 1334644259 7b Select the file type that you want to open, or select All Files (*) to display a list of all of the files in the directory. 5 33000 3f To rename a file, right-click the file, and then choose Rename. 41 SVTOOLS_PUSHBUTTON_DLG_SVT_EXPLORERFILE_BTN_EXPLORERFILE_STANDARD 31 Displays the files in the default user directory. a 1334678021 48 Click to cancel deletion of the file with the name shown in this dialog. a 1334678022 23 Click to delete all selected files. 5 33291 1b Selects the indicated path. 5 33292 27 Enter or select the path from the list. a 1311477279 3c Select the import filter for the file that you want to open. 33 SFX2%3ALISTBOX%3ADLG_FILTER_SELECT%3ALB_DLG_LISTBOX 3c Select the import filter for the file that you want to open. f .uno%3ACloseDoc 38 Closes the current document without exiting the program. 4 5503 38 Closes the current document without exiting the program. 4 5505 1b Saves the current document. b .uno%3ASave 1b Saves the current document. 5 33011 57 Protects the file with a password that must be entered before a user can open the file. 5 33009 f Saves the file. 5 33004 31 Displays the files in the default user directory. 5 33003 18 Creates a new directory. 5 33013 9a Exports only the selected graphic objects in %PRODUCTNAME Draw and Impress to another format. If this box is not checked, the entire document is exported. 4 5502 5f Saves the current document in a different location, or with a different file name or file type. 5 33002 61 Move up one directory in the directory hierarchy. Long-click to see the higher level directories. 5 33005 44 Displays the files and directories in the directory that you are in. d .uno%3ASaveAs 5f Saves the current document in a different location, or with a different file name or file type. 5 33007 42 Enter a file name or a path for the file. You can also enter a URL 5 33012 4e Allows you to set the spreadsheet saving options for some types of data files. 5 33008 3c Select the file format for the document that you are saving. 5 33014 5f Saves the current document in a different location, or with a different file name or file type. f .uno%3AExportTo 5b Saves the current document with a different name and format to a location that you specify. 4 5829 5b Saves the current document with a different name and format to a location that you specify. 1c .uno%3ASetDocumentProperties 78 Displays the properties for the current file, including statistics such as word count and the date the file was created. 4 5535 78 Displays the properties for the current file, including statistics such as word count and the date the file was created. 9 541181962 1f Enter a title for the document. 9 541182488 2d Enter comments to help identify the document. 9 541181964 61 Enter a subject for the document. You can use a subject to group documents with similar contents. 5 33076 34 Contains descriptive information about the document. 9 541181966 ad Enter the words that you want to use to index the content of your document. Keywords must be separated by commas. A keyword can contain white space characters or semicolons. 9 541197361 78 Saves the user's full name with the file. You can edit the name by choosing Tools - Options - $[officename] - User Data. 9 541198387 17 Displays the file name. 5 33077 32 Contains basic information about the current file. 9 541200958 a3 Resets the editing time to zero, the creation date to the current date and time, and the version number to 1. The modification and printing dates are also deleted. 9 541214738 ae Enter your custom contents. You can change the name, type, and contents of each row. You can add or remove rows. The items will be exported as metadata to other file formats. 9 541214736 ae Enter your custom contents. You can change the name, type, and contents of each row. You can add or remove rows. The items will be exported as metadata to other file formats. 9 541214742 ae Enter your custom contents. You can change the name, type, and contents of each row. You can add or remove rows. The items will be exported as metadata to other file formats. 5 33393 ae Enter your custom contents. You can change the name, type, and contents of each row. You can add or remove rows. The items will be exported as metadata to other file formats. 9 541214740 ae Enter your custom contents. You can change the name, type, and contents of each row. You can add or remove rows. The items will be exported as metadata to other file formats. 9 541364830 2e Click to add a new row to the Properties list. 5 33078 40 Allows you to assign custom information fields to your document. 9 957628416 29 Displays statistics for the current file. 5 53173 29 Displays statistics for the current file. 2f SFX2%3ACOMBOBOX%3ATP_DOCINFORELOAD%3ALB_DEFAULT 6f If the current HTML page uses frames, select the name of the target frame where you want the file to be loaded. 9 541349958 57 Enter the number of seconds to wait before redirecting the browser to a different file. 9 541344321 5c Loads a page that you specify after the number of seconds that you enter in the seconds box. 9 541348426 3b Locate the file that you want to open, and then click Open. 9 541349955 40 Enter the number of seconds to wait before the page is reloaded. 9 541344320 87 Reloads the HTML page after the number of seconds that you enter in the seconds box. To observe the result, open the page in a browser. 9 541347913 6f If the current HTML page uses frames, select the name of the target frame where you want the file to be loaded. 5 33092 37 Sets the refresh and redirect options for an HTML page. 9 541344319 24 User must refresh the page manually. 9 541345836 38 Enter the URL address of the file that you want to open. 13 .uno%3ATemplateMenu 5a Lets you organize and edit your templates, as well as save the current file as a template. 5 33173 47 Prints the name and properties of the styles that are used in the file. 5 33361 71 Uses the selected template as the default template when you create a new $[officename] document of the same type. 10 .uno%3AOrganizer 63 Opens the Template Management dialog where you can organize templates and define default templates. 5 33175 22 Updates the contents of the lists. a 1107415556 4d Locate a file that you want to add to the document list, and then click Open. 5 33362 5c Select a $[officename] document type to reset the default template to the original template. 5 33104 9d Displays the available template categories or opened $[officename] files. To change the contents of the list, select Templates or Documents in the box below. 5 33171 96 Imports an additional template. To import a template, select a template folder in the list, click the Command button, and then select Import template. 5 33168 20 Creates a new template category. 5 33172 1e Exports the selected template. a 1107415555 4d Locate a file that you want to add to the document list, and then click Open. 5 33174 3f Changes the printer and its settings for the selected document. 5 33169 1e Deletes the current selection. 4 5540 63 Opens the Template Management dialog where you can organize templates and define default templates. a 1107414530 5a Select Templates or Documents to change the contents that are displayed in the list above. 5 33170 28 Opens the selected template for editing. 5 33103 9d Displays the available template categories or opened $[officename] files. To change the contents of the list, select Templates or Documents in the box below. a 1107423337 48 Contains commands for managing and editing your templates and documents. a 1107414539 5a Select Templates or Documents to change the contents that are displayed in the list above. 4 6655 45 Edit the field assignments and the data source for your address book. 18 .uno%3AAddressBookSource 45 Edit the field assignments and the data source for your address book. a 1336446982 2c Select the data table for your address book. a 1336446979 2d Select the data source for your address book. a 1336447492 36 Add a new data source to the Address Book Source list. 5 32997 4e Select the field in the data table that corresponds to the address book entry. a 1107396615 1e Enter a name for the template. 15 .uno%3ASaveAsTemplate 29 Saves the current document as a template. a 1107399188 54 Opens the Template Management dialog where you can organize or create new templates. 4 5538 29 Saves the current document as a template. a 1107398148 28 Lists the available template categories. a 1107399180 28 Opens the selected template for editing. a 1107398146 34 Select a category in which to save the new template. 13 .uno%3AOpenTemplate 3b Opens a dialog where you can select a template for editing. 4 5594 3b Opens a dialog where you can select a template for editing. a 1104003592 38 For handouts, enable to print in a vertical order first. a 1338786338 46 Prints only the selected area(s) or object(s) in the current document. a 1104003591 3a For handouts, enable to print in a horizontal order first. a 1338791978 32 Enter the number of copies that you want to print. a 1338774033 36 Changes the printer settings for the current document. a 1338786829 67 Prints to a file instead of to a printer. Select this box, and then choose a location to save the file. a 1338786327 84 Enables the selected cells to be printed. In the "Print range" area of the dialog, you can restrict this output to some given pages. a 1338786326 85 Enables the selected sheets to be printed. In the "Print range" area of the dialog, you can restrict this output to some given pages. 4 5504 83 Prints the current document, selection, or the pages that you specify. You can also set the print options for the current document. a 1338786859 32 Preserves the page order of the original document. c .uno%3APrint 83 Prints the current document, selection, or the pages that you specify. You can also set the print options for the current document. a 1338786335 1b Prints the entire document. a 1338790454 36 Changes the printer settings for the current document. a 1104006659 45 Select whether you want to print Slides, Handouts, Notes, or Outline. a 1338786336 38 Prints only the pages that you specify in the Pages box. a 1104006661 45 For handouts, select the number of slides to print per page of paper. a 1338789378 ab Lists the default printer for the current document. The information for the printer is displayed below this box. If you select another printer, the information is updated. a 1338790403 24 Opens the printer properties dialog. a 1338786325 7c Enables all sheets to be printed. In the "Print range" area of the dialog, you can restrict this output to some given pages. a 1338787873 c7 To print a range of pages, use the format 3-6. To print single pages, use the format 7;9;11. If you want, you can print a combination of page ranges and single pages, by using the format 3-6;8;10;12. a 1338774019 4f Changes the printer settings of your operating system for the current document. a 1338772994 7a Lists the installed printers on your operating system. To change the default printer, select a printer name from the list. a 1338769408 34 Select the default printer for the current document. 4 5302 34 Select the default printer for the current document. 13 .uno%3APrinterSetup 34 Select the default printer for the current document. 17 .uno%3ASendMailDocAsOOo 83 Opens a new window in your default e-mail program with the current document as an attachment. The OpenDocument file format is used. 11 .uno%3ASendToMenu 3f Sends a copy of the current document to different applications. 16 .uno%3ASendMailDocAsMS 80 Opens a new window in your default e-mail program with the current document as an attachment. The Microsoft file format is used. 4 5331 e9 Opens a new window in your default e-mail program with the current document as an attachment. The current file format is used. If the document is new and unsaved, the format specified in Tools - Options - Load/Save - General is used. f .uno%3ASendMail e9 Opens a new window in your default e-mail program with the current document as an attachment. The current file format is used. If the document is new and unsaved, the format specified in Tools - Options - Load/Save - General is used. 5 54929 74 Select the paragraph style or outline level that you want to use to separate the source document into sub-documents. 5 20004 b1 Creates a master document from the current Writer document. A new sub-document is created at each occurrence of a chosen paragraph style or outline level in the source document. 5 33006 74 Select the paragraph style or outline level that you want to use to separate the source document into sub-documents. 5 54930 74 Select the paragraph style or outline level that you want to use to separate the source document into sub-documents. 5 54932 74 Select the paragraph style or outline level that you want to use to separate the source document into sub-documents. 13 .uno%3ANewGlobalDoc b1 Creates a master document from the current Writer document. A new sub-document is created at each occurrence of a chosen paragraph style or outline level in the source document. 4 5300 47 Closes all $[officename] programs and prompts you to save your changes. b .uno%3AQuit 47 Closes all $[officename] programs and prompts you to save your changes. 4 5309 2b Saves all modified $[officename] documents. e .uno%3ASaveAll 2b Saves all modified $[officename] documents. a 1112687619 77 If you have made changes to your document, $[officename] automatically saves a new version when you close the document. 4 6583 89 Saves and organizes multiple versions of the current document in the same file. You can also open, delete, and compare previous versions. a 1112691206 31 Opens the selected version in a read-only window. a 1112691217 33 Compare the changes that were made in each version. a 1112691205 1d Deletes the selected version. a 1112691202 a8 Saves the current state of the document as a new version. If you want, you can also enter comments in the Insert Version Comment dialog before you save the new version. a 1112705550 7d Enter a comment here when you are saving a new version. If you clicked Show to open this dialog, you cannot edit the comment. a 1112686592 85 Lists the existing versions of the current document, the date and the time they were created, the author and the associated comments. 14 .uno%3AVersionDialog 89 Saves and organizes multiple versions of the current document in the same file. You can also open, delete, and compare previous versions. a 1112691213 35 Displays the entire comment for the selected version. 4 6697 51 Lists the most recently opened files. To open a file in the list, click its name. 15 .uno%3ARecentFileList 51 Lists the most recently opened files. To open a file in the list, click its name. 4 5701 a1 Reverses the last command or the last entry you typed. To select the command that you want to reverse, click the arrow next to the Undo icon on the Standard bar. 5 33948 a1 Reverses the last command or the last entry you typed. To select the command that you want to reverse, click the arrow next to the Undo icon on the Standard bar. b .uno%3AUndo a1 Reverses the last command or the last entry you typed. To select the command that you want to reverse, click the arrow next to the Undo icon on the Standard bar. 4 5700 9a Reverses the action of the last Undo command. To select the Undo step that you want to reverse, click the arrow next to the Redo icon on the Standard bar. 5 33949 9a Reverses the action of the last Undo command. To select the Undo step that you want to reverse, click the arrow next to the Redo icon on the Standard bar. b .uno%3ARedo 9a Reverses the action of the last Undo command. To select the Undo step that you want to reverse, click the arrow next to the Redo icon on the Standard bar. d .uno%3ARepeat 47 Repeats the last command. This command is available in Writer and Calc. 4 5702 47 Repeats the last command. This command is available in Writer and Calc. 4 5710 32 Removes and copies the selection to the clipboard. a .uno%3ACut 32 Removes and copies the selection to the clipboard. b .uno%3ACopy 26 Copies the selection to the clipboard. 4 5711 26 Copies the selection to the clipboard. c .uno%3APaste a6 Inserts the contents of the clipboard at the location of the cursor, and replaces any selected text or objects. Click the arrow next to the icon to select the format. 5 59001 a6 Inserts the contents of the clipboard at the location of the cursor, and replaces any selected text or objects. Click the arrow next to the icon to select the format. 4 5712 a6 Inserts the contents of the clipboard at the location of the cursor, and replaces any selected text or objects. Click the arrow next to the icon to select the format. a 1493435416 0 5 34868 2e Displays the source of the clipboard contents. 5 27003 5d Inserts the contents of the clipboard into the current file in a format that you can specify. 30 SO3%3ALISTBOX%3AMD_PASTE_OBJECT%3ALB_INSERT_LIST 42 Select a format for the clipboard contents that you want to paste. a 1493434918 0 5 20114 5d Inserts the contents of the clipboard into the current file in a format that you can specify. a 1493434907 0 15 .uno%3AInsertContents 0 5 26265 0 a 1493435427 0 a 1493435414 0 a 1493434909 0 a 1493435425 0 a 1493435426 0 a 1493434908 0 a 1493435433 0 23 SO3%3AMODALDIALOG%3AMD_PASTE_OBJECT 5d Inserts the contents of the clipboard into the current file in a format that you can specify. a 1493435413 0 15 .uno%3APasteClipboard 5d Inserts the contents of the clipboard into the current file in a format that you can specify. a 1493434911 0 a 1493434910 0 a 1598049799 42 Select a format for the clipboard contents that you want to paste. a 1493434917 0 13 .uno%3APasteSpecial 5d Inserts the contents of the clipboard into the current file in a format that you can specify. a 1493435415 0 a 1493434919 0 5 26220 5d Inserts the contents of the clipboard into the current file in a format that you can specify. a 1493435417 0 a 1493435418 0 a 1493435412 0 10 .uno%3ASelectAll 46 Selects the entire content of the current file, frame, or text object. d .uno%3ASelect 46 Selects the entire content of the current file, frame, or text object. 4 5723 46 Selects the entire content of the current file, frame, or text object. 4 5720 46 Selects the entire content of the current file, frame, or text object. a 2311654967 9b Searches for the characters that you specify in formulas and in fixed (not calculated) values. For example, you could look for formulas that contain 'SUM'. a 2311652378 48 Searches for whole words or cells that are identical to the search text. 30 SVX%3ARADIOBUTTON%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ABTN_ROWS 2c Searches from left to right across the rows. 5 10291 41 Searches for or replaces text or formats in the current document. a 2311654929 57 Enter the replacement text, or select a recent replacement text or style from the list. a 1368769544 40 Distinguishes between half-width and full-width character forms. 34 SVX%3ARADIOBUTTON%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ABTN_FORMULAS 9b Searches for the characters that you specify in formulas and in fixed (not calculated) values. For example, you could look for formulas that contain 'SUM'. a 2311652394 5d Search starts at the current cursor position and goes backwards to the beginning of the file. a 2311652395 2b Allows you to use wildcards in your search. a 2311652398 cf Searches for text formatted with the style that you specify. Select this checkbox, and then select a style from the Search for list. To specify a replacement style, select a style from the Replace with list. a 2311655959 66 Replaces the selected text or format that you searched for, and then searches for the next occurrence. a 2311651898 30 Searches from top to bottom through the columns. 2e SVX%3ACHECKBOX%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ABTN_CELLS 48 Searches for whole words or cells that are identical to the search text. 33 SVX%3ACHECKBOX%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ABTN_SELECTIONS 29 Searches only the selected text or cells. a 2311655985 43 Sets the search options for similar notation used in Japanese text. a 2311652377 39 Distinguishes between uppercase and lowercase characters. a 2311652411 43 Searches through all of the sheets in the current spreadsheet file. a 2311655440 57 Enter the replacement text, or select a recent replacement text or style from the list. a 2311655988 7b Click in the Search for or the Replace with box, and then click this button to remove the search criteria based on formats. a 1368769545 a2 Lets you specify the search options for similar notation used in Japanese text. Select this checkbox, and then click the ... button to specify the search options. a 2311654924 56 Enter the text that you want to search for, or select a previous search from the list. 31 SVX%3ACHECKBOX%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ACB_ALLTABLES 43 Searches through all of the sheets in the current spreadsheet file. a 2311651897 2c Searches from left to right across the rows. 32 SVX%3ACHECKBOX%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ABTN_BACKWARDS 5d Search starts at the current cursor position and goes backwards to the beginning of the file. 32 SVX%3ARADIOBUTTON%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ABTN_VALUES 56 Searches for the characters that you specify in values and in the results of formulas. 2f SVX%3ACHECKBOX%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ABTN_REGEXP 2b Allows you to use wildcards in your search. a 2311664159 60 Shows more or fewer search options. Click this button again to hide the extended search options. 17 .uno%3ASearchProperties 41 Searches for or replaces text or formats in the current document. 4 5961 41 Searches for or replaces text or formats in the current document. a 2311652400 a2 Lets you specify the search options for similar notation used in Japanese text. Select this checkbox, and then click the ... button to specify the search options. 2a svx_CheckBox_RID_SVXDLG_SEARCH_BTN_LAYOUTS cf Searches for text formatted with the style that you specify. Select this checkbox, and then select a style from the Search for list. To specify a replacement style, select a style from the Replace with list. a 1368773123 43 Sets the search options for similar notation used in Japanese text. a 2311655957 89 Finds and selects all instances of the text or the format that you are searching for in the document (only in Writer and Calc documents). 3c SVX%3AMULTILINEEDIT%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3AED_REPLACE_FORMATS 41 Replacement options are listed in the Options area of the dialog. 33 SVX%3ARADIOBUTTON%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ABTN_COLUMNS 30 Searches from top to bottom through the columns. a 2311652399 40 Distinguishes between half-width and full-width character forms. 3b SVX%3AMULTILINEEDIT%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3AED_SEARCH_FORMATS 3b Search options are listed in the Options area of the dialog a 2311655960 4f Replaces all of the occurrences of the text or format that you want to replace. a 2311655435 56 Enter the text that you want to search for, or select a previous search from the list. 13 .uno%3ASearchDialog 41 Searches for or replaces text or formats in the current document. 31 SVX%3ARADIOBUTTON%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ABTN_NOTES 5c Searches for the characters that you specify in the comments that are attached to the cells. a 2311655956 63 Finds and selects the next occurrence of the text or format that you searching for in the document. a 2311652393 29 Searches only the selected text or cells. a 2311652396 89 Find terms that are similar to the Search for text. Select this checkbox, and then click the ... button to define the similarity options. a 1237964821 6e Enter the maximum number of characters by which a word can exceed the number of characters in the search term. a 1237964817 48 Enter the number of characters in the search term that can be exchanged. a 2311655981 2a Set the options for the similarity search. a 1237964819 53 Enter the number of characters by which a word can be shorter than the search term. a 1237959695 53 Searches for a term that matches any combination of the similarity search settings. 5 38189 89 Find terms that are similar to the Search for text. Select this checkbox, and then click the ... button to define the similarity options. 5 38190 89 Find terms that are similar to the Search for text. Select this checkbox, and then click the ... button to define the similarity options. a 2311655986 122 Choose the text attributes that you want to search for. For example, if you search for the Font attribute, all instances of text that do not use the default font are found. All text that has a directly coded font attribute, and all text where a style switches the font attribute, are found. 5 33883 32 Select the attributes that you want to search for. 5 33820 32 Select the attributes that you want to search for. a 2311655987 69 Finds specific text formatting features, such as font types, font effects, and text flow characteristics. a 2311655987 69 Finds specific text formatting features, such as font types, font effects, and text flow characteristics. 5 53013 36 Click and choose the contents that you want to update. 5 53012 b8 Edit the contents of the component selected in the Navigator list. If the selection is a file, the file is opened for editing. If the selection is an index, the index dialog is opened. 5 53031 90 Inserts a new paragraph in the master document where you can enter text. You cannot insert text next to an existing text entry in the Navigator. 5 53020 b8 The Navigator lists the main components of the master document. If you rest the mouse pointer over a name of a sub-document in the list, the full path of the sub-document is displayed. 5 53033 14 Updates all indexes. 5 53035 15 Updates all contents. 5 53029 3c Inserts one or more existing files into the master document. 5 53034 12 Updates all links. 5 53015 a7 Saves a copy of the contents of the linked files in the master document. This ensures that the current contents are available when the linked files cannot be accessed. 5 53024 b8 Edit the contents of the component selected in the Navigator list. If the selection is a file, the file is opened for editing. If the selection is an index, the index dialog is opened. 5 53017 3c Moves the selection down one position in the Navigator list. 5 53030 27 Creates and inserts a new sub-document. 5 53032 26 Updates the contents of the selection. 5 53014 45 Inserts a file, an index, or a new document into the master document. 5 53075 32 Changes the link properties for the selected file. 5 53023 45 Inserts a file, an index, or a new document into the master document. 5 53022 36 Click and choose the contents that you want to update. 5 53025 2e Deletes the selection from the Navigator list. 5 53016 3a Moves the selection up one position in the Navigator list. 5 53026 41 Inserts an index or a table of contents into the master document. 11 .uno%3ALinkDialog c6 Lets you edit the properties of each link in the current document, including the path to the source file. This command is not available if the current document does not contain links to other files. 5 26060 c6 Lets you edit the properties of each link in the current document, including the path to the source file. This command is not available if the current document does not contain links to other files. a 1598063146 d1 Automatically updates the contents of the link when you open the file. Any changes made in the source file are then displayed in the file containing the link. Linked graphic files can only be updated manually. 10 .uno%3AEditLinks c6 Lets you edit the properties of each link in the current document, including the path to the source file. This command is not available if the current document does not contain links to other files. 12 .uno%3AManageLinks c6 Lets you edit the properties of each link in the current document, including the path to the source file. This command is not available if the current document does not contain links to other files. 5 20109 c6 Lets you edit the properties of each link in the current document, including the path to the source file. This command is not available if the current document does not contain links to other files. 5 34869 68 Double-click a link in the list to open a file dialog where you can select another object for this link. a 1598067238 99 Breaks the link between the source file and the current document. The most recently updated contents of the source file are kept in the current document. a 1598067237 2d Change the source file for the selected link. a 1598067235 7a Updates the selected link so that the most recently saved version of the linked file is displayed in the current document. 27 SO3%3AMODALDIALOG%3AMD_UPDATE_BASELINKS c6 Lets you edit the properties of each link in the current document, including the path to the source file. This command is not available if the current document does not contain links to other files. 5 27005 c6 Lets you edit the properties of each link in the current document, including the path to the source file. This command is not available if the current document does not contain links to other files. a 1598063147 37 Only updates the link when you click the Update button. 29 SO3%3AEDIT%3AMD_DDE_LINKEDIT%3AED_DDE_APP 36 Lists the application that last saved the source file. 2b SO3%3AEDIT%3AMD_DDE_LINKEDIT%3AED_DDE_TOPIC 22 Lists the path to the source file. 2a SO3%3AEDIT%3AMD_DDE_LINKEDIT%3AED_DDE_ITEM 6c Lists the section that the link refers to in the source file. If you want, you can enter a new section here. 4 6314 124 Allows you to edit plug-ins in your file. Choose this command to enable or disable this feature. When enabled, a check mark appears beside this command, and you find commands to edit the plug-in in its context menu. When disabled, you find commands to control the plug-in in its context menu. 14 .uno%3APlugInsActive 124 Allows you to edit plug-ins in your file. Choose this command to enable or disable this feature. When enabled, a check mark appears beside this command, and you find commands to edit the plug-in in its context menu. When disabled, you find commands to control the plug-in in its context menu. 4 5575 60 Lets you edit a selected object in your file that you inserted with the Insert - Object command. 5 27282 28 Resizes the object to the original size. 12 .uno%3AObjectMenue 60 Lets you edit a selected object in your file that you inserted with the Insert - Object command. 13 .uno%3AOriginalSize 28 Resizes the object to the original size. a 1598210578 2a Displays the border of the floating frame. a 1598212102 a7 Enter the path and the name of the file that you want to display in the floating frame. You can also click the ... button and locate the file that you want to display. a 1598216200 dc Enter the amount of vertical space that you want to leave between the top and bottom edges of the floating frame and the contents of the frame. Both documents inside and outside the floating frame must be HTML documents. a 1598214663 5d Locate the file that you want to display in the selected floating frame, and then click Open. 38 SFX2%3ARADIOBUTTON%3ATP_FRAMEPROPERTIES%3ARB_SCROLLINGON 2e Displays the scrollbar for the floating frame. 34 SFX2%3APUSHBUTTON%3ATP_FRAMEPROPERTIES%3ABT_FILEOPEN 5d Locate the file that you want to display in the selected floating frame, and then click Open. 3c SFX2%3ACHECKBOX%3ATP_FRAMEPROPERTIES%3ACB_MARGINWIDTHDEFAULT 1c Applies the default spacing. a 1598210580 27 Hides the border of the floating frame. 23 SFX2%3ATABPAGE%3ATP_FRAMEPROPERTIES a9 Changes the properties of the selected floating frame. Floating frames work best when they contain an html document, and when they are inserted in another html document. a 1598210573 2e Displays the scrollbar for the floating frame. 3a SFX2%3ANUMERICFIELD%3ATP_FRAMEPROPERTIES%3ANM_MARGINHEIGHT dc Enter the amount of vertical space that you want to leave between the top and bottom edges of the floating frame and the contents of the frame. Both documents inside and outside the floating frame must be HTML documents. a 1598210575 59 Mark this option if the currently active floating frame can have a scrollbar when needed. 3d SFX2%3ACHECKBOX%3ATP_FRAMEPROPERTIES%3ACB_MARGINHEIGHTDEFAULT 1c Applies the default spacing. 39 SFX2%3ANUMERICFIELD%3ATP_FRAMEPROPERTIES%3ANM_MARGINWIDTH e2 Enter the amount of horizontal space that you want to leave between the right and the left edges of the floating frame and the contents of the frame. Both documents inside and outside the floating frame must be HTML documents. 3a SFX2%3ARADIOBUTTON%3ATP_FRAMEPROPERTIES%3ARB_SCROLLINGAUTO 59 Mark this option if the currently active floating frame can have a scrollbar when needed. a 1598212100 7b Enter a name for the floating frame. The name cannot contain spaces, special characters, or begin with an underscore ( _ ). 39 SFX2%3ARADIOBUTTON%3ATP_FRAMEPROPERTIES%3ARB_FRMBORDER_ON 2a Displays the border of the floating frame. 3a SFX2%3ARADIOBUTTON%3ATP_FRAMEPROPERTIES%3ARB_FRMBORDER_OFF 27 Hides the border of the floating frame. a 1598211094 1c Applies the default spacing. a 1598210574 2b Hides the scrollbar for the floating frame. a 1598216202 e2 Enter the amount of horizontal space that you want to leave between the right and the left edges of the floating frame and the contents of the frame. Both documents inside and outside the floating frame must be HTML documents. 29 SFX2%3AEDIT%3ATP_FRAMEPROPERTIES%3AED_URL a7 Enter the path and the name of the file that you want to display in the floating frame. You can also click the ... button and locate the file that you want to display. 2f SFX2%3AEDIT%3ATP_FRAMEPROPERTIES%3AED_FRAMENAME 7b Enter a name for the floating frame. The name cannot contain spaces, special characters, or begin with an underscore ( _ ). 39 SFX2%3ARADIOBUTTON%3ATP_FRAMEPROPERTIES%3ARB_SCROLLINGOFF 2b Hides the scrollbar for the floating frame. 5 33938 53 Saves the image map in the MAP-CERN, MAP-NCSA or SIP StarView ImageMap file format. 5 33946 43 Adds an anchor point where you click on the outline of the hotspot. 5 33936 33 Applies the changes that you made to the image map. 5 33950 5e Disables or enables the hyperlink for the selected hotspot. A disabled hotspot is transparent. 5 33943 122 Draws a hotspot that is based on a freeform polygon. Click this icon and move to where you want to draw the hotspot. Drag a freeform line and release to close the shape. After, you can enter the Address and the Text for the hotspot, and then select the Frame where you want the URL to open. 26 SVX%3AFLOATINGWINDOW%3ARID_SVXDLG_IMAP 93 Allows you to attach URLs to specific areas, called hotspots, on a graphic or a group of graphics. An image map is a group of one or more hotspots. 5 33941 b3 Draws an elliptical hotspot where you drag in the graphic. After, you can enter the Address and the Text for the hotspot, and then select the Frame where you want the URL to open. 5 33937 5b Loads an existing image map in the MAP-CERN, MAP-NCSA or SIP StarView ImageMap file format. a 2318700545 55 Enter the URL for the file that you want to open when you click the selected hotspot. 5 33940 b3 Draws a rectangular hotspot where you drag in the graphic. After, you can enter the Address and the Text for the hotspot, and then select the Frame where you want the URL to open. 15 .uno%3AImageMapDialog 93 Allows you to attach URLs to specific areas, called hotspots, on a graphic or a group of graphics. An image map is a group of one or more hotspots. 5 33944 4f Lets you change the shape of the selected hotspot by editing the anchor points. 5 33947 22 Deletes the selected anchor point. 5 10371 93 Allows you to attach URLs to specific areas, called hotspots, on a graphic or a group of graphics. An image map is a group of one or more hotspots. 5 33952 3c Allows you to define the properties of the selected hotspot. 5 33939 2f Selects a hotspot in the image map for editing. 5 33945 43 Lets you move the individual anchor points of the selected hotspot. 5 33951 53 Lets you assign a macro that runs when you click the selected hotspot in a browser. 5 33982 0 a 2318698497 59 Enter the text that you want to display when the mouse rests on the hotspot in a browser. 5 33942 1bb Draws a polygonal hotspot in the graphic. Click this icon, drag in the graphic, and then click to define one side of the polygon. Move to where you want to place the end of the next side, and then click. Repeat until you have drawn all of the sides of the polygon. When you are finished, double-click to close the polygon. After, you can enter the Address and the Text for the hotspot, and then select the Frame where you want the URL to open. a 1244989443 1b Enter a name for the image. a 1244989442 55 Enter the URL for the file that you want to open when you click the selected hotspot. a 1244991489 a0 Enter the name of the target frame that you want to open the URL in. You can also select a standard frame name that is recognized by all browsers from the list. a 1244987392 2e Lists the properties for the selected hotspot. a 1244989441 59 Enter the text that you want to display when the mouse rests on the hotspot in a browser. a 1244989956 24 Enter a description for the hotspot. 12 .uno%3AChangesMenu 48 Lists the commands that are available for tracking changes in your file. 5 21825 4b Tracks each change that is made in the current document by author and date. 16 .uno%3ATraceChangeMode 4b Tracks each change that is made in the current document by author and date. 13 .uno%3ATrackChanges 4b Tracks each change that is made in the current document by author and date. 5 26238 4b Tracks each change that is made in the current document by author and date. 1d .uno%3AProtectTraceChangeMode 87 Prevents a user from deactivating the record changes feature, or from accepting or rejecting changes unless the user enters a password. 5 26084 87 Prevents a user from deactivating the record changes feature, or from accepting or rejecting changes unless the user enters a password. 5 58946 87 Prevents a user from deactivating the record changes feature, or from accepting or rejecting changes unless the user enters a password. 19 .uno%3AShowTrackedChanges 20 Shows or hides recorded changes. 5 26239 20 Shows or hides recorded changes. 5 21826 20 Shows or hides recorded changes. 12 .uno%3AShowChanges 20 Shows or hides recorded changes. 5 34045 28 Enter a comment for the recorded change. 5 26259 28 Enter a comment for the recorded change. 5 21827 28 Enter a comment for the recorded change. 1c .uno%3ACommentChangeTracking 28 Enter a comment for the recorded change. 14 .uno%3ACommentChange 28 Enter a comment for the recorded change. 5 26258 22 Accept or reject recorded changes. 14 .uno%3AAcceptChanges 22 Accept or reject recorded changes. 1b .uno%3AAcceptTrackedChanges 22 Accept or reject recorded changes. 5 21829 22 Accept or reject recorded changes. 5 34027 4a Rejects all of the changes and removes the highlighting from the document. 5 53056 29 Edit the comment for the selected change. 5 21837 59 Accepts the selected change and removes the highlighting from the change in the document. 5 34026 59 Rejects the selected change and removes the highlighting from the change in the document. 5 58987 31 Lists the date and time that the change was made. 5 34063 29 Edit the comment for the selected change. 5 58989 82 Sorts the list in a descending order according to the position of the changes in the document. This is the default sorting method. 5 53053 4a Sorts the list according to the comments that are attached to the changes. 5 34024 59 Accepts the selected change and removes the highlighting from the change in the document. 5 53050 2f Sorts the list according to the type of change. 5 53052 2e Sorts the list according to the date and time. 5 53051 27 Sorts the list according to the Author. 5 21838 59 Rejects the selected change and removes the highlighting from the change in the document. 5 34025 4a Accepts all of the changes and removes the highlighting from the document. 5 58988 33 Lists the comments that are attached to the change. 5 58990 29 Edit the comment for the selected change. 5 34022 24 Accept or reject individual changes. 5 34023 b0 Lists the changes that were recorded in the document. When you select an entry in the list, the change is highlighted in the document. To sort the list, click a column heading. 5 58986 23 Lists the user who made the change. 5 58985 31 Lists the changes that were made in the document. a 2568973840 4f Filters the comments of the changes according to the keyword(s) that you enter. a 2569006604 4f Filters the comments of the changes according to the keyword(s) that you enter. 5 34013 50 Filters the list of changes according to the date and the time that you specify. 5 34043 4f Filters the comments of the changes according to the keyword(s) that you enter. 5 34012 3e Enters the current date and time into the corresponding boxes. 5 34015 3e Enters the current date and time into the corresponding boxes. 5 34018 3b Select the range of cells that you want to use as a filter. 5 34020 4f Filters the comments of the changes according to the keyword(s) that you enter. 5 34061 4f Filters the comments of the changes according to the keyword(s) that you enter. 5 34010 50 Filters the list of changes according to the date and the time that you specify. 5 34017 5e Filters the list of changes according to the name of the author that you select from the list. 5 34021 3b Select the range of cells that you want to use as a filter. 5 34008 50 Filters the list of changes according to the date and the time that you specify. 5 34019 3b Select the range of cells that you want to use as a filter. 5 34011 50 Filters the list of changes according to the date and the time that you specify. 5 34062 4f Filters the comments of the changes according to the keyword(s) that you enter. 5 34009 50 Filters the list of changes according to the date and the time that you specify. 5 34014 50 Filters the list of changes according to the date and the time that you specify. 5 34016 5e Filters the list of changes according to the name of the author that you select from the list. 4 6587 92 Imports changes made to copies of the same document into the original document. Changes made to footnotes, headers, frames and fields are ignored. 15 .uno%3AMergeDocuments 92 Imports changes made to copies of the same document into the original document. Changes made to footnotes, headers, frames and fields are ignored. 17 .uno%3ACompareDocuments 3e Compares the current document with a document that you select. 4 6586 3e Compares the current document with a document that you select. 22 BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_URL a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 5 34780 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table. 14 .uno%3ABib%2FMapping bd Lets you map the column headings to data fields from a different data source. To define a different data source for your bibliography, click the Data Source button on the record Object Bar. 5 34797 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table. 26 BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_CUSTOM3 a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 19 .uno%3ABib%2FInsertRecord 2c Inserts a new record into the current table. 13 .uno%3ABib%2Fsource 73 Lists the available tables in the current database. Click a name in the list to display the records for that table. 5 34777 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table. 5 34799 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table. 5 34775 a5 Select the type of record that you want to create. $[officename] inserts a number in the Type column of the record that corresponds to the type that you select here. 2c BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_ORGANIZATIONS a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 5 34776 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table. 5 34770 bd Lets you map the column headings to data fields from a different data source. To define a different data source for your bibliography, click the Data Source button on the record Object Bar. 17 .uno%3ABib%2FautoFilter 96 Long-click to select the data field that you want to search using the term that you entered in the Search Key box. You can only search one data field. 25 BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_EDITOR a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 5 34788 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table. 1b .uno%3ABib%2FstandardFilter 4b Use the Standard Filter to refine and to combine AutoFilter search options. 24 BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_TITLE a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 23 BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_ISBN a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 5 34778 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table. 26 BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_CUSTOM1 a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 5 34793 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table. 5 34785 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table. 19 .uno%3ABib%2FDeleteRecord 1b Deletes the current record. 25 BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_SCHOOL a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 19 .uno%3ABib%2FremoveFilter 47 To display all of the records in a table, click the Remove Filter icon. 2b BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_HOWPUBLISHED a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 24 BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_MONTH a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 26 BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_CUSTOM2 a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 26 BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_CUSTOM5 a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 29 BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_REPORTTYPE a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 5 34783 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table. 5 34786 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table. 5 34790 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table. 5 38196 24 Go to the first record in the table. 5 34781 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table. 29 BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_IDENTIFIER a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 5 34787 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table. 5 38198 23 Go to the next record in the table. 5 34779 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table. 5 10610 1c Deletes the selected record. 25 BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_AUTHOR a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 5 38199 23 Go to the last record in the table. 5 34782 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table. 5 34805 48 Insert, delete, edit, and organize records in the bibliography database. 25 BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_VOLUME a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 5 34774 6a Enter a short name for the record. The short name appears in the Identifier column in the list of records. 2c BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_AUTHORITYTYPE a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 12 .uno%3ABib%2Fquery 17e Type the information that you want to search for, and then press Enter. To change the filter options for the search, long-click the AutoFilter icon, and then select a different data field. You can use wildcards such as % or * for any number of characters, and _ or ? for one character in your search. To display all of the records in the table, clear this box, and then press Enter. 5 38197 27 Go to the previous record in the table. 28 BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_PUBLISHER a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 23 BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_NOTE a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 5 34789 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table. 26 BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_CHAPTER a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 5 34798 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table. 26 BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_ADDRESS a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 5 34792 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table. 2a BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_INSTITUTION a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 25 BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_SERIES a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 24 BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_PAGES a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 25 BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_NUMBER a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 5 34796 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table. 5 34784 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table. 26 BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_JOURNAL a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 28 BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_BOOKTITLE a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 26 BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_CUSTOM4 a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 1c .uno%3ABibliographyComponent 48 Insert, delete, edit, and organize records in the bibliography database. 5 38201 4d Type the number of the record that you want to display, and then press Enter. 23 BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_YEAR a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 26 BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_EDITION a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 5 34794 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table. 25 BIB_LISTBOX_RID_DLG_MAPPING_LB_ANNOTE a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography. 5 38200 2c Inserts a new record into the current table. 16 .uno%3ABib%2Fsdbsource 35 Select the data source for the bibliography database. 5 10880 48 Insert, delete, edit, and organize records in the bibliography database. 5 34791 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table. 5 34795 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table. a 1237588505 6c In columns view layout you see pages in a given number of columns side by side. Enter the number of columns. a 1237588500 5f Enter the zoom factor at which you want to display the document. Enter a percentage in the box. 5 10000 37 Reduces or enlarges the screen display of %PRODUCTNAME. 5 34028 33 Displays the document at two times its actual size. a 1237582360 6c In columns view layout you see pages in a given number of columns side by side. Enter the number of columns. a 1237582352 28 Displays the entire page on your screen. b .uno%3AZoom 37 Reduces or enlarges the screen display of %PRODUCTNAME. 2d SVX%3ARADIOBUTTON%3ARID_SVXDLG_ZOOM%3ABTN_200 33 Displays the document at two times its actual size. a 1237582358 59 The automatic view layout displays pages side by side, as many as the zoom factor allows. 5 34034 6a Displays the complete width of the document page. The top and bottom edges of the page may not be visible. 5 34031 30 Displays the document at 75% of its actual size. a 1237588500 5f Enter the zoom factor at which you want to display the document. Enter a percentage in the box. 5 34030 29 Displays the document at its actual size. 5 30264 29 Displays the document at its actual size. 5 34035 28 Displays the entire page on your screen. a 1237582359 56 The single page view layout displays pages beneath each other, but never side by side. a 1237582355 5f Enter the zoom factor at which you want to display the document. Enter a percentage in the box. 5 34032 31 Displays the document at half of its actual size. 2c SVX%3ARADIOBUTTON%3ARID_SVXDLG_ZOOM%3ABTN_75 30 Displays the document at 75% of its actual size. 5 34029 3e Displays the document at one and a half times its actual size. 2d SVX%3ARADIOBUTTON%3ARID_SVXDLG_ZOOM%3ABTN_150 3e Displays the document at one and a half times its actual size. a 1237582353 6a Displays the complete width of the document page. The top and bottom edges of the page may not be visible. a 1237582355 5f Enter the zoom factor at which you want to display the document. Enter a percentage in the box. 2c SVX%3ARADIOBUTTON%3ARID_SVXDLG_ZOOM%3ABTN_50 31 Displays the document at half of its actual size. a 1237582874 83 In book mode view layout you see two pages side by side as in an open book. The first page is a right page with an odd page number. a 1237582351 45 Resizes the display to fit the width of the text in the document at . 5 34033 45 Resizes the display to fit the width of the text in the document at . a 1237582354 29 Displays the document at its actual size. 19 .uno%3AFunctionBarVisible 20 Shows or hides the Standard Bar. 1a .uno%3AShowImeStatusWindow 3b Shows or hides the Input Method Engine (IME) status window. 4 6680 3b Shows or hides the Input Method Engine (IME) status window. 15 .uno%3AToolBarVisible 1d Shows or hides the Tools bar. 17 .uno%3AStatusBarVisible 3f Shows or hides the Status Bar at the bottom edge of the window. 15 .uno%3ATaskBarVisible 3f Shows or hides the Status Bar at the bottom edge of the window. 4 5920 3f Shows or hides the Status Bar at the bottom edge of the window. 4 5931 3f Shows or hides the Status Bar at the bottom edge of the window. 11 .uno%3AFullScreen 7b Shows or hides the menus and toolbars in Writer or Calc. To exit the full screen mode, click the Full Screen On/Off button. 5 33150 7d In Writer and Calc, you can also use the shortcut keys CommandCtrl+Shift+J to switch between the normal and full screen mode. 4 5627 7b Shows or hides the menus and toolbars in Writer or Calc. To exit the full screen mode, click the Full Screen On/Off button. 28 SFX2%3AMODALDIALOG%3ADLG_SFX_QUERYDELETE 21 Confirms or cancels the deletion. 31 SFX2%3APUSHBUTTON%3ADLG_SFX_QUERYDELETE%3ABTN_YES 2a Performs the deletion in the current file. 30 SFX2%3APUSHBUTTON%3ADLG_SFX_QUERYDELETE%3ABTN_NO 2a Rejects the deletion for the current file. 31 SFX2%3APUSHBUTTON%3ADLG_SFX_QUERYDELETE%3ABTN_ALL 2c Performs the deletion in all selected files. 13 .uno%3AColorControl 8b Show or hides the Color Bar. To modify or change the color table that is displayed, choose Format - Area, and then click on the Colors tab. 5 10417 8b Show or hides the Color Bar. To modify or change the color table that is displayed, choose Format - Area, and then click on the Colors tab. 5 33887 145 Click the color that you want to use. To change the fill color of an object in the current file, select the object and then click a color. To change the line color of the selected object, right-click a color. To change the color of text in a text object, double-click the text-object, select the text, and then click a color. 18 .cmd%3ARestoreVisibility aa Choose View - Toolbars - Reset to reset the toolbars to their default context sensitive behavior. Now some toolbars will be shown automatically, dependent on the context. 18 .uno%3AAvailableToolbars 2a Opens a submenu to show and hide toolbars. 4 6698 2a Opens a submenu to show and hide toolbars. 5 11097 2c Delete all comments in the current document. 5 11094 1b Delete the current comment. 5 26276 12 Inserts a comment. 16 .uno%3AShowAnnotations 49 Use View - Comments to show or hide all comments (not available in Calc). 17 .uno%3AInsertAnnotation 12 Inserts a comment. 5 22501 3b Delete all comments by this author in the current document. 5 22502 2c Delete all comments in the current document. 5 22500 1b Delete the current comment. 5 26478 1b Delete the current comment. 5 11100 3b Delete all comments by this author in the current document. b .uno%3AScan 2b Inserts a scanned image into your document. 5 10330 2b Inserts a scanned image into your document. 5 10331 29 Selects the scanner that you want to use. 12 .uno%3ATwainSelect 29 Selects the scanner that you want to use. 14 .uno%3ATwainTransfer 82 Scans an image, and then inserts the result into the document. The scanning dialog is provided by the manufacturer of the scanner. 5 10332 82 Scans an image, and then inserts the result into the document. The scanning dialog is provided by the manufacturer of the scanner. 5 10503 34 Inserts special characters from the installed fonts. a SID_BULLET 34 Inserts special characters from the installed fonts. 5 33876 4a Click the special character(s) that you want to insert, and then click OK. d .uno%3ABullet 34 Inserts special characters from the installed fonts. a 1237750292 4b Clears the current selection of special characters that you want to insert. 13 .uno%3AInsertSymbol 34 Inserts special characters from the installed fonts. a 1237749260 4c Select a font to display the special characters that are associated with it. a 1237749279 2f Select a Unicode category for the current font. 16 .uno%3AInsertHyperlink 6b Shows or hides the Hyperlink Bar, where you can insert and edit URLs or search the Internet using keywords. 5 10360 6b Shows or hides the Hyperlink Bar, where you can insert and edit URLs or search the Internet using keywords. 5 33970 2c Inserts the selected graphic file as a link. 5 33345 30 Displays a preview of the selected graphic file. 5 33971 30 Displays a preview of the selected graphic file. 5 33344 2c Inserts the selected graphic file as a link. 5 10241 2c Inserts a picture into the current document. 5 33018 27 Select the frame style for the graphic. 14 .uno%3AInsertGraphic 2c Inserts a picture into the current document. 11 .uno%3AObjectMenu 62 Inserts an object into your document. For movies and sounds, use Insert - Movie and Sound instead. 2c so3_CheckBox_MD_INSERT_OLEOBJECT_CB_FILELINK a2 Enable this checkbox to insert the OLE object as a link to the original file. If this checkbox is not enabled, the OLE object will be embedded into your document. 4 5561 6c Inserts an OLE object into the current document. The OLE object is inserted as a link or an embedded object. 2e SO3%3AEDIT%3AMD_INSERT_OLEOBJECT%3AED_FILEPATH 5f Enter the name of the file that you want to link or embed, or click Search, to locate the file. 13 .uno%3AInsertObject 6c Inserts an OLE object into the current document. The OLE object is inserted as a link or an embedded object. 37 SO3%3ARADIOBUTTON%3AMD_INSERT_OLEOBJECT%3ARB_NEW_OBJECT 42 Creates a new OLE object based on the object type that you select. 27 SO3%3AMODALDIALOG%3AMD_INSERT_OLEOBJECT 6c Inserts an OLE object into the current document. The OLE object is inserted as a link or an embedded object. 35 SO3%3APUSHBUTTON%3AMD_INSERT_OLEOBJECT%3ABTN_FILEPATH 3d Locate the file that you want to insert, and then click Open. 33 SO3%3ALISTBOX%3AMD_INSERT_OLEOBJECT%3ALB_OBJECTTYPE 34 Select the type of document that you want to create. 3c SO3%3ARADIOBUTTON%3AMD_INSERT_OLEOBJECT%3ARB_OBJECT_FROMFILE 2c Creates an OLE object from an existing file. 2b SO3%3AMODALDIALOG%3AMD_INSERT_OBJECT_PLUGIN 2c Inserts a plug-in into the current document. 13 .uno%3AInsertPlugin 2c Inserts a plug-in into the current document. 38 SO3%3APUSHBUTTON%3AMD_INSERT_OBJECT_PLUGIN%3ABTN_FILEURL 40 Locate the plug-in that you want to insert, and then click Open. 4 5672 2c Inserts a plug-in into the current document. 42 SO3%3AMULTILINEEDIT%3AMD_INSERT_OBJECT_PLUGIN%3AED_PLUGINS_OPTIONS 4d Enter the parameters for the plug-in using the format parameter1="some text". 31 SO3%3AEDIT%3AMD_INSERT_OBJECT_PLUGIN%3AED_FILEURL 63 Enter the URL for the plug-in or click Browse, and then locate the plug-in that you want to insert. 4 5676 2f Inserts a sound file into the current document. 12 .uno%3AInsertSound 2f Inserts a sound file into the current document. 12 .uno%3AInsertVideo 2f Inserts a video file into the current document. 4 5677 2f Inserts a video file into the current document. 5 26063 2c Inserts a formula into the current document. 5 27106 2c Inserts a formula into the current document. 1b .uno%3AInsertObjectStarMath 2c Inserts a formula into the current document. 11 .uno%3AInsertMath 2c Inserts a formula into the current document. 4 5563 c4 Inserts a floating frame into the current document. Floating frames are used in HTML documents to display the contents of another file. Floating frames are not supported by Netscape Navigator 4.x. 20 .uno%3AInsertObjectFloatingFrame c4 Inserts a floating frame into the current document. Floating frames are used in HTML documents to display the contents of another file. Floating frames are not supported by Netscape Navigator 4.x. 4 6660 6a Lists the databases that are registered in %PRODUCTNAME and lets you manage the contents of the databases. 5 26335 6a Lists the databases that are registered in %PRODUCTNAME and lets you manage the contents of the databases. 1c .uno%3AViewDataSourceBrowser 6a Lists the databases that are registered in %PRODUCTNAME and lets you manage the contents of the databases. 11 .uno%3ADataImport 6a Lists the databases that are registered in %PRODUCTNAME and lets you manage the contents of the databases. 12 .uno%3AGraphicMenu 38 Select the source for a picture that you want to insert. 16 .uno%3AResetAttributes 50 Removes direct formatting and formatting by character styles from the selection. 1d .uno%3AStandardTextAttributes 50 Removes direct formatting and formatting by character styles from the selection. 11 .uno%3ASetDefault 50 Removes direct formatting and formatting by character styles from the selection. 5 10456 50 Removes direct formatting and formatting by character styles from the selection. 5 26296 50 Removes direct formatting and formatting by character styles from the selection. 5 20469 50 Removes direct formatting and formatting by character styles from the selection. 5 26067 50 Removes direct formatting and formatting by character styles from the selection. 11 .uno%3AFontDialog 45 Changes the font and the font formatting for the selected characters. 5 10296 45 Changes the font and the font formatting for the selected characters. 9 704631208 59 Enter the name of an installed font that you want to use, or select a font from the list. 9 704631210 2d Select the formatting that you want to apply. 9 704630888 2d Select the formatting that you want to apply. 9 704636522 6c Enter or select the font size that you want to apply. For scalable fonts, you can also enter decimal values. 9 704630390 9c Sets the language that the spellchecker uses for the selected text or the text that you type. Available language modules have a check mark in front of them. 9 704636844 6c Enter or select the font size that you want to apply. For scalable fonts, you can also enter decimal values. 9 704636542 6c Enter or select the font size that you want to apply. For scalable fonts, you can also enter decimal values. 9 704630906 59 Enter the name of an installed font that you want to use, or select a font from the list. 9 704630896 59 Enter the name of an installed font that you want to use, or select a font from the list. 9 704636532 6c Enter or select the font size that you want to apply. For scalable fonts, you can also enter decimal values. 9 704630908 2d Select the formatting that you want to apply. 5 34160 3b Specify the formatting and the font that you want to apply. 9 704630400 9c Sets the language that the spellchecker uses for the selected text or the text that you type. Available language modules have a check mark in front of them. 9 704630380 9c Sets the language that the spellchecker uses for the selected text or the text that you type. Available language modules have a check mark in front of them. 9 704630898 2d Select the formatting that you want to apply. 9 704630702 9c Sets the language that the spellchecker uses for the selected text or the text that you type. Available language modules have a check mark in front of them. 9 704630886 59 Enter the name of an installed font that you want to use, or select a font from the list. 5 34161 2e Specify the font effects that you want to use. 9 704646863 e1 Select a relief effect to apply to the selected text. The embossed relief makes the characters appear as if they are raised above the page. The engraved relief makes the characters appear as if they are pressed into the page. 9 704646886 25 Select the color for the underlining. 9 704646898 53 Select a character to display over or below the entire length of the selected text. 9 704646861 e1 Select a relief effect to apply to the selected text. The embossed relief makes the characters appear as if they are raised above the page. The engraved relief makes the characters appear as if they are pressed into the page. 9 704644327 3d Applies the selected effect only to words and ignores spaces. 9 704646880 24 Select the color for the overlining. c .uno%3AColor d0 Click to apply the current font color to the selected characters. You can also click here, and then drag a selection to change the text color. Click the arrow next to the icon to open the Font color toolbar. 9 704646884 7d Select the underlining style that you want to apply. To apply the underlining to words only, select the Individual Words box. 9 704644816 5b Displays the outline of the selected characters. This effect does not work with every font. 9 704646900 2c Specify where to display the emphasis marks. 9 704646882 33 Select a strikethrough style for the selected text. 9 704646858 96 Sets the color for the selected text. If you select Automatic, the text color is set to black for light backgrounds and to white for dark backgrounds. 5 10537 d0 Click to apply the current font color to the selected characters. You can also click here, and then drag a selection to change the text color. Click the arrow next to the icon to open the Font color toolbar. 9 704646878 7b Select the overlining style that you want to apply. To apply the overlining to words only, select the Individual Words box. 9 704630414 96 Sets the color for the selected text. If you select Automatic, the text color is set to black for light backgrounds and to white for dark backgrounds. f .uno%3AOverline 81 Overlines or removes overlining from the selected text. If the cursor is not in a word, the new text that you enter is overlined. 5 10017 d0 Click to apply the current font color to the selected characters. You can also click here, and then drag a selection to change the text color. Click the arrow next to the icon to open the Font color toolbar. 10 .uno%3AFontColor d0 Click to apply the current font color to the selected characters. You can also click here, and then drag a selection to change the text color. Click the arrow next to the icon to open the Font color toolbar. 9 704644817 4b Adds a shadow that casts below and to the right of the selected characters. 9 701383705 32 Changes the font color of negative numbers to red. 9 701383706 6c Inserts a separator between thousands. The type of separator that is used depends on your language settings. 9 701384732 50 Enter a comment for the selected number format, and then click outside this box. 9 701383715 4b Uses the same number format as the cells containing the data for the chart. 9 701386273 71 Select a currency, and then scroll to the top of the Format list to view the formatting options for the currency. 5 33786 38 Specify the formatting options for the selected cell(s). 5 33917 23 Deletes the selected number format. 9 701388822 3c Enter the number of decimal places that you want to display. 1e .uno%3ATableNumberFormatDialog 38 Specify the formatting options for the selected cell(s). 5 34003 2d Adds a comment to the selected number format. 5 33916 4a Adds the number format code that you entered to the user-defined category. 5 20445 38 Specify the formatting options for the selected cell(s). 5 34004 49 Select how you want the contents of the selected cell(s) to be displayed. 9 701386253 100 Specifies the language setting for the selected fields. With the language set to Automatic, $[officename] automatically applies the number formats associated with the system default language. Select any language to fix the settings for the selected fields. 9 701388824 4c Enter the maximum number of zeroes to display in front of the decimal point. 9 701386249 56 Select a category from the list, and then select a formatting style in the Format box. 9 701384718 5c Displays the number format code for the selected format. You can also enter a custom format. 19 .uno%3AInsertHyperlinkDlg 38 Assigns a new hyperlink or edits the selected hyperlink. 9 878364736 3a Enter the text that you want to display for the hyperlink. 9 878364724 4c Enter a URL for the file that you want to open when you click the hyperlink. 9 878367292 3e Locate the file that you want to link to, and then click Open. 9 878366781 71 Enter the name of the frame that you want the linked file to open in, or select a predefined frame from the list. 9 878367291 3c Specify an event that triggers when you click the hyperlink. 9 878366266 c1 Select a formatting style to use for unvisited links from the list. To add or modify a style in this list, close this dialog, and click the Styles and Formatting icon on the Formatting toolbar. 5 20314 38 Assigns a new hyperlink or edits the selected hyperlink. 5 53190 38 Assigns a new hyperlink or edits the selected hyperlink. 9 878364738 1f Enter a name for the hyperlink. 9 878366264 bf Select a formatting style to use for visited links from the list. To add or modify a style in this list, close this dialog, and click the Styles and Formatting icon on the Formatting toolbar. 9 704666417 9e Enter the amount by which you want to raise or to lower the selected text in relation to the baseline. One hundred percent is equal to the height of the font. 9 704663361 b2 Specifies the spacing between the characters of the selected text. For expanded or condensed spacing, enter the amount that you want to expand or condense the text in the by box. 9 704660786 6a Automatically sets the amount by which the selected text is raised or lowered in relation to the baseline. 9 704660270 2c Removes superscript or subscript formatting. 9 704660269 52 Reduces the font size of the selected text and raises the text above the baseline. 9 704666428 66 Enter the percentage of the font width by which to horizontally stretch or compress the selected text. 9 704660271 52 Reduces the font size of the selected text and lowers the text below the baseline. 9 704660804 4c Automatically adjust the character spacing for specific letter combinations. 5 10294 52 Reduces the font size of the selected text and raises the text above the baseline. 5 34162 44 Specify the position, scaling, rotation, and spacing for characters. 5 10295 52 Reduces the font size of the selected text and lowers the text below the baseline. 9 704666420 50 Enter the amount by which you want to reduce the font size of the selected text. 9 704666435 65 Enter the amount by which you want to expand or condense the character spacing for the selected text. 9 704679838 83 Select the character to define the end of the double-lined area. If you want to choose a custom character, select Other Characters. 9 704677265 5a Allows you to write in double lines in the area that you selected in the current document. 9 704679836 85 Select the character to define the start of the double-lined area. If you want to choose a custom character, select Other Characters. 9 704726530 88 Prevents commas and periods from breaking the line. Instead, these characters are added to the end of the line, even in the page margin. 9 704726532 ef Prevents the characters in the list from starting or ending a line. The characters are relocated to either the previous or the next line. To edit the list of restricted characters, choose Tools - Options - Language Settings - Asian Layout. 9 704726535 3c Inserts a space between Asian, Latin and complex characters. 16 .uno%3AParagraphDialog 4c Modifies the format of the current paragraph, such as indents and alignment. 4 5550 4c Modifies the format of the current paragraph, such as indents and alignment. 5 10297 4c Modifies the format of the current paragraph, such as indents and alignment. 9 700812840 4a Specify the amount of space to leave between lines of text in a paragraph. 9 700810288 51 Enter the amount of space that you want to leave above the selected paragraph(s). 9 700815885 12a Indents the first line of a paragraph by the amount that you enter. To create a hanging indent enter a positive value for "Before text" and a negative value for "First line". To indent the first line of a paragraph that uses numbering or bullets, choose "Format - Bullets and Numbering - Position". 5 33793 3d Sets the indenting and the spacing options for the paragraph. 9 700815915 2c Enter the value to use for the line spacing. 9 700815887 184 Enter the amount of space that you want to indent the paragraph from the page margin. If you want the paragraph to extend into the page margin, enter a negative number. In Left-to-Right languages, the right edge of the paragraph is indented with respect to the right page margin. In Right-to-Left languages, the left edge of the paragraph is indented with respect to the left page margin. 9 700815914 2c Enter the value to use for the line spacing. 9 700815893 51 Enter the amount of space that you want to leave above the selected paragraph(s). 9 700815895 51 Enter the amount of space that you want to leave below the selected paragraph(s). 9 700815883 184 Enter the amount of space that you want to indent the paragraph from the page margin. If you want the paragraph to extend into the page margin, enter a negative number. In Left-to-Right languages, the left edge of the paragraph is indented with respect to the left page margin. In Right-to-Left languages, the right edge of the paragraph is indented with respect to the right page margin. 9 700748338 3c Adds the tab stop that you defined to the current paragraph. 9 700744218 63 Aligns the decimal point of a number to the center of the tab stop and text to the left of the tab. 9 700744216 2e Aligns the center of the text to the tab stop. 9 700744236 56 Allows you to specify a character to fill the empty space to the left of the tab stop. 9 700744214 63 Aligns the right edge of the text to the tab stop and extends the text to the left of the tab stop. 9 700744212 53 Aligns the left edge of the text to the tab stop and extends the text to the right. 9 700744232 5c Inserts no fill characters, or removes existing fill characters to the left of the tab stop. 9 700744234 3e Fills the empty space to the left of the tab stop with dashes. 9 700745756 4e Enter a character that you want the decimal tab to use as a decimal separator. 5 33782 2e Set the position of a tab stop in a paragraph. 9 700745773 56 Allows you to specify a character to fill the empty space to the left of the tab stop. 9 700744233 3c Fills the empty space to the left of the tab stop with dots. 9 700744235 41 Draws a line to fill the empty space to the left of the tab stop. 9 700748340 80 Removes all of the tab stops that you defined under Position. Sets Left tab stops at regular intervals as the default tab stops. 9 700753418 fa Select a tab stop type, enter a new measurement, and then click New. If you want, you can also specify the measurement units to use for the tab (cm for centimeter, or " for inches). Existing tabs to the left of the first tab that you set are removed. 9 700796437 6b Click the border style that you want to apply. The style is applied to the borders selected in the preview. 9 700799522 1e Enter the width of the shadow. 5 33783 43 Sets the border options for the selected objects in Writer or Calc. 9 700799540 63 Enter the distance that you want to have between the left border and the contents of the selection. 9 700796438 46 Select the line color that you want to use for the selected border(s). 9 700796452 1e Select a color for the shadow. 9 700793915 5f Applies the same spacing to contents setting to all four borders when you enter a new distance. 5 33874 2a Select a predefined border style to apply. 5 33875 2e Click a shadow style for the selected borders. 9 700799544 62 Enter the distance that you want to have between the top border and the contents of the selection. 9 700799542 64 Enter the distance that you want to have between the right border and the contents of the selection. 9 700799546 65 Enter the distance that you want to have between the bottom border and the contents of the selection. 5 34186 62 Click the color that you want to use as a background. To remove a background color, click No Fill. 9 700727835 43 Select this option, and then click a location in the position grid. 9 700730914 38 Links to or embeds the graphic file in the current file. 9 700728342 38 Links to or embeds the graphic file in the current file. 9 700727834 53 Repeats the graphic so that it covers the entire background of the selected object. 9 700727833 4b Stretches the graphic to fill the entire background of the selected object. 5 33784 24 Set the background color or graphic. 9 700733988 38 Links to or embeds the graphic file in the current file. 5 33868 62 Click the color that you want to use as a background. To remove a background color, click No Fill. 9 700728343 34 Displays or hides a preview of the selected graphic. 5 33871 43 Select this option, and then click a location in the position grid. 9 700730912 38 Links to or embeds the graphic file in the current file. 9 700730881 35 Select the type of background that you want to apply. 9 700731924 52 Locate the graphic file that you want to use as a background, and then click Open. 9 703775262 2d Aligns the paragraph to the left page margin. 9 703778396 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled. 36 SVX_LISTBOX_RID_SVXPAGE_EXT_PARAGRAPH_LB_TEXTDIRECTION 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled. 9 703778354 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled. 9 703775263 2e Aligns the paragraph to the right page margin. 9 703775264 32 Centers the contents of the paragraph on the page. 9 877874749 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled. 9 703775795 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled. 9 703775265 3f Aligns the paragraph to the left and to the right page margins. 9 878218796 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled. 5 33795 44 Sets the alignment of the paragraph relative to the margins of page. 9 704614934 32 Returns the selected graphic to its original size. 9 704616976 39 Enter the height of the selected graphic as a percentage. 9 704616981 39 Enter the width for the selected graphic as a percentage. 9 704616974 151 If the Keep Scale option is selected, enter a positive amount to trim the bottom of the graphic, or a negative amount to add white space below the graphic. If the Keep image size option is selected, enter a positive amount to increase the vertical scale of the graphic, or a negative amount to decrease the vertical scale of the graphic. 9 704616975 28 Enter a height for the selected graphic. 9 704616977 161 If the Keep Scale option is selected, enter a positive amount to trim the left edge of the graphic, or a negative amount to add white space to the left of the graphic. If the Keep image size option is selected, enter a positive amount to increase the horizontal scale of the graphic, or a negative amount to decrease the horizontal scale of the graphic. 9 704616980 27 Enter a width for the selected graphic. 9 704610840 68 Maintains the original scale of the graphic when you crop, so that only the size of the graphic changes. 9 704616978 163 If the Keep Scale option is selected, enter a positive amount to trim the right edge of the graphic, or a negative amount to add white space to the right of the graphic. If the Keep image size option is selected, enter a positive amount to increase the horizontal scale of the graphic, or a negative amount to decrease the horizontal scale of the graphic. 9 704610839 123 Maintains the original size of the graphic when you crop, so that only the scale of the graphic changes. To reduce the scale of the graphic, select this option and enter negative values in the cropping boxes. To increase the scale of the graphic, enter positive values in the cropping boxes. 9 704616979 14e If the Keep Scale option is selected, enter a positive amount to trim the top of the graphic, or a negative amount to add white space above the graphic. If the Keep image size option is selected, enter a positive amount to increase the vertical scale of the graphic, or a negative amount to decrease the vertical scale of the graphic. 9 541248011 3c Describes the relevant formatting used in the current style. 5 33074 27 Set the options for the selected style. 9 541249032 7f Displays the category for the current style. If you are creating or modifying a new style, select 'Custom Style' from the list. 9 541247490 a7 Displays the name of the selected style. If you are creating or modifying a custom style, enter a name for the style. You cannot change the name of a predefined style. 9 541249030 69 Select an existing style that you want to base the new style on, or select none to define your own style. 9 541249028 102 Select an existing style that you want to follow the current style in your document. For paragraph styles, the next style is applied to the paragraph that is created when you press Enter. For page styles, the next style is applied when a new page is created. 9 541246476 b0 Updates the style when you apply direct formatting to a paragraph using this style in your document. The formatting of all paragraphs using this style is automatically updated. 9 701127222 5f Displays the width of the selected paper format. To define a custom format, enter a width here. 9 701121607 31 Centers the cells vertically on the printed page. 9 701127185 5c Enter the amount of space to leave between the lower edge of the page and the document text. 9 701121076 4e Displays and prints the current document with the paper oriented horizontally. 9 701121075 4c Displays and prints the current document with the paper oriented vertically. 9 701121596 43 Aligns the text on the selected Page Style to a vertical page grid. 9 701121596 43 Aligns the text on the selected Page Style to a vertical page grid. 5 33788 73 Allows you to define page layouts for single and multiple-page documents, as well as a numbering and paper formats. 9 701121608 86 Resizes the drawing objects so that they fit on the paper format that you select. The arrangement of the drawing objects is preserved. 9 701124146 81 Select a predefined paper size, or create a custom format by entering the dimensions for the paper in the Height and Width boxes. 9 701127224 61 Displays the height of the selected paper format. To define a custom format, enter a height here. 9 701124158 dd Select the Paragraph Style that you want to use as a reference for lining up the text on the selected Page style. The height of the font that is specified in the reference style sets the spacing of the vertical page grid. 9 701127181 e8 Enter the amount of space to leave between the right edge of the page and the document text. If you are using the Mirrored page layout, enter the amount of space to leave between the outer text margin and the outer edge of the page. 9 701124126 51 Select the page numbering format that you want to use for the current page style. 9 701124154 ea Select the paper source for your printer. If you want, you can assign different paper trays to different page styles. For example, assign a different tray to the First Page style and load the tray with your company's letterhead paper. 9 701124132 40 Select the text direction that you want to use in your document. 9 701127183 5c Enter the amount of space to leave between the upper edge of the page and the document text. 9 701124126 51 Select the page numbering format that you want to use for the current page style. 9 701127179 e7 Enter the amount of space to leave between the left edge of the page and the document text. If you are using the Mirrored page layout, enter the amount of space to leave between the inner text margin and the inner edge of the page. 9 701124116 60 Specify whether the current style should show odd pages, even pages, or both odd and even pages. 9 701121606 33 Centers the cells horizontally on the printed page. 9 701124116 60 Specify whether the current style should show odd pages, even pages, or both odd and even pages. 9 701159953 65 Enter the amount of space to leave between the left edge of the page and the left edge of the header. 9 701157928 4d Defines a border, a background color, or a background pattern for the header. 9 701159955 67 Enter the amount of space to leave between the right edge of the page and the right edge of the header. 5 58908 18 Add or edit header text. 9 701154319 51 Automatically adjusts the height of the header to fit the content that you enter. 5 33789 78 Adds a header to the current page style. A header is an area in the top page margin, where you can add text or graphics. 9 701154326 76 Overrides the Spacing setting, and allows the header to expand into the area between the header and the document text. 9 701159948 80 Enter the amount of space that you want to maintain between the bottom edge of the header and the top edge of the document text. 9 701154314 28 Adds a header to the current page style. 9 701154324 2a Even and odd pages share the same content. 9 701159950 2e Enter the height that you want for the header. 9 701141544 4d Defines a border, a background color, or a background pattern for the footer. 9 701143569 65 Enter the amount of space to leave between the left edge of the page and the left edge of the footer. 9 701143571 67 Enter the amount of space to leave between the right edge of the page and the right edge of the footer. 5 33790 7b Adds a footer to the current page style. A footer is an area in the bottom page margin, where you can add text or graphics. 9 701143564 80 Enter the amount of space that you want to maintain between the bottom edge of the document text and the top edge of the footer. 9 701137940 2a Even and odd pages share the same content. 5 58909 18 Add or edit footer text. 9 701137935 4c Automatically adjusts the height of the footer to fit the content you enter. 9 701143566 29 Enter the height you want for the footer. 9 701137942 71 Overrides the Spacing setting and allows the footer to expand into the area between the footer and document text. 9 701137930 28 Adds a footer to the current page style. 18 .uno%3ATransliterateMenu 82 Changes the case of the selected characters, or if the cursor is in a word, changes the case of all of the characters in the word. 1b .uno%3AChangeCaseToKatakana 3d Changes the selected Asian characters to Katakana characters. 1c .uno%3AChangeCaseToFullWidth 3f Changes the selected Asian characters to full width characters. 5 10917 3d Changes the selected Asian characters to Katakana characters. 5 10915 3f Changes the selected Asian characters to full width characters. 1b .uno%3AChangeCaseToHiragana 3d Changes the selected Asian characters to Hiragana characters. 5 10914 3f Changes the selected Asian characters to half-width characters. 5 10912 3a Changes the selected western characters to capital letters 18 .uno%3AChangeCaseToUpper 3a Changes the selected western characters to capital letters 18 .uno%3AChangeCaseToLower 3d Changes the selected western characters to lowercase letters. 5 10913 3d Changes the selected western characters to lowercase letters. 5 10916 3d Changes the selected Asian characters to Hiragana characters. 1c .uno%3AChangeCaseToHalfWidth 3f Changes the selected Asian characters to half-width characters. 11 .uno%3ARubyDialog 54 Allows you to add comments above Asian characters to serve as a pronunciation guide. 4 6656 54 Allows you to add comments above Asian characters to serve as a pronunciation guide. a 2315372560 4f Enter the text that you want to use as a pronunciation guide for the base text. a 2315372561 4f Enter the text that you want to use as a pronunciation guide for the base text. a 2315372557 82 Displays the base text that you selected in the current file. If you want, you can modify the base text by entering new text here. a 2315374105 2d Select where you want to place the ruby text. a 2315374083 2b Select a character style for the ruby text. a 2315372558 4f Enter the text that you want to use as a pronunciation guide for the base text. a 2315374103 32 Select the horizontal alignment for the Ruby text. a 2315375108 60 Opens the Styles and Formatting window where you can select a character style for the ruby text. a 2315372556 82 Displays the base text that you selected in the current file. If you want, you can modify the base text by entering new text here. a 2315372555 82 Displays the base text that you selected in the current file. If you want, you can modify the base text by entering new text here. a 2315372559 4f Enter the text that you want to use as a pronunciation guide for the base text. a 2315372554 82 Displays the base text that you selected in the current file. If you want, you can modify the base text by entering new text here. 15 .uno%3AAlignFrameMenu 34 Aligns selected objects with respect to one another. 10 .uno%3AAlignLeft a1 Aligns the left edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the left edge of the object is aligned to the left page margin. 5 10131 a1 Aligns the left edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the left edge of the object is aligned to the left page margin. 5 20475 a1 Aligns the left edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the left edge of the object is aligned to the left page margin. 5 26371 a1 Aligns the left edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the left edge of the object is aligned to the left page margin. 16 .uno%3AObjectAlignLeft a1 Aligns the left edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the left edge of the object is aligned to the left page margin. 5 10132 a7 Horizontally centers the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the center of the object is aligned to the horizontal center of the page. 1c .uno%3AAlignHorizontalCenter a7 Horizontally centers the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the center of the object is aligned to the horizontal center of the page. 12 .uno%3AAlignCenter a7 Horizontally centers the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the center of the object is aligned to the horizontal center of the page. 5 20477 a7 Horizontally centers the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the center of the object is aligned to the horizontal center of the page. 5 10133 a4 Aligns the right edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Impress or Draw, the right edge of the object is aligned to the right page margin. 5 20476 a4 Aligns the right edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Impress or Draw, the right edge of the object is aligned to the right page margin. 11 .uno%3AAlignRight a4 Aligns the right edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Impress or Draw, the right edge of the object is aligned to the right page margin. 17 .uno%3AObjectAlignRight a4 Aligns the right edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Impress or Draw, the right edge of the object is aligned to the right page margin. 5 20478 ab Vertically aligns the top edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the top edge of the object is aligned to the upper page margin. 5 10134 ab Vertically aligns the top edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the top edge of the object is aligned to the upper page margin. e .uno%3AAlignUp ab Vertically aligns the top edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the top edge of the object is aligned to the upper page margin. f .uno%3AAlignTop ab Vertically aligns the top edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the top edge of the object is aligned to the upper page margin. 1a .uno%3AAlignVerticalCenter a3 Vertically centers the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the center of the object is aligned to the vertical center of the page. 5 20480 a3 Vertically centers the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the center of the object is aligned to the vertical center of the page. 12 .uno%3AAlignMiddle a3 Vertically centers the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the center of the object is aligned to the vertical center of the page. 5 10135 a3 Vertically centers the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the center of the object is aligned to the vertical center of the page. 12 .uno%3AAlignBottom b1 Vertically aligns the bottom edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the bottom edge of the object is aligned to the lower page margin. 10 .uno%3AAlignDown b1 Vertically aligns the bottom edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the bottom edge of the object is aligned to the lower page margin. 5 10136 b1 Vertically aligns the bottom edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the bottom edge of the object is aligned to the lower page margin. 5 20479 b1 Vertically aligns the bottom edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the bottom edge of the object is aligned to the lower page margin. 5 10028 39 Aligns the selected paragraph(s) to the left page margin. f .uno%3ALeftPara 39 Aligns the selected paragraph(s) to the left page margin. 10 .uno%3ARightPara 3a Aligns the selected paragraph(s) to the right page margin. 5 10029 3a Aligns the selected paragraph(s) to the right page margin. 11 .uno%3ACenterPara 2e Centers the selected paragraph(s) on the page. 5 10030 2e Centers the selected paragraph(s) on the page. 12 .uno%3AJustifyPara cd Aligns the selected paragraph(s) to the left and the right page margins. If you want, you can also specify the alignment options for the last line of a paragraph by choosing Format - Paragraph - Alignment. 5 10031 cd Aligns the selected paragraph(s) to the left and the right page margins. If you want, you can also specify the alignment options for the last line of a paragraph by choosing Format - Paragraph - Alignment. 11 .uno%3AMergeCells 45 Combines the contents of the selected table cells into a single cell. 5 20506 45 Combines the contents of the selected table cells into a single cell. 22 SW_NUMERICFIELD_DLG_SPLIT_ED_COUNT 55 Enter the number of rows or columns that you want to split the selected cell(s) into. 1d SW_CHECKBOX_DLG_SPLIT_CB_PROP 27 Splits cells into rows of equal height. 25 SW_IMAGERADIOBUTTON_DLG_SPLIT_RB_HORZ 60 Splits the selected cell(s) into the number of rows that you specify in the Split cell into box. 5 20505 65 Splits the cell or group of cells horizontally or vertically into the number of cells that you enter. 25 SW_IMAGERADIOBUTTON_DLG_SPLIT_RB_VERT 63 Splits the selected cell(s) into the number of columns that you specify in the Split cell into box. 10 .uno%3ASplitCell 65 Splits the cell or group of cells horizontally or vertically into the number of cells that you enter. 5 20585 3c Aligns the contents of the cell to the top edge of the cell. 12 .uno%3ACellVertTop 3c Aligns the contents of the cell to the top edge of the cell. 15 .uno%3ACellVertCenter 3a Centers the contents of the cell horizontally in the cell. 5 20586 3a Centers the contents of the cell horizontally in the cell. 5 20587 3f Aligns the contents of the cell to the bottom edge of the cell. 15 .uno%3ACellVertBottom 3f Aligns the contents of the cell to the bottom edge of the cell. b .uno%3ABold 9c Makes the selected text bold. If the cursor is in a word, the entire word is made bold. If the selection or word is already bold, the formatting is removed. 5 10009 9c Makes the selected text bold. If the cursor is in a word, the entire word is made bold. If the selection or word is already bold, the formatting is removed. 5 10008 a2 Makes the selected text italic. If the cursor is in a word, the entire word is made italic. If the selection or word is already italic, the formatting is removed. d .uno%3AItalic a2 Makes the selected text italic. If the cursor is in a word, the entire word is made italic. If the selection or word is already italic, the formatting is removed. 5 26648 2c Underlines the selected text with two lines. 16 .uno%3AUnderlineDouble 2c Underlines the selected text with two lines. 10 .uno%3AUnderline 39 Underlines or removes underlining from the selected text. 5 10014 39 Underlines or removes underlining from the selected text. 10 .uno%3AStrikeout 57 Draws a line through the selected text, or if the cursor is in a word, the entire word. 5 10013 57 Draws a line through the selected text, or if the cursor is in a word, the entire word. 5 10010 56 Adds a shadow to the selected text, or if the cursor is in a word, to the entire word. f .uno%3AShadowed 56 Adds a shadow to the selected text, or if the cursor is in a word, to the entire word. 15 .uno%3ADistributeRows 60 Adjusts the height of the selected rows to match the height of the tallest row in the selection. 5 20583 60 Adjusts the height of the selected rows to match the height of the tallest row in the selection. 11 .uno%3ASpacePara1 52 Applies single line spacing to the current paragraph. This is the default setting. 5 10034 52 Applies single line spacing to the current paragraph. This is the default setting. 5 10035 45 Sets the line spacing of the current paragraph to one and half lines. 12 .uno%3ASpacePara15 45 Sets the line spacing of the current paragraph to one and half lines. 11 .uno%3ASpacePara2 3c Sets the line spacing of the current paragraph to two lines. 5 10036 3c Sets the line spacing of the current paragraph to two lines. 5 20582 63 Adjusts the width of the selected columns to match the width of the widest column in the selection. 18 .uno%3ADistributeColumns 63 Adjusts the width of the selected columns to match the width of the widest column in the selection. 4 5555 1f Enter a name for the new Style. 18 .uno%3AStyleNewByExample 1f Enter a name for the new Style. a 1111805953 1f Enter a name for the new Style. a 1425344513 37 Enter a name for the new AutoFormat, and then click OK. 5 59896 50 Enter a name for the selected object. The name will be visible in the Navigator. 5 27027 60 Assigns a name to the selected object, so that you can quickly find the object in the Navigator. 5 53076 50 Enter a name for the selected object. The name will be visible in the Navigator. 13 .uno%3ARenameObject 60 Assigns a name to the selected object, so that you can quickly find the object in the Navigator. 10 .uno%3ANameGroup 60 Assigns a name to the selected object, so that you can quickly find the object in the Navigator. 5 21614 60 Assigns a name to the selected object, so that you can quickly find the object in the Navigator. 5 26088 60 Assigns a name to the selected object, so that you can quickly find the object in the Navigator. a 1238632450 50 Enter a name for the selected object. The name will be visible in the Navigator. a 1238681603 7c Enter a title text. This short name is visible as an alternative tag in HTML format. Accessibility tools can read this text. 5 21615 9c Assigns a title and a description to the selected object. These are accessible for accessibility tools and as alternative tags when you export the document. 5 27033 9c Assigns a title and a description to the selected object. These are accessible for accessibility tools and as alternative tags when you export the document. 5 26094 9c Assigns a title and a description to the selected object. These are accessible for accessibility tools and as alternative tags when you export the document. a 1238682116 e3 Enter a description text. The long description text can be entered to describe a complex object or group of objects to users with screen reader software. The description is visible as an alternative tag for accessibility tools. 5 10143 32 Sets the formatting options for the selected line. 11 .uno%3AFormatLine 32 Sets the formatting options for the selected line. 9 701553175 1e Enter a height for the symbol. 9 701550084 41 Select the arrowhead that you want to apply to the selected line. 9 701548036 4e Places the center of the arrowhead(s) on the endpoint(s) of the selected line. 5 10171 99 Select the width for the line. You can append a measurement unit. A zero line width results in a hairline with a width of one pixel of the output medium. 11 .uno%3AXLineStyle 2b Select the line style that you want to use. 9 701553154 20 Enter a width for the arrowhead. 5 10172 1c Select a color for the line. 9 701553153 99 Select the width for the line. You can append a measurement unit. A zero line width results in a hairline with a width of one pixel of the output medium. 9 701547521 8a Automatically updates both arrowhead settings when you enter a different width, select a different arrowhead style,or center an arrowhead. 9 701553174 1d Enter a width for the symbol. 9 701548037 4e Places the center of the arrowhead(s) on the endpoint(s) of the selected line. 9 701553157 71 Enter the transparency of the line, where 100% corresponds to completely transparent and 0% to completely opaque. 9 701558810 3b Select the symbol style that you want to use in your chart. 9 701553155 20 Enter a width for the arrowhead. 5 33802 93 Set the formatting options for the selected line or the line that you want to draw. You can also add arrowheads to a line, or change chart symbols. 9 701550083 41 Select the arrowhead that you want to apply to the selected line. 9 701547544 53 Maintains the proportions of the symbol when you enter a new height or width value. 5 10169 2b Select the line style that you want to use. 9 701550081 1c Select a color for the line. 9 701550082 2b Select the line style that you want to use. 11 .uno%3AXLineColor 1c Select a color for the line. 10 .uno%3ALineWidth 99 Select the width for the line. You can append a measurement unit. A zero line width results in a hairline with a width of one pixel of the output medium. 9 701566465 38 Select the combination of dashes and dots that you want. 9 701566466 31 Select the style of line that you want to create. 9 701569540 1d Enter the length of the dash. 9 701563905 45 Automatically adjusts the entries relative to the length of the line. 9 701569026 50 Enter the number of times that you want a dot or a dash to appear in a sequence. 9 701569537 48 Enter the amount of space that you want to leave between dots or dashes. 9 701569539 1d Enter the length of the dash. a 1238599681 24 Enter a name for the new line style. 5 33803 2c Edit or create dashed or dotted line styles. 9 701567489 34 Creates a new line style using the current settings. 9 701567490 8a Updates the selected line style using the current settings. To change the name of the selected line style, enter a new name when prompted. 9 701569025 50 Enter the number of times that you want a dot or a dash to appear in a sequence. 9 701574662 4b Saves the current list of line styles, so that you can load it again later. 9 701574661 1e Imports a list of line styles. 9 701566467 38 Select the combination of dashes and dots that you want. 9 701591045 1f Imports a list of arrow styles. 5 33804 1c Edit or create arrow styles. 9 701583873 5d To define a custom arrow style, select a drawing object in the document, and then click here. 9 701582849 39 Choose a predefined arrow style symbol from the list box. 9 701591046 46 Saves the current list of arrow styles, so that you can load it later. 9 701581313 2e Displays the name of the selected arrow style. 9 701583874 2d Changes the name of the selected arrow style. 11 .uno%3AFormatArea 38 Sets the fill properties of the selected drawing object. 5 10142 38 Sets the fill properties of the selected drawing object. 9 701635074 30 Enter the vertical offset for tiling the bitmap. 9 701632001 3d Click the fill that you want to apply to the selected object. 5 10164 4e Select the type of fill that you want to apply to the selected drawing object. 33 SVX%3ARADIOBUTTON%3ARID_SVXPAGE_AREA%3ARBT_GRADIENT 47 Fills the selected object with the gradient that you click in the list. 9 701628935 61 Vertically offsets the original bitmap relative to the bitmap tiles by the amount that you enter. 31 SVX%3ARADIOBUTTON%3ARID_SVXPAGE_AREA%3ARBT_BITMAP bf Fills the selected object with the bitmap pattern that you click in the list. To add a bitmap to the list, open this dialog in %PRODUCTNAME Draw, click the Bitmaps tab, and then click Import. 9 701629956 2d Tiles the bitmap to fill the selected object. 9 701635073 32 Enter the horizontal offset for tiling the bitmap. 9 701635076 1d Enter a width for the bitmap. 2d SVX_RADIOBUTTON_RID_SVXPAGE_AREA_RBT_FILL_OFF 61 Does not apply a fill to the selected object. If the object contains a fill, the fill is removed. 9 701629955 5d Automatically determines the number of steps for blending the two end colors of the gradient. 9 701632003 3d Click the fill that you want to apply to the selected object. 9 701632022 57 Click the color that you want to use as a background for the selected hatching pattern. 5 33798 35 Set the fill options for the selected drawing object. 9 701629461 6d Applies a background color to the hatching pattern. Select this checkbox, and then click a color in the list. 9 701634561 4a Enter the number of steps for blending the two end colors of the gradient. 9 701628934 63 Horizontally offsets the original bitmap relative to the bitmap tiles by the amount that you enter. 9 701629957 5a Stretches the bitmap to fill the selected object. To use this feature, clear the Tile box. 9 701632002 3d Click the fill that you want to apply to the selected object. 9 701632004 3d Click the fill that you want to apply to the selected object. 30 SVX%3ARADIOBUTTON%3ARID_SVXPAGE_AREA%3ARBT_COLOR 44 Fills the selected object with the color that you click in the list. 9 701635077 1e Enter a height for the bitmap. 2a SVX_RADIOBUTTON_RID_SVXPAGE_AREA_RBT_HATCH c9 Fills the selected object with the hatching pattern that you click in the list. To apply a background color to the hatching pattern, select the Background color box, and then click a color in the list. 9 701635075 33 Enter the percentage to offset the rows or columns. 9 701629958 8d Retains the original size of the bitmap when filling the selected object. To resize the bitmap, clear this checkbox, and then click Relative. 9 701629953 fd Rescales the bitmap relative to the size of the selected object by the percentage values that you enter in the Width and Height boxes . Clear this checkbox to resize the selected object with the measurements that you enter in the Width and Height boxes. 10 .uno%3AFillStyle 4e Select the type of fill that you want to apply to the selected drawing object. 9 701684228 72 Enter the intensity for the color in the From box, where 0% corresponds to black, and 100 % to the selected color. 9 701684226 cc Enter the horizontal offset for the gradient, where 0% corresponds to the current horizontal location of the endpoint color in the gradient. The endpoint color is the color that is selected in the To box. 9 701681155 3d Select the type of gradient that you want to apply or create. 9 701681156 2b Select the gradient that you want to apply. 9 701684225 31 Enter a rotation angle for the selected gradient. 9 701684230 9c Enter the amount by which you want to adjust the area of the endpoint color on the gradient. The endpoint color is the color that is selected in the To box. 9 701684227 c8 Enter the vertical offset for the gradient, where 0% corresponds to the current vertical location of the endpoint color in the gradient. The endpoint color is the color that is selected in the To box. 9 701682177 6f Adds a custom gradient to the current list. Specify the properties of your gradient, and then click this button 9 701689349 23 Load a different list of gradients. 9 701689350 43 Saves the current list of gradients, so that you can load it later. 5 33801 42 Set the properties of a gradient, or save and load gradient lists. 9 701681154 30 Select a color for the endpoint of the gradient. 9 701681153 37 Select a color for the beginning point of the gradient. 9 701684229 70 Enter the intensity for the color in the To box, where 0% corresponds to black, and 100 % to the selected color. 9 701682179 80 Applies the current gradient properties to the selected gradient. If you want, you can save the gradient under a different name. 9 701649409 80 Adds a custom hatching pattern to the current list. Specify the properties of your hatching pattern, and then click this button. 9 701648385 34 Select the type of hatch lines that you want to use. 9 701648387 24 Select the color of the hatch lines. 5 33991 4e Click a position in the grid to define the rotation angle for the hatch lines. 9 701651459 54 Enter the rotation angle for the hatch lines, or click a position in the angle grid. 9 701648388 6c Lists the available hatching patterns. Click the hatching pattern that you want to apply, and then click OK. 9 701649411 87 Applies the current hatching properties to the selected hatching pattern. If you want, you can save the pattern under a different name. 5 33799 4a Set the properties of a hatching pattern, or save and load hatching lists. 9 701656581 2c Loads a different list of hatching patterns. 9 701656582 4b Saves the current list of hatching patterns, so that you can load it later. 9 701651457 48 Enter the amount of space that you want to have between the hatch lines. 9 701665793 49 Adds a bitmap that you created in the Pattern Editor to the current list. 9 701672966 41 Saves the current list of bitmaps, so that you can load it later. 5 33800 95 Select a bitmap that you want to use as a fill pattern, or create your own pixel pattern. You can also import bitmaps, and save or load bitmap lists. 9 701664772 5b Select a bitmap in the list, and then click OK to apply the pattern to the selected object. 9 701665794 80 Locate the bitmap that you want to import, and then click Open. The bitmap is added to the end of the list of available bitmaps. 9 701664769 54 Select a foreground color, and then click in the grid to add a pixel to the pattern. 9 701665795 97 Replaces a bitmap that you created in the Pattern Editor with the current bitmap pattern. If you want, you can save the pattern under a different name. 9 701672965 22 Loads a different list of bitmaps. 9 701664771 32 Select a background color for your bitmap pattern. 5 33990 28 Click where you want to cast the shadow. 9 701717003 64 Enter a percentage from 0% (opaque) to 100% (transparent) to specify the transparency of the shadow. 5 33805 55 Add a shadow to the selected drawing object, and define the properties of the shadow. 5 10299 c9 Adds a shadow to the selected object. If the object already has a shadow, the shadow is removed. If you click this icon when no object is selected, the shadow is added to the next object that you draw. 9 701711874 2d Adds a shadow to the selected drawing object. 9 701713930 1e Select a color for the shadow. 9 701716993 52 Enter the distance that you want the shadow to be offset from the selected object. 11 .uno%3AFillShadow c9 Adds a shadow to the selected object. If the object already has a shadow, the shadow is removed. If you click this icon when no object is selected, the shadow is added to the next object that you draw. 9 701602314 6e Adjusts the transparency of the current fill color. Enter a number between 0% (opaque) and 100% (transparent). 9 701596168 1d Turns off color transparency. 9 701602309 2b Enter the vertical offset for the gradient. 9 701602312 7b Enter a transparency value for the beginning point of the gradient, where 0% is fully opaque and 100% is fully transparent. 9 701599235 40 Select the type of transparency gradient that you want to apply. 9 701602310 28 Enter a rotation angle for the gradient. 9 701602311 6b Enter the amount by which you want to adjust the transparent area of the gradient. The default value is 0%. 9 701602313 74 Enter a transparency value for the endpoint of the gradient, where 0% is fully opaque and 100% is fully transparent. 9 701596170 74 Applies a transparency gradient to the current fill color. Select this option, and then set the gradient properties. 9 701596169 8c Turns on color transparency. Select this option, and then enter a number in the box, where 0% is fully opaque and 100% is fully transparent. 9 701602308 2d Enter the horizontal offset for the gradient. 9 703219207 56 Resizes a custom shape to fit the text that you enter after double-clicking the shape. 5 27281 59 Sets the layout and anchoring properties for text in the selected drawing or text object. 5 33854 59 Sets the layout and anchoring properties for text in the selected drawing or text object. 15 .uno%3ATextAttributes 59 Sets the layout and anchoring properties for text in the selected drawing or text object. 9 703219201 63 Expands the height of the object to the height of the text, if the object is smaller than the text. 9 703219206 59 Wraps the text that you add after double-clicking a custom shape to fit inside the shape. 9 703219205 54 Adapts the text flow so that it matches the contours of the selected drawing object. 5 33884 36 Click where you want to place the anchor for the text. 9 703224324 7a Enter the amount of space to leave between the bottom edge of the drawing or text object and the lower border of the text. 9 703224323 77 Enter the amount of space to leave between the top edge of the drawing or text object and the upper border of the text. 9 703219204 41 Anchors the text to the full width of the drawing or text object. 9 703224321 77 Enter the amount of space to leave between the left edge of the drawing or text object and the left border of the text. 9 703224322 79 Enter the amount of space to leave between the right edge of the drawing or text object and the right border of the text. 9 703219203 46 Resizes the text to fit the entire area of the drawing or text object. 9 703219202 61 Expands the width of the object to the width of the text, if the object is smaller than the text. 5 10087 37 Resizes, moves, rotates, or slants the selected object. 16 .uno%3ATransformDialog 37 Resizes, moves, rotates, or slants the selected object. 9 702137902 26 Prevents you from resizing the object. 9 702142994 27 Enter a height for the selected object. 9 702142984 6d Enter the vertical distance that you want to move the object relative to the base point selected in the grid. 5 33992 f2 Click a base point in the grid, and then enter the amount that you want to shift the object relative to the base point that you selected in the Position Y and Position X boxes. The base points correspond to the selection handles on an object. 9 702142983 6f Enter the horizontal distance that you want to move the object relative to the base point selected in the grid. 9 702137366 3a Maintains proportions when you resize the selected object. 9 702139939 0 9 702137868 3a Resizes the text to fit the height of the selected object. 9 702142993 26 Enter a width for the selected object. 5 33993 7d Click a base point in the grid, and then enter the new size dimensions for the selected object in the Width and Height boxes. 9 702137901 44 Prevents changes to the position or the size of the selected object. 9 702139944 0 9 702137869 39 Resizes the text to fit the width of the selected object. 9 701504008 4d Enter the vertical distance from the top edge of the page to the pivot point. 9 701504007 50 Enter the horizontal distance from the left edge of the page to the pivot point. 5 33995 3f Click to specify the rotation angle in multiples of 45 degrees. 5 33780 1c Rotates the selected object. 5 33994 2e Click where you want to place the pivot point. 9 701504019 48 Enter the number of degrees that you want to rotate the selected object. 5 33781 4a Slants the selected object, or rounds the corners of a rectangular object. 9 701520413 49 Enter the radius of the circle that you want to use to round the corners. 9 701520403 22 Enter the angle of the slant axis. 9 703172099 56 Select where you want to extend the callout line from, in relation to the callout box. 9 703172098 56 Select where you want to extend the callout line from, in relation to the callout box. 9 703175171 73 Enter the length of the callout line segment that extends from the callout box to the inflection point of the line. 9 703175169 6a Enter the amount of space that you want to leave between the end of the callout line, and the callout box. 9 703169537 3d Click here to display a single-angled line in an optimal way. 9 703175170 56 Select where you want to extend the callout line from, in relation to the callout box. 9 703172097 47 Click the Callout style that you want to apply to the selected callout. 5 34002 47 Click the Callout style that you want to apply to the selected callout. f .uno%3AFlipMenu 36 Flips the selected object horizontally, or vertically. 1b .uno%3AObjectMirrorVertical 3b Flips the selected object(s) vertically from top to bottom. 5 26065 3b Flips the selected object(s) vertically from top to bottom. 11 .uno%3AMirrorVert 3b Flips the selected object(s) vertically from top to bottom. 5 27034 3b Flips the selected object(s) vertically from top to bottom. 11 .uno%3AMirrorHorz 3d Flips the selected object(s) horizontally from left to right. 5 27035 3d Flips the selected object(s) horizontally from left to right. 1d .uno%3AObjectMirrorHorizontal 3d Flips the selected object(s) horizontally from left to right. 5 26066 3d Flips the selected object(s) horizontally from left to right. 17 .uno%3AArrangeFrameMenu 35 Changes the stacking order of the selected object(s). 5 27022 35 Changes the stacking order of the selected object(s). 15 .uno%3AObjectPosition 35 Changes the stacking order of the selected object(s). 12 .uno%3AArrangeMenu 35 Changes the stacking order of the selected object(s). 13 .uno%3ABringToFront 64 Moves the selected object to the top of the stacking order, so that it is in front of other objects. 5 10286 64 Moves the selected object to the top of the stacking order, so that it is in front of other objects. e .uno%3AForward 5a Moves the selected object up one level, so that it is closer to top of the stacking order. 5 20522 5a Moves the selected object up one level, so that it is closer to top of the stacking order. 5 27031 5a Moves the selected object up one level, so that it is closer to top of the stacking order. 17 .uno%3AObjectForwardOne 5a Moves the selected object up one level, so that it is closer to top of the stacking order. 14 .uno%3AObjectBackOne 63 Moves the selected object down one level, so that it is closer to the bottom of the stacking order. 5 20523 63 Moves the selected object down one level, so that it is closer to the bottom of the stacking order. 5 27032 63 Moves the selected object down one level, so that it is closer to the bottom of the stacking order. f .uno%3ABackward 63 Moves the selected object down one level, so that it is closer to the bottom of the stacking order. 5 10287 66 Moves the selected object to the bottom of the stacking order, so that it is behind the other objects. 11 .uno%3ASendToBack 66 Moves the selected object to the bottom of the stacking order, so that it is behind the other objects. 1c .uno%3ASetObjectToForeground 2b Moves the selected object in front of text. 5 10283 2b Moves the selected object in front of text. 5 10282 26 Moves the selected object behind text. 1c .uno%3ASetObjectToBackground 26 Moves the selected object behind text. 11 .uno%3AAnchorMenu 33 Sets the anchoring options for the selected object. 5 20350 2e Anchors the selected item to the current page. 5 26410 2e Anchors the selected item to the current page. 16 .uno%3ASetAnchorToPage 2e Anchors the selected item to the current page. 16 .uno%3ASetAnchorToPara 33 Anchors the selected item to the current paragraph. 5 20351 33 Anchors the selected item to the current paragraph. 16 .uno%3ASetAnchorToCell 24 Anchors the selected item to a cell. 5 26411 24 Anchors the selected item to a cell. 17 .uno%3ASetAnchorToFrame 33 Anchors the selected item to the surrounding frame. 5 20366 33 Anchors the selected item to the surrounding frame. 5 20384 c0 Anchors the selected item as a character in the current text. If the height of the selected item is greater than the current font size, the height of the line containing the item is increased. 16 .uno%3ASetAnchorAsChar c0 Anchors the selected item as a character in the current text. If the height of the selected item is greater than the current font size, the height of the line containing the item is increased. 1d .uno%3AToggleObjectBezierMode 39 Lets you change the shape of the selected drawing object. 5 10126 39 Lets you change the shape of the selected drawing object. f .uno%3AFontWork 66 Edits Fontwork effects of the selected object that has been created with the previous Fontwork dialog. 5 33907 35 Aligns the text to the left end of the text baseline. 5 33913 38 Removes the shadow effects that you applied to the text. 5 10256 66 Edits Fontwork effects of the selected object that has been created with the previous Fontwork dialog. 5 33911 46 Shows or hides the text baseline, or the edges of the selected object. 5 33910 38 Resizes the text to fit the length of the text baseline. 5 33908 26 Centers the text on the text baseline. a 3386592769 23 Select a color for the text shadow. 5 33914 9c Adds a shadow to the text in the selected object. Click this button, and then enter the dimensions of the shadow in the Distance X and the Distance Y boxes. 5 33909 36 Aligns the text to the right end of the text baseline. 5 33879 42 Click the shape of the baseline that you want to use for the text. 5 33901 1c Removes baseline formatting. 5 33902 4c Uses the top or the bottom edge of the selected object as the text baseline. 5 33912 44 Shows or hides the borders of the individual characters in the text. a 3386595844 53 Enter the vertical distance between the text characters and the edge of the shadow. 5 33906 9c Reverses the text flow direction, and flips the text horizontally or vertically. To use this command, you must first apply a different baseline to the text. a 3386595841 75 Enter the amount of space that you want to leave between the text baseline and the base of the individual characters. a 3386595842 6d Enter the amount of space to leave between the beginning of the text baseline, and the beginning of the text. a 3386595843 55 Enter the horizontal distance between the text characters and the edge of the shadow. 5 33905 34 Vertically slants the characters in the text object. 5 33915 a2 Adds a slant shadow to the text in the selected object. Click this button, and then enter the dimensions of the shadow in the Distance X and the Distance Y boxes. 5 33904 36 Horizontally slants the characters in the text object. 5 33903 97 Uses the top or the bottom edge of the selected object as the text baseline and preserves the original vertical alignment of the individual characters. 10 .uno%3AGroupMenu 61 Groups keep together selected objects, so that they can be moved or formatted as a single object. 12 .uno%3AFormatGroup 4a Groups the selected objects, so that they can be moved as a single object. 5 10454 4a Groups the selected objects, so that they can be moved as a single object. d FN_TOOL_GROUP 4a Groups the selected objects, so that they can be moved as a single object. f FN_TOOL_UNGROUP 38 Breaks apart the selected group into individual objects. 14 .uno%3AFormatUngroup 38 Breaks apart the selected group into individual objects. 5 10455 38 Breaks apart the selected group into individual objects. 5 27096 a1 Opens the selected group, so that you can edit the individual objects. If the selected group contains nested group, you can repeat this command on the subgroups. 11 .uno%3AEnterGroup a1 Opens the selected group, so that you can edit the individual objects. If the selected group contains nested group, you can repeat this command on the subgroups. 5 27097 54 Exits the group, so that you can no longer edit the individual objects in the group. 11 .uno%3ALeaveGroup 54 Exits the group, so that you can no longer edit the individual objects in the group. 9 703731713 47 Enter the number of times that you want the animation effect to repeat. 9 703729153 8f Select the animation effect that you want to apply to the text in the selected drawing object. To remove an animation effect, select No Effect. 9 703737348 20 Scrolls text from top to bottom. 9 703727106 31 Text remains visible after the effect is applied. 9 703732225 3b Enter the number of increments by which to scroll the text. 9 703727108 23 Measures increment value in pixels. 9 703727105 49 Text is visible and inside the drawing object when the effect is applied. 9 703737346 20 Scrolls text from right to left. 9 703737347 20 Scrolls text from left to right. 9 703727107 9a Plays the animation effect continuously. To specify the number of times to play the effect, clear this checkbox, and enter a number in the Continuous box. 9 703727109 c5 $[officename] automatically determines the amount of time to wait before repeating the effect. To manually assign the delay period, clear this checkbox, and then enter a value in the Automatic box. 9 703725568 44 Adds an animation effect to the text in the selected drawing object. 9 703737345 20 Scrolls text from bottom to top. 9 703732226 3d Enter the amount of time to wait before repeating the effect. a 1494942721 3f Automatically adjusts the row height based on the current font. 5 26281 3c Changes the height of the current row, or the selected rows. a 1388446722 3f Automatically adjusts the row height based on the current font. 10 .uno%3ARowHeight 3c Changes the height of the current row, or the selected rows. a 1494948353 2a Enter the row height that you want to use. a 1388452353 2a Enter the row height that you want to use. 5 38832 3c Changes the height of the current row, or the selected rows. 12 .uno%3AColumnWidth 41 Changes the width of the current column, or the selected columns. a 1388468737 2c Enter the column width that you want to use. a 1494909953 41 Automatically adjusts the column width based on the current font. a 1494915585 2c Enter the column width that you want to use. 5 26285 41 Changes the width of the current column, or the selected columns. 5 38830 41 Changes the width of the current column, or the selected columns. a 1388463106 41 Automatically adjusts the column width based on the current font. 9 702187050 3c Enables word hyphenation for text wrapping to the next line. 9 702187053 aa Reduces the apparent size of the font so that the contents of the cell fit into the current cell width. You cannot apply this command to a cell that contains line breaks. 9 702189072 51 Select the vertical alignment option that you want to apply to the cell contents. 9 702192142 44 Indents from the left edge of the cell by the amount that you enter. 5 34006 3b Specify the cell edge from which to write the rotated text. 9 702191640 a2 Enter the rotation angle for the text in the selected cell(s). A positive number rotates the text to the left and a negative number rotates the text to the right. 9 702187049 66 Wraps text onto another line at the cell border. The number of lines depends on the width of the cell. 9 702187029 17 Aligns text vertically. 9 702189068 53 Select the horizontal alignment option that you want to apply to the cell contents. 9 702187035 133 Aligns Asian characters one below the other in the selected cell(s). If the cell contains more than one line of text, the lines are converted to text columns that are arranged from right to left. Western characters in the converted text are rotated 90 degrees to the right. Asian characters are not rotated. 5 34005 2e Click in the dial to set the text orientation. 5 33785 57 Sets the alignment options for the contents of the current cell, or the selected cells. 5 38831 1c Formats the selected row(s). 5 38829 1f Formats the selected column(s). f .uno%3AWindow3D 41 Specifies the properties of 3D object(s) in the current document. 5 10644 41 Specifies the properties of 3D object(s) in the current document. a 3388495897 52 Enter the number of horizontal segments to use in the selected 3D rotation object. a 3388496420 67 Enter the extrusion depth for the selected 3D object. This option is not valid for 3D rotation objects. a 3388496416 67 Enter the amount by which to increase or decrease the area of the front side of the selected 3D object. a 3388501506 108 Adjusts the shape of the selected 3D object. You can only modify the shape of a 3D object that was created by converting a 2D object. To convert a 2D object to 3D, select the object, right-click, and then choose Convert - To 3D, or Convert - To 3D Rotation Object. a 3388496414 52 Enter the amount by which you want to round the corners of the selected 3D object. a 3388501545 8f Lights the object from the outside and the inside. To use an ambient light source, click this button, and then click the Invert Normals button. a 3388501548 60 Closes the shape of a 3D object that was created by extruding a freeform line (Convert - To 3D). a 3388501544 1c Renders a smooth 3D surface. a 3388496418 45 Enter the angle in degrees to rotate the selected 3D rotation object. a 3388501543 23 Renders the 3D surface as polygons. a 3388501542 80 Renders the 3D surface according to the shape of the object. For example, a circular shape is rendered with a spherical surface. a 3388501546 19 Inverts the light source. a 3388495899 4f Enter the number of vertical segments to use in the selected 3D rotation object a 3388496438 81 Enter the focal length of the camera, where a small value corresponds to a "fisheye" lens, and a large value to a telephoto lens. a 3388496433 3b Enter an angle from 0 to 90 degrees for casting the shadow. a 3388501507 3f Sets the shading and shadow options for the selected 3D object. a 3388496436 55 Enter the distance to leave between the camera and the center of the selected object. a 3388501551 35 Adds or removes a shadow from the selected 3D object. a 3388493358 135 Select the shading method that you want to use. Flat shading assigns a single color to a single polygon on the surface of the object. Gouraud shading blends colors across the polygons. Phong shading averages the color of each pixel based on the pixels that surround it, and requires the most processing power. a 3388501569 d0 Click twice to turn the light source on, and then select a color for the light from the list. If you want, you can also set the color of the surrounding light, by selecting a color from the Ambient light box. a 3388501564 d0 Click twice to turn the light source on, and then select a color for the light from the list. If you want, you can also set the color of the surrounding light, by selecting a color from the Ambient light box. a 3388501508 33 Define the light source for the selected 3D object. a 3388493390 25 Select a color for the ambient light. a 3388501580 25 Select a color for the ambient light. a 3388501568 d0 Click twice to turn the light source on, and then select a color for the light from the list. If you want, you can also set the color of the surrounding light, by selecting a color from the Ambient light box. a 3388501565 d0 Click twice to turn the light source on, and then select a color for the light from the list. If you want, you can also set the color of the surrounding light, by selecting a color from the Ambient light box. a 3388493380 2c Select a color for the current light source. a 3388501570 d0 Click twice to turn the light source on, and then select a color for the light from the list. If you want, you can also set the color of the surrounding light, by selecting a color from the Ambient light box. a 3388501567 d0 Click twice to turn the light source on, and then select a color for the light from the list. If you want, you can also set the color of the surrounding light, by selecting a color from the Ambient light box. a 3388501571 d0 Click twice to turn the light source on, and then select a color for the light from the list. If you want, you can also set the color of the surrounding light, by selecting a color from the Ambient light box. a 3388501566 d0 Click twice to turn the light source on, and then select a color for the light from the list. If you want, you can also set the color of the surrounding light, by selecting a color from the Ambient light box. a 3388501608 4c Automatically adjusts the texture based on the shape and size of the object. a 3388501604 4c Automatically adjusts the texture based on the shape and size of the object. a 3388501509 135 Sets the properties of the surface texture for the selected 3D object. This feature is only available after you apply a surface textures to the selected object. To quickly apply a surface texture, open the Gallery, hold down Shift+Ctrl (Mac: Shift+Command), and then drag an image onto the selected 3D object. a 3388501595 28 Converts the texture to black and white. a 3388501602 34 Applies the texture parallel to the horizontal axis. a 3388501598 24 Applies the texture without shading. a 3388501596 1e Converts the texture to color. a 3388501610 37 Blurs the texture slightly to remove unwanted speckles. a 3388501607 3f Wraps the vertical axis of the texture pattern around a sphere. a 3388501603 41 Wraps the horizontal axis of the texture pattern around a sphere. a 3388501606 32 Applies the texture parallel to the vertical axis. a 3388501599 79 Applies the texture with shading. To define the shading options for the texture, click the Shading button in this dialog. a 3388501510 2f Changes the coloring of the selected 3D object. a 3388493437 59 Select a predefined color scheme, or select User-defined to define a custom color scheme. a 3388501624 2b Enter the intensity of the specular effect. a 3388496506 2b Enter the intensity of the specular effect. a 3388493431 35 Select the color that you want the object to reflect. a 3388493428 2a Select the color to illuminate the object. a 3388501621 35 Select the color that you want the object to reflect. a 3388493425 36 Select the color that you want to apply to the object. a 3388501618 2a Select the color to illuminate the object. 9 704578050 2d Does not distribute the objects horizontally. 9 704578054 6c Distributes the selected objects, so that the right edges of the objects are evenly spaced from one another. 9 704578053 66 Distributes the selected objects horizontally, so that the objects are evenly spaced from one another. 9 704578052 73 Distributes the selected objects, so that the horizontal centers of the objects are evenly spaced from one another. 9 704578056 2b Does not distribute the objects vertically. 4 5683 9d Distributes three or more selected objects evenly along the horizontal axis or the vertical axis. You can also evenly distribute the spacing between objects. 9 704578058 71 Distributes the selected objects, so that the vertical centers of the objects are evenly spaced from one another. 1a .uno%3ADistributeSelection 9d Distributes three or more selected objects evenly along the horizontal axis or the vertical axis. You can also evenly distribute the spacing between objects. 9 704578051 6b Distributes the selected objects, so that the left edges of the objects are evenly spaced from one another. 9 704578059 64 Distributes the selected objects vertically, so that the objects are evenly spaced from one another. 9 704578057 6a Distributes the selected objects, so that the top edges of the objects are evenly spaced from one another. 9 704578060 6d Distributes the selected objects, so that the bottom edges of the objects are evenly spaced from one another. a 2311860263 33 Adds the unknown word to a user-defined dictionary. 5 39888 49 Replaces all occurrences of the unknown word with the current suggestion. 35 SVX%3APUSHBUTTON%3ARID_SVXDLG_SPELLCHECK%3ABTN_CHANGE 8a Replaces the unknown word with the current suggestion. If you changed more than just the misspelled word, the entire sentence is replaced. 5 39885 39 Skips the unknown word and continues with the spellcheck. a 2311851552 80 Lists suggested words to replace the misspelled word. Select the word that you want to use, and then click Change or Change All. 5 40076 74 While performing a grammar check, click Ignore Rule to ignore the rule that is currently flagged as a grammar error. 38 SVX%3APUSHBUTTON%3ARID_SVXDLG_SPELLCHECK%3ABTN_IGNOREALL 63 Skips all occurrences of the unknown word in the entire document and continues with the spellcheck. a 2311849014 58 Enable Check grammar to work first on all spellcheck errors, then on all grammar errors. 1f .uno%3ASpellingAndGrammarDialog 9a Checks the document or the current selection for spelling errors. If a grammar checking extension is installed, the dialog also checks for grammar errors. 5 39886 63 Skips all occurrences of the unknown word in the entire document and continues with the spellcheck. a 2311852588 6c Opens a dialog, where you can select the user-defined dictionaries, and set the rules for the spellchecking. f .uno%3ASpelling 9a Checks the document or the current selection for spelling errors. If a grammar checking extension is installed, the dialog also checks for grammar errors. a 2311850530 91 Displays the sentence with the misspelled word highlighted. Edit the word or the sentence, or click one of the suggestions in the text box below. a 2311852590 69 Click to undo the last step of your spellcheck session. Click again to undo the previous step, and so on. 31 SVX_PUSHBUTTON_RID_SVXDLG_SPELLCHECK_BTN_AUTOCORR 6c Opens a dialog, where you can select the user-defined dictionaries, and set the rules for the spellchecking. a 2311851556 34 Specifies the language to use to check the spelling. 38 SVX%3APUSHBUTTON%3ARID_SVXDLG_SPELLCHECK%3ABTN_CHANGEALL 49 Replaces all occurrences of the unknown word with the current suggestion. 35 SVX%3APUSHBUTTON%3ARID_SVXDLG_SPELLCHECK%3ABTN_IGNORE 39 Skips the unknown word and continues with the spellcheck. 5 39887 8a Replaces the unknown word with the current suggestion. If you changed more than just the misspelled word, the entire sentence is replaced. 2c SVX_LISTBOX_RID_SVXDLG_SPELLCHECK_LB_NEWWORD 80 Lists suggested words to replace the misspelled word. Select the word that you want to use, and then click Change or Change All. a 2311852586 6c Opens a dialog, where you can select the user-defined dictionaries, and set the rules for the spellchecking. 2c SVX_PUSHBUTTON_RID_SVXDLG_SPELLCHECK_BTN_ADD 33 Adds the unknown word to a user-defined dictionary. 30 SVX_PUSHBUTTON_RID_SVXDLG_SPELLCHECK_BTN_OPTIONS 6c Opens a dialog, where you can select the user-defined dictionaries, and set the rules for the spellchecking. 13 .uno%3ALanguageMenu 40 Opens a submenu where you can choose language specific commands. 17 .uno%3AMoreDictionaries 3d Opens the default browser on the dictionaries extension page. 18 .uno%3AChineseConversion 8d Translates the selected Chinese text from one Chinese writing system to the other. If no text is selected, the entire document is translated. 5 11016 8d Translates the selected Chinese text from one Chinese writing system to the other. If no text is selected, the entire document is translated. a 1238093330 6c Select the meaning that matches the context of the current word, and then select a word in the Synonym list. a 1238091798 85 Displays a suggested replacement for the current word. You can also type a new word in this box, or click a word in the Synonym list. 5 10245 3c Replaces the current word with a synonym, or a related term. a 1238094350 53 Searches the thesaurus for the best match of the word selected in the Synonym list. 16 .uno%3AThesaurusDialog 3c Replaces the current word with a synonym, or a related term. a 1238208010 4e Select the language that you want to use for the thesaurus, and then click OK. a 1238093328 45 Displays the current selection, or the word that contains the cursor. 5 20603 3c Replaces the current word with a synonym, or a related term. a 1238093332 9d Lists the words associated with the category that you selected in the Meaning list. Select the word that you want to use as a replacement, and then click OK. a 1238094348 30 Specifies the language to use for the thesaurus. 10 .uno%3AThesaurus 3c Replaces the current word with a synonym, or a related term. a 3391947781 4f Replaces transparent areas in the current image with the color that you select. a 3391953409 d3 Set the tolerance for replacing a source color in the source image. To replace colors that are similar to the color that you selected, enter a low value. To replace a wider range of colors, enter a higher value. a 3391953410 d3 Set the tolerance for replacing a source color in the source image. To replace colors that are similar to the color that you selected, enter a low value. To replace a wider range of colors, enter a higher value. a 3391953412 d3 Set the tolerance for replacing a source color in the source image. To replace colors that are similar to the color that you selected, enter a low value. To replace a wider range of colors, enter a higher value. a 3391950337 96 Lists the available replacement colors. To modify the current list of colors, deselect the image, choose Format - Area, and then click the Colors tab. 5 10350 5b Opens the eyedropper dialog, where you can replace colors in bitmap and meta file graphics. e .uno%3ABmpMask 5b Opens the eyedropper dialog, where you can replace colors in bitmap and meta file graphics. 5 33898 8d Select one of the four source color boxes. Move the mouse pointer over the selected image, and then click the color that you want to replace. 5 33872 ab Displays the color in the selected image that you want to replace. To set the source color, click here, click the eyedropper, and then click a color in the selected image. a 3391947778 71 Select this checkbox to replace the current Source color with the color that you specify in the Replace with box. a 3391947779 71 Select this checkbox to replace the current Source color with the color that you specify in the Replace with box. a 3391950339 96 Lists the available replacement colors. To modify the current list of colors, deselect the image, choose Format - Area, and then click the Colors tab. a 3391950341 47 Select the color to replace the transparent areas in the current image. a 3391950340 96 Lists the available replacement colors. To modify the current list of colors, deselect the image, choose Format - Area, and then click the Colors tab. a 3391947780 71 Select this checkbox to replace the current Source color with the color that you specify in the Replace with box. a 3391950338 96 Lists the available replacement colors. To modify the current list of colors, deselect the image, choose Format - Area, and then click the Colors tab. a 3391951361 74 Replaces the selected source colors in the current image with the colors that you specify in the Replace with boxes. a 3391947777 71 Select this checkbox to replace the current Source color with the color that you specify in the Replace with box. 5 33873 a1 Displays the color in the selected image that directly underlies the current mouse pointer position. This features only works if the eyedropper tool is selected. a 3391953411 d3 Set the tolerance for replacing a source color in the source image. To replace colors that are similar to the color that you selected, enter a low value. To replace a wider range of colors, enter a higher value. 5 10424 3e Sets the options for automatically replacing text as you type. 15 .uno%3AAutoCorrectDlg 3e Sets the options for automatically replacing text as you type. 5 35076 56 Select the options for automatically correcting errors as you type, and then click OK. 5 35074 56 Select the options for automatically correcting errors as you type, and then click OK. 5 35029 56 Select the options for automatically correcting errors as you type, and then click OK. 5 35075 56 Select the options for automatically correcting errors as you type, and then click OK. 3f OFFMGR%3ACHECKBOX%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_REPLACE%3ACB_TEXT_ONLY 85 Saves the entry in the With box without formatting. When the replacement is made, the text uses the same format as the document text. 5 35032 12f Lists the entries for automatically replacing words or abbreviations while you type. To add an entry, enter text in the Replace and With boxes, and then click New. To edit an entry, select it, change the text in the With box, and then click Replace. To delete an entry, select it, and then click Delete. 39 OFFMGR%3AEDIT%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_REPLACE%3AED_REPLACE f3 Enter the replacement text, graphic, frame, or OLE object that you want to replace the text in the Replace box. If you have selected text, a graphic, a frame, or an OLE object in your document, the relevant information is already entered here. 9 808896544 f3 Enter the replacement text, graphic, frame, or OLE object that you want to replace the text in the Replace box. If you have selected text, a graphic, a frame, or an OLE object in your document, the relevant information is already entered here. 43 OFFMGR%3APUSHBUTTON%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_REPLACE%3APB_NEW_REPLACE 33 Adds or replaces an entry in the replacement table. 37 OFFMGR%3AEDIT%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_REPLACE%3AED_SHORT 47 Enter the word or abbreviation that you want to replace while you type. 9 808895522 85 Saves the entry in the With box without formatting. When the replacement is made, the text uses the same format as the document text. 9 808896543 47 Enter the word or abbreviation that you want to replace while you type. 9 808899107 33 Adds or replaces an entry in the replacement table. 5 35030 6e Edits the replacement table for automatically correcting or replacing words or abbreviations in your document. 9 808911915 12e Automatically adds abbreviations or words that start with two capital letters to the corresponding list of exceptions. This feature only works if the Correct TWo INitial CApitals option or the Capitalize first letter of every sentence option are selected in the [T] column onOptions tab of this dialog. 5 35091 4f Select the language for which you want to create or edit the replacement rules. 3d OFFMGR%3ACHECKBOX%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_EXCEPT%3ACB_AUTOCAPS 12e Automatically adds abbreviations or words that start with two capital letters to the corresponding list of exceptions. This feature only works if the Correct TWo INitial CApitals option or the Capitalize first letter of every sentence option are selected in the [T] column onOptions tab of this dialog. 3a OFFMGR%3ALISTBOX%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_EXCEPT%3ALB_ABBREV 3d Lists the abbreviations that are not automatically corrected. 44 OFFMGR%3APUSHBUTTON%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_EXCEPT%3APB_NEWDOUBLECAPS 31 Adds the current entry to the list of exceptions. 9 808912918 ce Type the word or abbreviation that starts with two capital letters that you do not want $[officename] to change to one initial capital. For example, enter PC to prevent $[officename] from changing PC to Pc. 9 808914450 3d Lists the abbreviations that are not automatically corrected. 9 808915475 31 Adds the current entry to the list of exceptions. 5 35031 6d Specify the abbreviations or letter combinations that you do not want $[officename] to correct automatically. 3f OFFMGR%3ACHECKBOX%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_EXCEPT%3ACB_AUTOABBREV 12e Automatically adds abbreviations or words that start with two capital letters to the corresponding list of exceptions. This feature only works if the Correct TWo INitial CApitals option or the Capitalize first letter of every sentence option are selected in the [T] column onOptions tab of this dialog. 3c OFFMGR%3AEDIT%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_EXCEPT%3AED_DOUBLE_CAPS ce Type the word or abbreviation that starts with two capital letters that you do not want $[officename] to change to one initial capital. For example, enter PC to prevent $[officename] from changing PC to Pc. 9 808915480 31 Adds the current entry to the list of exceptions. 37 OFFMGR%3AEDIT%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_EXCEPT%3AED_ABBREV d3 Type an abbreviation followed by a period, and then click New. This prevents $[officename] from automatically capitalizing the first letter of the word that comes after the period at the end of the abbreviation. 3f OFFMGR%3ALISTBOX%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_EXCEPT%3ALB_DOUBLE_CAPS b3 Lists the words or abbreviations that start with two initial capitals that are not automatically corrected. All words which start with two capital letters are listed in the field. 9 808911916 12e Automatically adds abbreviations or words that start with two capital letters to the corresponding list of exceptions. This feature only works if the Correct TWo INitial CApitals option or the Capitalize first letter of every sentence option are selected in the [T] column onOptions tab of this dialog. 9 808912913 d3 Type an abbreviation followed by a period, and then click New. This prevents $[officename] from automatically capitalizing the first letter of the word that comes after the period at the end of the abbreviation. 40 OFFMGR%3APUSHBUTTON%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_EXCEPT%3APB_NEWABBREV 31 Adds the current entry to the list of exceptions. 9 808914455 b3 Lists the words or abbreviations that start with two initial capitals that are not automatically corrected. All words which start with two capital letters are listed in the field. 9 808993849 78 Automatically replaces the default system symbol for single quotation marks with the special character that you specify. 3e OFFMGR%3APUSHBUTTON%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_QUOTE%3APB_ENDQUOTE 9e Select the special character that will automatically replace the current closing quotation mark in your document when you choose Format - AutoCorrect - Apply. 9 808997389 9e Select the special character that will automatically replace the current opening quotation mark in your document when you choose Format - AutoCorrect - Apply. 40 OFFMGR%3APUSHBUTTON%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_QUOTE%3APB_STARTQUOTE 9e Select the special character that will automatically replace the current opening quotation mark in your document when you choose Format - AutoCorrect - Apply. 38 OFFMGR%3ACHECKBOX%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_QUOTE%3ACB_TYPO 78 Automatically replaces the default system symbol for single quotation marks with the special character that you specify. 3d OFFMGR%3APUSHBUTTON%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_QUOTE%3APB_SGL_STD 32 Resets the quotation marks to the default symbols. 44 OFFMGR%3APUSHBUTTON%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_QUOTE%3APB_SGL_STARTQUOTE 9e Select the special character that will automatically replace the current opening quotation mark in your document when you choose Format - AutoCorrect - Apply. 9 808993803 78 Automatically replaces the default system symbol for single quotation marks with the special character that you specify. 9 808997422 9e Select the special character that will automatically replace the current opening quotation mark in your document when you choose Format - AutoCorrect - Apply. 42 OFFMGR%3APUSHBUTTON%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_QUOTE%3APB_SGL_ENDQUOTE 9e Select the special character that will automatically replace the current closing quotation mark in your document when you choose Format - AutoCorrect - Apply. 9 808997391 9e Select the special character that will automatically replace the current closing quotation mark in your document when you choose Format - AutoCorrect - Apply. 9 808997425 32 Resets the quotation marks to the default symbols. 9 808997426 32 Resets the quotation marks to the default symbols. 9 808997424 9e Select the special character that will automatically replace the current closing quotation mark in your document when you choose Format - AutoCorrect - Apply. 3d OFFMGR%3APUSHBUTTON%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_QUOTE%3APB_DBL_STD 32 Resets the quotation marks to the default symbols. 3c OFFMGR%3ACHECKBOX%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_QUOTE%3ACB_SGL_TYPO 78 Automatically replaces the default system symbol for single quotation marks with the special character that you specify. 5 34065 1c Opens the Spellcheck dialog. 5 53431 46 Ignores all instances of the highlighted word in the current document. 5 53434 66 Click the word to replace the highlighted word. Use the AutoCorrect submenu for permanent replacement. 5 53433 9f To always replace the highlighted word, click a word in the list. The word pair is stored in the replacement table under Tools - AutoCorrect Options - Replace. 5 53438 7e Changes the language setting for the paragraph that contains the highlighted word, if the word is found in another dictionary. 5 53432 1c Opens the Spellcheck dialog. 5 53430 37 Adds the highlighted word to a user-defined dictionary. 5 34067 46 Ignores all instances of the highlighted word in the current document. 5 34068 9f To always replace the highlighted word, click a word in the list. The word pair is stored in the replacement table under Tools - AutoCorrect Options - Replace. 5 53437 63 Changes the language settings for the highlighted word, if the word is found in another dictionary. 5 34066 37 Adds the highlighted word to a user-defined dictionary. 9 809157757 2a Displays the completed word as a Help Tip. 49 OFFMGR%3ANUMERICFIELD%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS%3ANF_MAX_ENTRIES 55 Enter the maximum number of words that you want to store in the Word Completion list. 3d OFFMGR_CHECKBOX_RID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS_CB_KEEP_LIST f7 When enabled, the list gets cleared when closing the current document. When disabled, makes the current Word Completion list available to other documents after you close the current document. The list remains available until you exit %PRODUCTNAME. 9 809162881 55 Enter the maximum number of words that you want to store in the Word Completion list. 44 OFFMGR%3ALISTBOX%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS%3ADCB_EXPAND_KEY 4c Select the key that you want to use to accept the automatic word completion. 3f OFFMGR%3ACHECKBOX%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS%3ACB_ACTIV 92 Stores frequently used words, and automatically completes a word after you type three letters that match the first three letters of a stored word. 9 809157756 f7 When enabled, the list gets cleared when closing the current document. When disabled, makes the current Word Completion list available to other documents after you close the current document. The list remains available until you exit %PRODUCTNAME. 9 809162880 5c Enter the minimum word length for a word to become eligible for the word completion feature. 40 OFFMGR_CHECKBOX_RID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS_CB_APPEND_SPACE 49 If you do not add punctuation after the word, $[officename] adds a space. 9 809161349 41 Removes the selected word or words from the Word Completion list. 9 809160323 4c Select the key that you want to use to accept the automatic word completion. 9 809157754 87 Adds the frequently used words to a list. To remove a word from the Word Completion list, select the word, and then click Delete Entry. 40 OFFMGR%3ACHECKBOX%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS%3ACB_AS_TIP 2a Displays the completed word as a Help Tip. 9 809159812 ea Lists the collected words. The list is valid until you close the current document. To make the list available to other documents in the current session, select "When closing a document, save the list for later use in other documents". 9 809157755 49 If you do not add punctuation after the word, $[officename] adds a space. 43 OFFMGR%3APUSHBUTTON%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS%3APB_ENTRIES 41 Removes the selected word or words from the Word Completion list. 41 OFFMGR%3ACHECKBOX%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS%3ACB_COLLECT 87 Adds the frequently used words to a list. To remove a word from the Word Completion list, select the word, and then click Delete Entry. 49 OFFMGR%3ANUMERICFIELD%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS%3ANF_MIN_WORDLEN 5c Enter the minimum word length for a word to become eligible for the word completion feature. 9 809157753 92 Stores frequently used words, and automatically completes a word after you type three letters that match the first three letters of a stored word. 45 OFFMGR%3AMULTILISTBOX%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS%3ALB_ENTRIES ea Lists the collected words. The list is valid until you close the current document. To make the list available to other documents in the current session, select "When closing a document, save the list for later use in other documents". 9 809259743 78 To configure a Smart Tag, select the name of the Smart Tag, then click Properties. Not all Smart Tags can be configured. 9 809256156 43 Enables Smart Tags to be evaluated and shown in your text document. 14 .uno%3AOutlineBullet 69 Adds numbering or bullets to the current paragraph, and lets you edit format of the numbering or bullets. 5 20121 69 Adds numbering or bullets to the current paragraph, and lets you edit format of the numbering or bullets. 20 .uno%3ABulletsAndNumberingDialog 69 Adds numbering or bullets to the current paragraph, and lets you edit format of the numbering or bullets. 5 10156 69 Adds numbering or bullets to the current paragraph, and lets you edit format of the numbering or bullets. 5 34050 2c Click the bullet style that you want to use. 5 34049 2f Click the numbering style that you want to use. 5 34051 2d Click the outline style that you want to use. 9 704283872 6c If enabled, the graphics are inserted as links. If not enabled, the graphics are embedded into the document. 5 34052 33 Click the graphics that you want to use as bullets. 9 704302783 2f Select a color for the current numbering style. 9 704305321 32 Enter a new starting number for the current level. 9 704301216 a0 Enter a character or the text to display behind the number in the list. If you want to create a numbered list that uses the style "1.)", enter ".)" in this box. 9 704300209 2e Maintains the size proportions of the graphic. 9 704303789 4a Opens the Special Characters dialog, where you can select a bullet symbol. 9 704302775 2c Select the alignment option for the graphic. 9 704302760 32 Enter a new starting number for the current level. 9 704302232 47 Select the level(s) that you want to define the formatting options for. 9 704305857 7b Enter the amount by which you want to resize the bullet character with respect to the font height of the current paragraph. 9 704305845 1f Enter a height for the graphic. 9 704311480 50 Select the graphic, or locate the graphic file that you want to use as a bullet. 9 704305323 32 Enter a new starting number for the current level. 9 704301212 4c Enter a character or the text to display in front of the number in the list. 9 704305843 1e Enter a width for the graphic. 9 704302750 31 Select a numbering style for the selected levels. 9 878844424 f1 Enter the amount of space to leave between the left page margin (or the left edge of the text object) and the left edge of the numbering symbol. If the current paragraph style uses an indent, the amount you enter here is added to the indent. 9 878838790 4f Indents the current level relative to the previous level in the list hierarchy. 9 704322210 f1 Enter the amount of space to leave between the left page margin (or the left edge of the text object) and the left edge of the numbering symbol. If the current paragraph style uses an indent, the amount you enter here is added to the indent. 9 704316601 4f Indents the current level relative to the previous level in the list hierarchy. 9 878841356 125 Set the alignment of the numbering symbols. Select "Left" to align the numbering symbol to start directly at the "Aligned at" position. Select "Right" to align the symbol to end directly before the "Aligned at" position. Select "Centered" to center the symbol around the "Aligned at" position. 9 878842381 3f Resets the indent and the spacing values to the default values. 9 704322307 7c Enter the distance from the left page margin to the start of all lines in the numbered paragraph that follow the first line. 9 704318616 2c Select the level(s) that you want to modify. 9 704322212 3f Resets the indent and the spacing values to the default values. 9 704319227 53 Select the element that will follow the numbering: a tab stop, a space, or nothing. 9 878840834 2c Select the level(s) that you want to modify. 9 704319027 125 Set the alignment of the numbering symbols. Select "Left" to align the numbering symbol to start directly at the "Aligned at" position. Select "Right" to align the symbol to end directly before the "Aligned at" position. Select "Centered" to center the symbol around the "Aligned at" position. 9 704322305 5b Enter the distance from the left page margin at which the numbering symbol will be aligned. 9 878844426 3f Resets the indent and the spacing values to the default values. 9 878844424 6f Enter the amount of space to leave between the left edge of the numbering symbol and the left edge of the text. 9 704319231 125 Set the alignment of the numbering symbols. Select "Left" to align the numbering symbol to start directly at the "Aligned at" position. Select "Right" to align the symbol to end directly before the "Aligned at" position. Select "Centered" to center the symbol around the "Aligned at" position. 9 704320187 3f Resets the indent and the spacing values to the default values. 9 704322301 6e If you select a tab stop to follow the numbering, you can enter a non-negative value as the tab stop position. 9 878844421 f1 Enter the amount of space to leave between the left page margin (or the left edge of the text object) and the left edge of the numbering symbol. If the current paragraph style uses an indent, the amount you enter here is added to the indent. 9 704322214 6f Enter the amount of space to leave between the left edge of the numbering symbol and the left edge of the text. 12 .uno%3AMacroDialog 22 Opens a dialog to organize macros. 9 780816900 59 Starts the $[officename] Basic editor and opens the selected macro or dialog for editing. a 1317868042 59 Starts the $[officename] Basic editor and opens the selected macro or dialog for editing. a 1241813507 41 To run a script, select a script in the list, and then click Run. 9 780800516 51 Opens the $[officename] Basic editor so that you can modify the selected library. 9 780784135 2a Opens the editor and creates a new dialog. a 1317868052 29 Saves the recorded macro in a new module. a 1317734441 2b Enter a name for the new library or module. 24 svx%3AEdit%3ADLG_NEWLIB%3AED_LIBNAME 1c Enter a name for the script. 9 780800523 37 Assigns or edits the password for the selected library. a 1241813510 3a Opens the default script editor for your operating system. 9 780784132 2f Opens the selected macro or dialog for editing. a 1241813512 2a Prompts you to delete the selected script. a 1317868040 20 Runs or saves the current macro. a 1317865477 67 Displays the name of the selected macro. To create or to change the name of a macro, enter a name here. 5 63544 52 Lists the macros that are contained in the module selected in the Macro from list. 9 780800521 16 Creates a new library. 9 780816903 2a Opens the editor and creates a new dialog. 5 40011 83 Select a macro or script from "user", "share", or an open document. To view the available macros or scripts, double-click an entry. 9 780799500 60 Select the application or the document containing the macro libraries that you want to organize. 9 780800522 66 Locate that $[officename] Basic library that you want to add to the current list, and then click Open. a 1317868051 2a Saves the recorded macro in a new library. a 1317868045 6e Opens the Customize dialog, where you can assign the selected macro to a menu command, a toolbar, or an event. a 1241813509 15 Creates a new script. 9 780784134 2a Opens the editor and creates a new module. 5 63545 a5 Lists the libraries and the modules where you can open or save your macros. To save a macro with a particular document, open the document, and then open this dialog. 5 63547 26 Lists the existing macros and dialogs. a 1317868044 33 Creates a new macro, or deletes the selected macro. a 1317868043 74 Opens the Macro Organizer dialog, where you can add, edit, or delete existing macro modules, dialogs, and libraries. 5 63548 56 Lists the existing macro libraries for the current application and any open documents. a 1241813511 44 Opens a dialog where you can change the name of the selected script. 4 5959 22 Opens a dialog to organize macros. 4 6704 6e Adds and removes digital signatures to and from your macros. You can also use the dialog to view certificates. 15 .uno%3AMacroSignature 6e Adds and removes digital signatures to and from your macros. You can also use the dialog to view certificates. 27 .uno%3AMacroOrganizer%3FTabId%3Ashort=1 32 Opens the Dialogs tab page of the Macro Organizer. f .uno%3ARunMacro 2b Opens a dialog where you can start a macro. 4 6692 2b Opens a dialog where you can start a macro. 4 6671 18 Stops recording a macro. 14 .uno%3AMacroRecorder 14 Records a new macro. 4 6669 14 Records a new macro. 14 .uno%3AStopRecording 18 Stops recording a macro. 5 33824 2e Protects the selected library with a password. a 1239894027 34 Enter the current password for the selected library. a 1239894037 2e Enter a new password for the selected library. a 1239894039 32 Reenter the new password for the selected library. 4 6690 50 Opens a submenu with links to dialogs where you can organize macros and scripts. 45 .uno%3AScriptOrganizer%3FScriptOrganizer.Language%3Astring=JavaScript 2e Opens a dialog where you can organize scripts. 16 .uno%3AScriptOrganizer 50 Opens a submenu with links to dialogs where you can organize macros and scripts. 44 .uno%3AScriptOrganizer%3FScriptOrganizer.Language%3Astring=BeanShell 2e Opens a dialog where you can organize scripts. a 1317700644 43 Replaces a library that has the same name with the current library. 5 63549 6d Enter a name or the path to the library that you want to append. You can also select a library from the list. a 1317700643 68 Adds the selected library as a read-only file. The library is reloaded each time you start %PRODUCTNAME. 16 .uno%3AConfigureDialog 59 Customizes $[officename] menus, shortcut keys, toolbars, and macro assignments to events. 4 5907 59 Customizes $[officename] menus, shortcut keys, toolbars, and macro assignments to events. 4 5904 59 Customizes $[officename] menus, shortcut keys, toolbars, and macro assignments to events. 12 .uno%3ALoadToolBox 59 Customizes $[officename] menus, shortcut keys, toolbars, and macro assignments to events. 9 705499960 71 Opens the New Menu dialog where you can enter the name of a new menu as well as select the location for the menu. 9 705507646 2f Opens a menu that contains additional commands. 9 705498948 47 Select the application or open document where you want to add the menu. f HID_CONFIG_MENU 6b Customizes and saves current menu layouts as well as creates new menus. You cannot customize context menus. 29 SFX2_IMAGEBUTTON_TP_CONFIG_MENU_BTN_MN_UP 28 Moves the selected item up one position. 2b SFX2_IMAGEBUTTON_TP_CONFIG_MENU_BTN_MN_DOWN 2a Moves the selected item down one position. 9 705499974 ad Opens the Add Commands dialog. Select the command that you want to add to the menu, and then click Add. You can also drag-and-drop the command into the Customize dialog box. 16 HID_MENUCONFIG_LISTBOX 6c Displays a list of the available menu commands for the selected menu in the current application or document. 9 705498935 32 Select the menu and submenu that you want to edit. 9 705507642 29 Opens a submenu with additional commands. 2e SFX2%3ALISTBOX%3ATP_CONFIG_ACCEL%3ABOX_ACC_KEY 46 Displays the shortcut keys that are assigned to the selected function. 29 sfx2_PushButton_TP_CONFIG_ACCEL_BTN_RESET 32 Resets modified values back to the default values. 5 40077 5d Assigns or edits the shortcut keys for $[officename] commands, or $[officename] Basic macros. 34 SFX2%3APUSHBUTTON%3ATP_CONFIG_ACCEL%3ABTN_ACC_REMOVE 48 Deletes the selected element or elements without requiring confirmation. 2a SFX2_RADIOBUTTON_TP_CONFIG_ACCEL_RB_MODULE 41 Displays shortcut keys for the current $[officename] application. 2e SFX2%3APUSHBUTTON%3ATP_CONFIG_ACCEL%3ABTN_SAVE 4c Saves the current shortcut key configuration, so that you can load it later. 5 40078 be Lists the shortcut keys and the associated commands. To assign or modify the shortcut key for the command selected in the Function list, click a shortcut in this list, and then click Modify. 2a SFX2_RADIOBUTTON_TP_CONFIG_ACCEL_RB_OFFICE 49 Displays shortcut keys that are common to all $[officename] applications. 5 40080 dd Select a function that you want to assign a shortcut key to, click a key combination in the Shortcut keys list, and then click Modify. If the selected function already has a shortcut key, it is displayed in the Keys list. 5 40079 63 Lists the available function categories. To assign shortcuts to Styles, open the "Styles" category. 34 SFX2%3APUSHBUTTON%3ATP_CONFIG_ACCEL%3ABTN_ACC_CHANGE 6c Assigns the key combination selected in the Shortcut keys list to the command selected in the Function list. 2e SFX2%3APUSHBUTTON%3ATP_CONFIG_ACCEL%3ABTN_LOAD 4b Replaces the shortcut key configuration with one that was previously saved. 5 40042 49 Select the location where to load the configuration and where to save it. 5 40052 21 The Modify button opens a submenu 5 40051 22 The Toolbar button opens a submenu 5 40041 21 The Modify button opens a submenu 5 40050 6c Opens the Name dialog, where you enter the name of a new toolbar and select the location of the new toolbar. a 1080136589 99 Adds new icons to the list of icons. You see a file open dialog that imports the selected icon or icons into the internal icon directory of %PRODUCTNAME. 29 svx_PushButton_MD_ICONSELECTOR_BTN_REMOVE 58 Click to remove the selected icon from the list. Only user-defined icons can be removed. 10 HID_CONFIG_EVENT 6d Assigns macros to program events. The assigned macro runs automatically every time the selected event occurs. 9 705548803 34 Deletes the macro assignment for the selected event. 2f SFX2%3APUSHBUTTON%3ATP_CONFIG_EVENT%3APB_ASSIGN 41 Opens the Macro Selector to assign a macro to the selected event. 2f SFX2%3APUSHBUTTON%3ATP_CONFIG_EVENT%3APB_DELETE 34 Deletes the macro assignment for the selected event. 9 705547787 59 Select first where to save the event binding, in the current document or in %PRODUCTNAME. 9 705548802 41 Opens the Macro Selector to assign a macro to the selected event. 5 40000 b1 The big list box lists the events and the assigned macros. After you selected the location in the Save In list box, select an event in the big list box. Then click Assign Macro. 5 64057 56 Displays a Save as dialog to save the selected file as an XSLT filter package (*.jar). 5 64051 27 Displays the help page for this dialog. 5 64052 3a Select one or more filters, then click one of the buttons. 1c .uno%3AOpenXMLFilterSettings 7d Opens the XML Filter Settings dialog, where you can create, edit, delete, and test filters to import and to export XML files. 5 10958 7d Opens the XML Filter Settings dialog, where you can create, edit, delete, and test filters to import and to export XML files. 5 64053 2d Opens a dialog with the name of a new filter. 5 64055 32 Opens a dialog with the name of the selected file. 5 64056 44 Deletes the selected file after you confirm the dialog that follows. 5 64054 32 Opens a dialog with the name of the selected file. 5 64059 12 Closes the dialog. 5 64058 4d Displays an Open dialog to open a filter from an XSLT filter package (*.jar). 5 64064 3c Select the application that you want to use with the filter. 5 64066 99 Enter the file extension to use when you open a file without specifying a filter. $[officename] uses the file extension to determine which filter to use. 5 64063 5a Enter the name that you want to display in the list box of the XML Filter Settings dialog. 5 64061 34 Enter or edit general information for an XML filter. 5 64065 4d Enter the name that you want to display in the File type box in file dialogs. 5 64067 1b Enter a comment (optional). 5 64068 22 Enter the DOCTYPE of the XML file. 5 64071 6b If this is an export filter, enter the file name of the XSLT stylesheet that you want to use for exporting. 5 64075 7b Enter the name of the template that you want to use for importing. In the template, styles are defined to display XML tags. 5 64073 6b If this is an import filter, enter the file name of the XSLT stylesheet that you want to use for importing. 5 64087 1e Opens a file selection dialog. 5 64070 1e Opens a file selection dialog. 5 64072 1e Opens a file selection dialog. 5 64074 1e Opens a file selection dialog. 5 64069 6e If you want, enter the public or system identifier of the DTD (Document Type Definition) that you want to use. 5 64080 5a Displays the file name of the XSLT filter that you entered on the Transformation tab page. 5 64077 93 Locate the file that you want to apply the XML export filter to. The XML code of the transformed file is displayed in the XML Filter output window. 5 64082 8f Opens the XML Filter output window, where the XML source of the selected document is displayed. The document is used to test the import filter. 5 64084 3c Re-opens the document that was last opened with this dialog. 5 64081 57 Displays the file name of the template that you entered on the Transformation tab page. 5 64078 d9 The front-most open file that matches the XML filter criteria will be used to test the filter. The current XML export filter transforms the file and the resulting XML code is displayed in the XML Filter output window. 5 64083 5f Opens a file selection dialog. The selected file is opened using the current XML import filter. 5 64090 5a Displays the file name of the XSLT filter that you entered on the Transformation tab page. 5 64085 3c Re-opens the document that was last opened with this dialog. 5 64050 37 Validates the contents of the XML Filter output window. 5 64088 28 Lists the test results of an XML filter. 5 64089 28 Lists the test results of an XML filter. a 1237599233 68 Check to move character-by-character through the selected text. If not checked, full words are replaced. 5 34074 1f Displays the current selection. 5 39893 aa Replaces the selection with the suggested characters or word according to the format options. Every time the same selection is detected it will be replaced automatically. a 1237598724 44 The Hanja part will be displayed as ruby text above the Hangul part. a 1237598721 41 The original characters are replaced by the suggested characters. a 1237598726 44 The Hangul part will be displayed as ruby text above the Hanja part. a 1237598725 44 The Hanja part will be displayed as ruby text below the Hangul part. 5 40038 36 Displays all available replacements in the dictionary. a 1237599234 33 Check to convert only Hangul. Do not convert Hanja. 5 39895 3e Displays the first replacement suggestion from the dictionary. 5 39892 5d Replaces the selection with the suggested characters or word according to the format options. 5 39993 26 Opens the Hangul/Hanja Options dialog. a 1237598723 43 The Hanja part will be displayed in brackets after the Hangul part. 1c .uno%3AHangulHanjaConversion 4f Converts the selected Korean text from Hangul to Hanja or from Hanja to Hangul. 5 10959 4f Converts the selected Korean text from Hangul to Hanja or from Hanja to Hangul. a 1237602817 57 Finds your Hangul input in the dictionary and replaces it with the corresponding Hanja. 5 39891 81 No changes will be made to the current selection, and every time the same selection is detected it will be skipped automatically. a 1237599235 33 Check to convert only Hanja. Do not convert Hangul. 5 40040 36 Displays all available replacements in the dictionary. a 1237598727 44 The Hangul part will be displayed as ruby text below the Hanja part. a 1237598722 43 The Hangul part will be displayed in brackets after the Hanja part. 5 39889 12 Closes the dialog. 5 40039 36 Displays all available replacements in the dictionary. 5 39890 6d No changes will be made to the current selection. The next word or character will be selected for conversion. a 1237648387 60 Shows the replacement suggestion that you selected the last time as the first entry on the list. a 1237648388 4b Automatically replaces words that only have one suggested word replacement. a 1237648385 56 Ignores positional characters at the end of Korean words when you search a dictionary. a 1237651970 57 Opens the Edit Custom Dictionary dialog where you can edit any user-defined dictionary. 3c svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_OPT%3ACB_AUTOCLOSE 70 Closes the Hangul/Hanja Conversion dialog box after you click Ignore, Always Ignore, Replace, or Always Replace. 5 39994 ae Lists all user-defined dictionaries. Select the check box next to the dictionary that you want to use. Clear the check box next to the dictionary that you do not want to use. a 1237651969 4b Opens the New dictionary dialog box, where you can create a new dictionary. a 1237651971 2d Deletes the selected user-defined dictionary. a 1237682177 20 Enter a name for the dictionary. a 1237665794 95 Type a suggested replacement for the entry that is selected in the Original text box. The replacement word can contain a maximum of eight characters. a 1237665796 95 Type a suggested replacement for the entry that is selected in the Original text box. The replacement word can contain a maximum of eight characters. a 1237665793 95 Type a suggested replacement for the entry that is selected in the Original text box. The replacement word can contain a maximum of eight characters. a 1237668353 3a Adds the current replacement definition to the dictionary. a 1237665795 95 Type a suggested replacement for the entry that is selected in the Original text box. The replacement word can contain a maximum of eight characters. a 1237667842 79 Select the entry in the current dictionary that you want to edit. If you want, you can also type a new entry in this box. 41 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_EDIT%3ACB_REPLACEBYCHAR 54 Converts the text on a character by character basis and not on a word by word basis. a 1237668354 1b Deletes the selected entry. a 1237667329 39 Select the user-defined dictionary that you want to edit. 5 10243 19 Checks spelling manually. 12 .uno%3ASpellDialog 19 Checks spelling manually. 4 5620 44 Opens a new window that displays the contents of the current window. 10 .uno%3ANewWindow 44 Opens a new window that displays the contents of the current window. a 1336459780 36 Hides the Registration dialog for the next seven days. 4 6537 59 Connects to the $[officename] Web site where you can register your copy of $[officename]. a 1336459779 7f Launches your default Web browser and connects to the $[officename] Web site where you can register your copy of $[officename]. 5 42777 59 Connects to the $[officename] Web site where you can register your copy of $[officename]. 9 586088966 36 Hides the Registration dialog for the next seven days. 1c .uno%3AOnlineRegistrationDlg 59 Connects to the $[officename] Web site where you can register your copy of $[officename]. 9 586088967 63 Permanently hides the Registration dialog. To register at a later time, choose Help - Registration. a 1336459781 63 Permanently hides the Registration dialog. To register at a later time, choose Help - Registration. 9 586088965 7f Launches your default Web browser and connects to the $[officename] Web site where you can register your copy of $[officename]. 10 .uno%3ASignature 70 Adds and removes digital signatures to and from your document. You can also use the dialog to view certificates. 9 541200975 70 Adds and removes digital signatures to and from your document. You can also use the dialog to view certificates. 1f HID_XMLSEC_QUERY_SAVEBEFORESIGN 4a You must save a file before you can apply a digital signature to the file. 1e HID_XMLSEC_INFO_WRONGDOCFORMAT 61 You must save a file in OpenDocument format before you can apply a digital signature to the file. a 1090130487 22 Opens the View Certificate dialog. 5 43081 36 Lists the digital signatures for the current document. a 1090130435 2a Removes the selected source from the list. a 1090130434 24 Opens the Select Certificate dialog. 4 6643 70 Adds and removes digital signatures to and from your document. You can also use the dialog to view certificates. a 1106676231 95 While checking for updates, you see a progress indicator. Wait for some messages to show up in the dialog, or click Cancel to abort the update check. a 1106674693 8c By default, only the downloadable extensions are shown in the dialog. Mark Show all Updates to see also other extensions and error messages. 5 42786 ec Click the Check for Updates button in the Extension Manager to check for online updates for all installed extensions. To check for online updates for only the selected extension, right-click to open the context menu, then choose Update. 5 42787 ec Click the Check for Updates button in the Extension Manager to check for online updates for all installed extensions. To check for online updates for only the selected extension, right-click to open the context menu, then choose Update. a 1106678282 54 When you click the Install button the Download and Installation dialog is displayed. 17 .uno%3AInsertHardHyphen 4d Inserts a hyphen that will keep bordering characters together on line breaks. 10 .uno%3AInsertRLM 92 Inserts a text direction mark that affects the text direction of any text following the mark. Available when complex text layout (CTL) is enabled. 11 .uno%3AInsertZWSP a9 Inserts an invisible space within a word that will insert a line break once it becomes the last character in a line. Available when complex text layout (CTL) is enabled. 13 .uno%3AInsertZWNBSP 94 Inserts an invisible space within a word that will keep the word together at the end of a line. Available when complex text layout (CTL) is enabled. 10 .uno%3AInsertLRM 92 Inserts a text direction mark that affects the text direction of any text following the mark. Available when complex text layout (CTL) is enabled. 19 .uno%3AFormattingMarkMenu 51 Opens a submenu to insert special formatting marks. Enable CTL for more commands. 1d .uno%3AInsertNonBreakingSpace 4c Inserts a space that will keep bordering characters together on line breaks. 17 .uno%3AInsertSoftHyphen 80 Inserts an invisible hyphen within a word that will appear and create a line break once it becomes the last character in a line. 5 34193 2e Displays the contents of the Gallery as icons. 5 34179 3c Click a theme to view the objects associated with the theme. 5 34178 56 Adds a new theme to the Gallery and lets you choose the files to include in the theme. e .uno%3AGallery 59 Opens the Gallery, where you can select graphics and sounds to insert into your document. 5 33770 56 Adds a new theme to the Gallery and lets you choose the files to include in the theme. 5 33775 52 To insert a Gallery object, select the object, and then drag it into the document. 4 5960 59 Opens the Gallery, where you can select graphics and sounds to insert into your document. 5 34194 55 Displays the contents of the Gallery as small icons, with title and path information. 9 706679301 2f Adds the selected file(s) to the current theme. 9 706679297 37 Adds all of the files in the list to the current theme. 9 706678785 2d Select the type of file that you want to add. 9 706675715 31 Displays or hides a preview of the selected file. 9 706679300 52 Locate the directory containing the files that you want to add, and then click OK. 9 706677761 8b Lists the available files. Select the file(s) that you want to add, and then click Add. To add all of the files in the list, click Add All. f .uno%3AGridMenu 26 Sets the display properties of a grid. 14 .uno%3ASnapLinesMenu 29 Specifies the display options for guides. 14 .uno%3AAVMediaPlayer 82 Opens the Media Player window where you can preview movie and sound files as well as insert these files into the current document. 4 6694 82 Opens the Media Player window where you can preview movie and sound files as well as insert these files into the current document. 4 6696 31 Inserts a video or sound file into your document. 14 .uno%3AInsertAVMedia 31 Inserts a video or sound file into your document. 9 705594384 88 Mark to enable the automatic check for updates. Choose Tools - Options - %PRODUCTNAME - Online Update to disable or enable this feature. 9 586155011 34 You can check for updates manually or automatically. 9 705597971 2f Click to select a folder to download the files. 5 34848 40 Pauses the download. Later click Resume to continue downloading. 5 34852 1f Installs the downloaded update. 5 33390 f2 Checks for available updates to your version of %PRODUCTNAME. If a newer version is available, you can choose to download the update. After downloading, if you have write permissions for the installation directory, you can install the update. 5 34845 f2 Checks for available updates to your version of %PRODUCTNAME. If a newer version is available, you can choose to download the update. After downloading, if you have write permissions for the installation directory, you can install the update. 5 34855 3b Aborts the download and deletes the partly downloaded file. 5 34850 94 Downloads and saves the update files to the desktop or a folder of your choice. Select the folder in Tools - Options - %PRODUCTNAME - Online Update. 5 34851 94 Downloads and saves the update files to the desktop or a folder of your choice. Select the folder in Tools - Options - %PRODUCTNAME - Online Update. 5 34849 1c Continues a paused download. a 2180354573 de Click to check for online updates of all installed extensions. To check for updates of the selected extension only, choose the Update command from the context menu. The check for availability of updates starts immediately. a 1180240435 87 Read the license. Click the Scroll Down button to scroll down if necessary. Click Accept to continue the installation of the extension. a 2180256282 57 Select an installed extension, then click to open the Options dialog for the extension. a 2180256276 1e Click Add to add an extension. 5 42792 57 Select an installed extension, then click to open the Options dialog for the extension. 39 service%3Acom.sun.star.deployment.ui.PackageManagerDialog 5c The Extension Manager adds, removes, disables, enables, and updates %PRODUCTNAME extensions. a 2180256281 de Click to check for online updates of all installed extensions. To check for updates of the selected extension only, choose the Update command from the context menu. The check for availability of updates starts immediately. 5 42772 5c The Extension Manager adds, removes, disables, enables, and updates %PRODUCTNAME extensions. a 2180354572 1e Click Add to add an extension. 5 42795 44 Select the extension that you want to remove, and then click Remove. a 2180256277 44 Select the extension that you want to remove, and then click Remove. 5 42794 20 Enable or disable the extension. a 2180256279 46 Select the extension that you want to disable, and then click Disable. a 2180256278 44 Select the extension that you want to enable, and then click Enable. a 1180242482 87 Read the license. Click the Scroll Down button to scroll down if necessary. Click Accept to continue the installation of the extension. 5 42768 5c The Extension Manager adds, removes, disables, enables, and updates %PRODUCTNAME extensions. 5 42769 7b Select the extension that you want to remove, enable, or disable. For some extensions, you can also open an Options dialog. 5 58993 2e Type a password. A password is case sensitive. a 1111689230 2e Type a password. A password is case sensitive. 2b UUI_EDIT_DLG_UUI_PASSWORD_ED_MASTERPASSWORD 55 Type a master password to prevent unauthorized users from accessing stored passwords. 36 UUI_EDIT_DLG_UUI_PASSWORD_CRT_ED_MASTERPASSWORD_REPEAT 1d Re-enter the master password. 33 UUI_EDIT_DLG_UUI_PASSWORD_CRT_ED_MASTERPASSWORD_CRT 55 Type a master password to prevent unauthorized users from accessing stored passwords. 27 FILTER_EDIT_RID_PDF_EXPORT_DLG_ED_PAGES 45 Saves the current file to Portable Document Format (PDF) version 1.4. 9 867844618 43 Selects a lossless compression of images. All pixels are preserved. 9 868025499 d2 Enable this checkbox to convert the URLs referencing other ODF files to PDF files with the same name. In the referencing URLs the extensions .odt, .odp, .ods, .odg, and .odm are converted to the extension .pdf. 9 867877473 96 Select to generate a PDF file that shows pages side by side in a continuous column. For more than two pages, the first page is displayed on the right. 9 867861605 5a Select to generate a PDF file that is shown in a window displaying the whole initial page. 9 867846149 26 Exports the pages you type in the box. 9 867877463 61 Select to generate a PDF file that shows the page zoomed to fit the width of the reader's window. 9 867893894 27 Printing the document is not permitted. 37 filter_CheckBox_RID_PDF_EXPORT_DLG_CB_TRANSITIONEFFECTS 4d Selects to export Impress slide transition effects to respective PDF effects. 9 867861608 5e Select to generate a PDF file that is shown with the document title in the reader's title bar. 32 filter_RadioButton_RID_PDF_EXPORT_DLG_RB_SELECTION 1e Exports the current selection. 36 filter_CheckBox_RID_PDF_TAB_GENER_CB_TRANSITIONEFFECTS 4d Selects to export Impress slide transition effects to respective PDF effects. 9 867844610 5c Exports all defined print ranges. If no print range is defined, exports the entire document. 31 filter_NumericField_RID_PDF_EXPORT_DLG_NF_QUALITY 2d Enter the quality level for JPEG compression. 30 filter_ListBox_RID_PDF_EXPORT_DLG_LB_FORMSFORMAT 3f Select the format of submitting forms from within the PDF file. 9 867877986 f9 Select to generate a PDF file that shows pages side by side in a continuous column. For more than two pages, the first page is displayed on the left. You must enable support for complex text layout on Tools - Options - Language settings - Languages. 2f filter_CheckBox_RID_PDF_EXPORT_DLG_CB_TAGGEDPDF 47 Selects to write PDF tags. This can increase file size by huge amounts. 9 867847702 3f Select the format of submitting forms from within the PDF file. 9 867845139 f0 Selects to export bookmarks of Writer documents as PDF bookmarks. Bookmarks are created for all outline paragraphs (Tools - Outline Numbering) and for all table of contents entries for which you did assign hyperlinks in the source document. 9 867845140 60 Choose to create a PDF form. This can be filled out and printed by the user of the PDF document. 9 867861104 46 Select to show all bookmark levels when the reader opens the PDF file. 9 867845143 190 If switched on, automatically inserted blank pages are being exported to pdf file. This is best if you are printing the pdf file double-sided. Example: In a book a chapter paragraph style is set to always start with an odd numbered page. The previous chapter ends on an odd page. %PRODUCTNAME inserts an even numbered blank page. This option controls whether to export that even numbered page or not. 9 867845138 45 Selects to export comments of Writer and Calc documents as PDF notes. 9 867861607 69 Select to generate a PDF file that is shown in a full screen reader window in front of all other windows. 2c filter_RadioButton_RID_PDF_EXPORT_DLG_RB_ALL 5c Exports all defined print ranges. If no print range is defined, exports the entire document. 9 867861612 41 Select to hide the reader's controls when the document is active. 9 867861611 40 Select to hide the reader's toolbar when the document is active. 9 867894415 35 Select to enable copying of content to the clipboard. 9 867894416 35 Select to enable text access for accessibility tools. 9 867877472 4f Select to generate a PDF file that shows pages in a continuous vertical column. 9 867850765 2d Enter the quality level for JPEG compression. 9 867845145 ea Converts to the PDF/A-1a format. This is defined as an electronic document file format for long term preservation. All fonts that were used in the source document will be embedded into the generated PDF file. PDF tags will be written. 37 filter_CheckBox_RID_PDF_TAB_SECURITY_CB_SEL_PERMISSIONS 73 Select to restrict some permissions. The permissions can be changed only when the user enters the correct password. 3b filter_ComboBox_RID_PDF_EXPORT_DLG_CO_REDUCEIMAGERESOLUTION 2c Select the target resolution for the images. 9 867845137 47 Selects to write PDF tags. This can increase file size by huge amounts. 4 6673 45 Saves the current file to Portable Document Format (PDF) version 1.4. 33 filter_CheckBox_RID_PDF_TAB_SECURITY_CB_SEC_ENCRYPT 7e Select to encrypt the PDF document with a password. The PDF file can be opened only when the user enters the correct password. 9 867861606 52 Select to generate a PDF file that is shown in a reader window centered on screen. 9 867893896 2f The document can be printed in high resolution. 9 867883610 3e Select a given zoom factor when the reader opens the PDF file. 36 filter_CheckBox_RID_PDF_EXPORT_DLG_CB_EXPORTEMPTYPAGES 190 If switched on, automatically inserted blank pages are being exported to pdf file. This is best if you are printing the pdf file double-sided. Example: In a book a chapter paragraph style is set to always start with an odd numbered page. The previous chapter ends on an odd page. %PRODUCTNAME inserts an even numbered blank page. This option controls whether to export that even numbered page or not. 9 867893902 33 All changes are permitted, except extracting pages. 9 867893895 65 The document can only be printed in low resolution (150 dpi). Not all PDF readers honor this setting. 9 867877462 62 Select to generate a PDF file that shows the page zoomed to fit entirely into the reader's window. 9 867893899 3a Only inserting, deleting, and rotating pages is permitted. 9 868024985 94 Cross-document links are opened with the Internet browser. The Internet browser must be able to handle the specified file type inside the hyperlink. 9 867893898 28 No changes of the content are permitted. 38 filter_RadioButton_RID_PDF_EXPORT_DLG_RB_JPEGCOMPRESSION ca Selects a JPEG compression of images. With a high quality level, almost all pixels are preserved. With a low quality level, some pixels get lost and artefacts are introduced, but file sizes are reduced. 2e filter_RadioButton_RID_PDF_EXPORT_DLG_RB_RANGE 26 Exports the pages you type in the box. 9 867877471 3c Select to generate a PDF file that shows one page at a time. 9 867897976 34 Click to open a dialog where you enter the password. 9 868024984 6c Links from your PDF document to other documents will be handled as it is specified in your operating system. 3c filter_RadioButton_RID_PDF_EXPORT_DLG_RB_LOSSLESSCOMPRESSION 43 Selects a lossless compression of images. All pixels are preserved. 9 867877461 b7 Select to generate a PDF file that shows the page contents without zooming. If the reader software is configured to use a zoom factor by default, the page shows with that zoom factor. 9 867877457 40 Select to generate a PDF file that shows only the page contents. 9 867877458 53 Select to generate a PDF file that shows a bookmarks palette and the page contents. 31 filter_CheckBox_RID_PDF_EXPORT_DLG_CB_EXPORTNOTES 45 Selects to export comments of Writer and Calc documents as PDF notes. 9 867877465 3e Select a given zoom factor when the reader opens the PDF file. 9 867877464 7a Select to generate a PDF file that shows the text and graphics on the page zoomed to fit the width of the reader's window. 9 867861614 4d Selects to export Impress slide transition effects to respective PDF effects. 9 867861105 5d Select to show bookmark levels down to the selected level when the reader opens the PDF file. 9 867877459 54 Select to generate a PDF file that shows a thumbnails palette and the page contents. 9 867844612 1e Exports the current selection. 9 867877470 6a Select to generate a PDF file that shows the pages according to the layout setting of the reader software. 9 867897983 34 Click to open a dialog where you enter the password. 9 867883100 41 Select to show the given page when the reader opens the PDF file. 9 867866738 5d Select to show bookmark levels down to the selected level when the reader opens the PDF file. 9 867845134 51 Selects to resample or down-size the images to a lower number of pixels per inch. 9 867845144 98 When the Sun PDF Import Extension is installed, this setting enables you to export the document as a .pdf file containing two file formats: PDF and ODF. 12 .uno%3AExportToPDF 45 Saves the current file to Portable Document Format (PDF) version 1.4. 9 868025500 141 The bookmarks (targets of references) in PDF files can be defined as rectangular areas. Additionally, bookmarks to named objects can be defined by their names. Enable the checkbox to export the names of objects in your document as valid bookmark targets. This allows to link to those objects by name from other documents. 9 867861610 41 Select to hide the reader's menu bar when the document is active. 9 868024986 c2 Cross-document links are opened with the PDF reader application that currently shows the document. The PDF reader application must be able to handle the specified file type inside the hyperlink. 9 867893900 29 Only filling in form fields is permitted. 9 867844611 26 Exports the pages you type in the box. 3b filter_CheckBox_RID_PDF_EXPORT_DLG_CB_REDUCEIMAGERESOLUTION 51 Selects to resample or down-size the images to a lower number of pixels per inch. 9 867844619 ca Selects a JPEG compression of images. With a high quality level, almost all pixels are preserved. With a low quality level, some pixels get lost and artefacts are introduced, but file sizes are reduced. 9 867893901 38 Only commenting and filling in form fields is permitted. 9 868025494 82 Enable this checkbox to export URLs to other documents as relative URLs in the file system. See "relative hyperlinks" in the Help. 9 867848207 2c Select the target resolution for the images. 17 .uno%3ASendMailDocAsPDF a6 Shows the Export as PDF dialog, exports the current document to Portable Document Format (PDF), and then opens an e-mail sending window with the PDF as an attachment. 4 6672 a6 Shows the Export as PDF dialog, exports the current document to Portable Document Format (PDF), and then opens an e-mail sending window with the PDF as an attachment. 5 35847 62 Enable or disable the macros. Choose Tools - Options - %PRODUCTNAME - Security to set the options. 1a HID_WARNING_MACROSDISABLED 62 Enable or disable the macros. Choose Tools - Options - %PRODUCTNAME - Security to set the options. 5 33374 62 Enable or disable the macros. Choose Tools - Options - %PRODUCTNAME - Security to set the options. a 1090146871 51 Opens the View Certificate dialog where you can examine the selected certificate. 9 553341495 51 Opens the View Certificate dialog where you can examine the selected certificate. 5 43082 51 Select the certificate that you want to digitally sign the current document with. e .uno%3AWebHtml 95 Creates a temporary copy of the current document in HTML format, opens the system default Web browser, and displays the HTML file in the Web browser. 5 38130 2e Selects the XForms model that you want to use. a 1368934412 f Enter the name. 5 38119 30 Opens a dialog where you can add a new instance. 18 .uno%3AShowDataNavigator 3c Specifies the data structure of the current XForms document. 5 38117 21 Renames the selected Xform model. 5 38121 42 Deletes the current instance. You cannot delete the last instance. 5 38128 47 Deletes the selected item (element, attribute, submission, or binding). a 1368933377 d4 When enabled, the document status will be set to "modified" when you change any form control that is bound to any data in the model. When not enabled, such a change does not set the document status to "modified". 5 38116 3c Opens the Add Model dialog where you can add an XForm model. 5 38137 3c Specifies the data structure of the current XForms document. 5 38125 70 Opens a dialog to add a new item (element, attribute, submission, or binding) as a sub-item of the current item. 5 38118 43 Deletes the selected XForm model. You cannot delete the last model. 5 38122 2d Switches the display to show or hide details. 5 38127 56 Opens a dialog to edit the selected item (element, attribute, submission, or binding). 5 38131 29 Adds, renames, and removes XForms models. 5 38129 34 Lists the items that belong to the current instance. 5 38120 39 Opens a dialog where you can modify the current instance. 5 10773 3c Specifies the data structure of the current XForms document. 5 38124 70 Opens a dialog to add a new item (element, attribute, submission, or binding) as a sub-item of the current item. 5 38123 3c Specifies the data structure of the current XForms document. 5 38132 3a This button has submenus to add, edit or remove instances. 5 38126 70 Opens a dialog to add a new item (element, attribute, submission, or binding) as a sub-item of the current item. 5 38001 1f Declares the item as read-only. 5 38003 25 Declares that the item is calculated. 5 38000 1e Declares the item as relevant. a 1368851479 22 Declares the item as a constraint. a 1368852494 2c Enter a default value for the selected item. a 1368854034 2b Select the data type for the selected item. a 1368855060 1e Declares the item as relevant. a 1368855066 25 Declares that the item is calculated. a 1368852492 1b Enter the name of the item. a 1368855064 1f Declares the item as read-only. a 1368851475 34 Specifies if the item must be included on the XForm. a 1368851481 1f Declares the item as read-only. a 1368851477 1e Declares the item as relevant. a 1368851483 25 Declares that the item is calculated. 5 38002 22 Declares the item as a constraint. 5 37999 34 Specifies if the item must be included on the XForm. a 1368855062 22 Declares the item as a constraint. a 1368869387 12 Enter a condition. a 1368871438 4f Opens the Form Namespaces dialog where you can add, edit, or delete namespaces. a 1368887820 21 Adds a new namespace to the list. 5 38111 34 Lists the currently defined namespaces for the form. a 1368887822 1f Deletes the selected namespace. a 1368887821 1d Edits the selected namespace. 5 38017 5a Select a user-defined data type and click the button to delete the user-defined data type. 5 38001 1f Declares the item as read-only. 5 37998 e7 Enter the DOM node what's a DOM node? spec doesn't tellto bind the control model towhat's a control model? spec doesn't tell. may be a typo in spec: control's model?. Click the ... button for a dialog to enter the XPath expression. 5 38005 f2 Specifies how whitespaces are to be handled when a string of the current data type is being processed. Possible values are Preserve, Replace, and Collapse. The sematics follow the definition at http://www.w3.org/TR/xmlschema-2/#rf-whiteSpace. 5 37997 43 Select a model from the list of all models in the current document. 5 38003 25 Declares that the item is calculated. 5 38019 d1 Select or enter the name of a binding. Selecting the name of an existing binding associates the binding with the form control. Entering a new name creates a new binding and associates it with the form control. 5 37938 2e Specifies an exclusive upper bound for values. 5 38000 1e Declares the item as relevant. 5 37940 2e Specifies an exclusive lower bound for values. 5 38016 ac Click the button to open a dialog where you can enter the name of a new user-defined data type. The new data type inherits all facets from the currently selected data type. 5 38006 125 Specifies a regular expression pattern. Strings validated against the data type must conform to this pattern to be valid. The XSD data type syntax for regular expressions is different from the regular expression syntax used elseswhere in %PRODUCTNAME, for example in the Find & Replace dialog. 5 37937 2e Specifies an inclusive upper bound for values. 5 38008 38 Specifies the minimum number of characters for a string. 5 38002 22 Declares the item as a constraint. 5 38007 30 Specifies the number of characters for a string. 5 37935 5b Specifies the maximum total number of digits that values of the decimal data type can have. 5 37999 34 Specifies if the item must be included on the XForm. 5 37939 2e Specifies an inclusive lower bound for values. 5 37936 66 Specifies the maximum total number of fractional digits that values of the decimal data type can have. 5 38004 41 Select a data type which the control should be validated against. 5 38009 38 Specifies the maximum number of characters for a string. 13 .uno%3APrintDefault 68 Click the Print File Directly icon to print the active document with the current default print settings. 4 5509 68 Click the Print File Directly icon to print the active document with the current default print settings. 5 10244 74 Click to open or close the Drawing bar, where you can add shapes, lines, text, and callouts to the current document. 5 10115 1a6 Draws a filled shape that is defined by the arc of a circle and a diameter line in the current document. To draw a circle segment, drag a circle to the size you want, and then click to define the starting point of the diameter line. Move your pointer to where you want to place the endpoint of the diameter line and click. You do not need to click on the circle. To draw an ellipse segment, hold down Shift while you drag. 13 .uno%3AText_Marquee c8 Inserts animated text with horizontal text direction into the current document. Drag a text box, and then type or paste your text. To assign an animation effect, choose Format - Text - Text Animation. a .uno%3APie 17e Draws a filled shape that is defined by the arc of an oval and two radius lines in the current document. To draw an ellipse pie, drag an oval to the size you want, and then click to define the first radius line. Move your pointer to where you want to place the second radius line and click. You do not need to click on the oval. To draw a circle pie, hold down Shift while you drag. 10 .uno%3ACircleCut 1a6 Draws a filled shape that is defined by the arc of a circle and a diameter line in the current document. To draw a circle segment, drag a circle to the size you want, and then click to define the starting point of the diameter line. Move your pointer to where you want to place the endpoint of the diameter line and click. You do not need to click on the circle. To draw an ellipse segment, hold down Shift while you drag. 16 .uno%3AVerticalCaption 1ab Draws a line that ends in a rectangular callout with vertical text direction from where you drag in the current document. Drag a handle of the callout to resize the callout. To add text, click the edge of the callout, and then type or paste your text. To change a rectangular callout to a rounded callout, drag the largest corner handle when the pointer changes to a hand. Only available when Asian language support is enabled. 13 .uno%3AVerticalText 14a Draws a text box with vertical text direction where you click or drag in the current document. Click anywhere in the document, and then type or paste your text. You can also move the cursor to where you want to add the text, drag a text box, and then type or paste your text. Only available when Asian language support is enabled. b .uno%3ALine 82 Draws a straight line where you drag in the current document. To constrain the line to 45 degrees, hold down Shift while you drag. a .uno%3AArc 145 Draws an arc in the current document. To draw an arc, drag an oval to the size you want, and then click to define the starting point of the arc. Move your pointer to where you want to place the endpoint and click. You do not need to click on the oval. To draw an arc that is based on a circle, hold down Shift while you drag. 17 .uno%3APolygon_Unfilled 125 Draws a line composed of a series of straight line segments. Drag to draw a line segment, click to define the endpoint of the line segment, and then drag to draw a new line segment. Double-click to finish drawing the line. To create a closed shape, double-click the starting point of the line. 5 10254 176 Draws a line that ends in a rectangular callout with horizontal text direction from where you drag in the current document. Drag a handle of the callout to resize the callout. To add text, click the edge of the callout, and then type or paste your text. To change a rectangular callout to a rounded callout, drag the largest corner handle when the pointer changes to a hand. 16 .uno%3ABezier_Unfilled 15c Draws a smooth Bezier curve. Click where you want the curve to start, drag, release, and then move the pointer to where you want the curve to end and click. Move the pointer and click again to add a straight line segment to the curve. Double-click to finish drawing the curve. To create a closed shape, double click the starting point of the curve. 5 10112 17e Draws a filled shape that is defined by the arc of an oval and two radius lines in the current document. To draw an ellipse pie, drag an oval to the size you want, and then click to define the first radius line. Move your pointer to where you want to place the second radius line and click. You do not need to click on the oval. To draw a circle pie, hold down Shift while you drag. e .uno%3AEllipse ad Draws an oval where you drag in the current document. Click where you want to draw the oval, and drag to the size you want. To draw a circle, hold down Shift while you drag. 5 10906 1ab Draws a line that ends in a rectangular callout with vertical text direction from where you drag in the current document. Drag a handle of the callout to resize the callout. To add text, click the edge of the callout, and then type or paste your text. To change a rectangular callout to a rounded callout, drag the largest corner handle when the pointer changes to a hand. Only available when Asian language support is enabled. 5 10110 ad Draws an oval where you drag in the current document. Click where you want to draw the oval, and drag to the size you want. To draw a circle, hold down Shift while you drag. 11 .uno%3AInsertDraw 74 Click to open or close the Drawing bar, where you can add shapes, lines, text, and callouts to the current document. 5 10114 145 Draws an arc in the current document. To draw an arc, drag an oval to the size you want, and then click to define the starting point of the arc. Move your pointer to where you want to place the endpoint and click. You do not need to click on the oval. To draw an arc that is based on a circle, hold down Shift while you drag. 5 10905 14a Draws a text box with vertical text direction where you click or drag in the current document. Click anywhere in the document, and then type or paste your text. You can also move the cursor to where you want to add the text, drag a text box, and then type or paste your text. Only available when Asian language support is enabled. f .uno%3ADrawText e1 Draws a text box with horizontal text direction where you drag in the current document. Drag a text box to the size you want anywhere in the document, and then type or paste your text. Rotate the text box to get rotated text. 5 10104 c3 Draws a rectangle where you drag in the current document. To draw a square, hold down Shift while you drag. Click where you want to place a corner of the rectangle, and drag to the size you want. 12 .uno%3ADrawCaption 176 Draws a line that ends in a rectangular callout with horizontal text direction from where you drag in the current document. Drag a handle of the callout to resize the callout. To add text, click the edge of the callout, and then type or paste your text. To change a rectangular callout to a rounded callout, drag the largest corner handle when the pointer changes to a hand. 5 10253 e1 Draws a text box with horizontal text direction where you drag in the current document. Drag a text box to the size you want anywhere in the document, and then type or paste your text. Rotate the text box to get rotated text. 5 10397 15c Draws a smooth Bezier curve. Click where you want the curve to start, drag, release, and then move the pointer to where you want the curve to end and click. Move the pointer and click again to add a straight line segment to the curve. Double-click to finish drawing the curve. To create a closed shape, double click the starting point of the curve. 5 10395 125 Draws a line composed of a series of straight line segments. Drag to draw a line segment, click to define the endpoint of the line segment, and then drag to draw a new line segment. Double-click to finish drawing the line. To create a closed shape, double-click the starting point of the line. 5 10465 c8 Inserts animated text with horizontal text direction into the current document. Drag a text box, and then type or paste your text. To assign an animation effect, choose Format - Text - Text Animation. 18 .uno%3AFreeline_Unfilled be Draws a freeform line where you drag in the current document. To end the line, release the mouse button. To draw a closed shape, release the mouse button near the starting point of the line. b .uno%3ARect c3 Draws a rectangle where you drag in the current document. To draw a square, hold down Shift while you drag. Click where you want to place a corner of the rectangle, and drag to the size you want. 5 10464 be Draws a freeform line where you drag in the current document. To end the line, release the mouse button. To draw a closed shape, release the mouse button near the starting point of the line. 5 10102 82 Draws a straight line where you drag in the current document. To constrain the line to 45 degrees, hold down Shift while you drag. 5 10193 16 Creates a spin button. 17 .uno%3AAutoControlFocus 107 If Automatic Control Focus is activated, the first form control will be selected when you open the document. If the button is not activated, the text will be selected after opening. The Tab Order that you have specified determines which is the first form control. 10 .uno%3ADateField 15 Creates a date field. 13 .uno%3ANumericField 1a Creates a numerical field. 5 10599 13 Creates a text box. 5 10594 16 Creates a push button. 13 .uno%3AMoreControls 20 Opens the More Controls toolbar. 11 .uno%3APushbutton 16 Creates a push button. 10 .uno%3AScrollBar 14 Creates a scrollbar. f .uno%3AGroupBox 33 Creates a frame to visually group several controls. 5 10707 19 Creates a currency field. 5 10148 14 Creates a check box. 5 10706 1a Creates a numerical field. 5 10704 15 Creates a date field. 12 .uno%3AImagebutton 27 Creates a button displayed as an image. e .uno%3AListBox 13 Creates a list box. 14 .uno%3ACurrencyField 19 Creates a currency field. 12 .uno%3AFileControl 2d Creates a button that enables file selection. 5 10597 24 Creates a field for displaying text. 14 .uno%3ANavigationBar 19 Creates a navigation bar. 15 .uno%3AFormattedField 1a Creates a formatted field. b .uno%3AEdit 13 Creates a text box. 5 10605 2d Creates a button that enables file selection. 13 .uno%3AImageControl 4c Creates an image control. It can only be used to add images from a database. 5 10604 27 Creates a button displayed as an image. 5 10710 4c Creates an image control. It can only be used to add images from a database. d .uno%3AConfig 55 The Form Controls toolbar contains tools that you need to create an interactive form. 5 10768 14 Creates a scrollbar. 5 10708 18 Creates a pattern field. 12 .uno%3ARadioButton 19 Creates an option button. 5 10728 1a Creates a formatted field. 13 .uno%3APatternField 18 Creates a pattern field. 5 10600 13 Creates a list box. 10 .uno%3ATimeField 15 Creates a time field. 5 11045 20 Opens the More Controls toolbar. 5 10763 107 If Automatic Control Focus is activated, the first form control will be selected when you open the document. If the button is not activated, the text will be selected after opening. The Tab Order that you have specified determines which is the first form control. c .uno%3ALabel 24 Creates a field for displaying text. 5 10192 14 Creates a combo box. 5 10603 34 Creates a table control to display a database table. 16 .uno%3AFormDesignTools 1e Opens the Form Design toolbar. 5 11046 1e Opens the Form Design toolbar. b .uno%3AGrid 34 Creates a table control to display a database table. f .uno%3AComboBox 14 Creates a combo box. 5 10147 19 Creates an option button. 5 10189 33 Creates a frame to visually group several controls. f .uno%3ACheckBox 14 Creates a check box. 5 10705 15 Creates a time field. 11 .uno%3ASpinButton 16 Creates a spin button. 5 10607 19 Creates a navigation bar. 5 10593 55 The Form Controls toolbar contains tools that you need to create an interactive form. 5 10739 3a The selected control is transformed into an option button. 5 10749 39 The selected control is transformed into a pattern field. 15 .uno%3AConvertToRadio 3a The selected control is transformed into an option button. 15 .uno%3AConvertToFixed 31 The selected control is transformed into a label. 5 10736 31 The selected control is transformed into a label. 5 10737 34 The selected control is transformed into a list box. 5 10748 3a The selected control is transformed into a currency field. 18 .uno%3AChangeControlType 64 Calls a submenu where you can select a control type to replace the control selected in the document. 5 10738 35 The selected control is transformed into a check box. 5 10734 34 The selected control is transformed into a text box. 14 .uno%3AConvertToDate 36 The selected control is transformed into a date field. 17 .uno%3AConvertToNumeric 3b The selected control is transformed into a numerical field. 18 .uno%3AConvertToCurrency 3a The selected control is transformed into a currency field. 5 10733 64 Calls a submenu where you can select a control type to replace the control selected in the document. 5 10751 3b The selected control is transformed into a formatted field. 5 10744 3a The selected control is transformed into a file selection. 18 .uno%3AConvertToImageBtn 39 The selected control is transformed into an image button. 17 .uno%3AConvertToPattern 39 The selected control is transformed into a pattern field. 1b .uno%3AConvertToFileControl 3a The selected control is transformed into a file selection. 14 .uno%3AConvertToTime 36 The selected control is transformed into a time field. 5 10750 3a The selected control is transformed into an image control. 1c .uno%3AConvertToImageControl 3a The selected control is transformed into an image control. 5 10747 3b The selected control is transformed into a numerical field. 14 .uno%3AConvertToEdit 34 The selected control is transformed into a text box. 14 .uno%3AConvertToList 34 The selected control is transformed into a list box. 5 10743 39 The selected control is transformed into an image button. 19 .uno%3AConvertToFormatted 3b The selected control is transformed into a formatted field. 15 .uno%3AConvertToCombo 35 The selected control is transformed into a combo box. 5 10741 35 The selected control is transformed into a combo box. 5 10746 36 The selected control is transformed into a time field. 5 10745 36 The selected control is transformed into a date field. 5 10735 32 The selected control is transformed into a button. 18 .uno%3AConvertToCheckBox 35 The selected control is transformed into a check box. 16 .uno%3AConvertToButton 32 The selected control is transformed into a button. 5 10753 1a Hides the selected column. 5 10606 5f Opens a submenu to select a data field to replace the data field selected in the table control. 5 10612 26 Deletes the currently selected column. 5 10755 1e Calls the Show Columns dialog. a 1368837633 8d In the Show Columns dialog you can select the columns to be shown. Hold down the Shift or Ctrl (Mac: Command) key to select multiple entries. 5 10754 3f Calls a submenu where you can select the columns to show again. 5 10611 48 Calls a submenu to select a data field to adopt it in the table control. 5 10756 2a Click All if you want to show all columns. 5 10613 40 Opens a dialog for editing the properties of a selected control. 18 .uno%3AControlProperties 40 Opens a dialog for editing the properties of a selected control. 5 38173 40 Opens a dialog for editing the properties of a selected control. 5 37894 50 Specifies the horizontal or vertical orientation for a scrollbar or spin button. 1b HID_PROP_DEFAULT_SELECT_SEQ 3a Specifies the list box entry to mark as the default entry. 5 37891 5a Specify the value to add or subtract when the user clicks the arrow icon on the scrollbar. 15 HID_PROP_EFFECTIVEMAX 68 Defines a value for the control field which can not be exceeded by another value introduced by the user. 5 37905 29 Sets the default value for the scrollbar. d HID_PROP_NAME 9f On the Properties tab page, this option specifies the name for the control field. On the Form Properties tab page, this option specifies the name for the form. 5 38111 2b Defines where the control will be anchored. 5 37895 3e Defines the X position of the control, relative to the anchor. 10 HID_PROP_HSCROLL 37 Adds the scrollbar type that you specify to a text box. 5 37793 165 Sets whether the value changes when the user scrolls a mouse wheel. Never: No change of the value. When focused: (default) The value changes when the control has the focus and the wheel is pointing at the control and gets scrolled. Always: The value changes when the wheel is pointing at the control and gets scrolled, no matter which control has the focus. 5 38102 5e If you set this option to "Yes", the Push Button receives the focus when you click the button. 11 HID_PROP_DROPDOWN 42 Specifies whether the combo box should dropdown (Yes) or not (No). f HID_PROP_HEIGHT 22 Defines the height of the control. 5 38107 4f Specifies the alignment option for text or graphics that are used on a control. 11 HID_PROP_VALUEMAX 68 Defines a value for the control field which can not be exceeded by another value introduced by the user. 5 37911 2d Sets the default value for the control field. 11 HID_PROP_VALUEMIN 67 You can determine here a value for the control field to prevent the user from entering a smaller value. 15 HID_PROP_TARGET_FRAME 6b Specifies the target frame to display the document that is opened by the "Open document / web page" action. 5 37893 bb Specifies the size of scrollbar thumb in "value units". A value of ("Scroll value max." minus "Scroll value min." ) / 2 would result in a thumb which occupies half of the background area. 10 HID_PROP_TIMEMAX 54 Determines a time which can not be exceeded by another value introduced by the user. 13 HID_PROP_BUTTONTYPE 51 The Action property determines the action that occurs when you activate a button. 5 37914 24 Displays text on more than one line. 13 HID_PROP_TARGET_URL 59 Specifies the URL address that opens when you click an "Open document / web page" button. 5 38105 54 Specifies the border color for controls that have the Border property set to "flat". d HID_PROP_TEXT 34 Sets the default text for a text box or a combo box. 5 37910 68 Defines a value for the control field which can not be exceeded by another value introduced by the user. 17 HID_PROP_STRINGITEMLIST 105 Defines the list entries visible in the document. Open this list and type your text. Use Shift+Enter for a new line. With list and combo boxes, you can define the list entries that will be visible in the document. Open the List entries field and type your text. f HID_PROP_BORDER 62 Determines if the field's border should be displayed "Without frame", with a "3-D look" or "Flat". 16 HID_PROP_NAVIGATIONBAR 59 Specifies whether to display the navigation bar on the lower border of the table control. 19 HID_PROP_EFFECTIVEDEFAULT 2d Sets the default value for the control field. 14 HID_PROP_LITERALMASK 76 Defines the literal mask. The literal mask contains the initial values and is always visible after downloading a form. 11 HID_PROP_TRISTATE 77 Specifies whether a check box can also represent ZERO values of a linked database apart from the TRUE and FALSE values. 10 HID_PROP_HELPURL 83 Specifies a batch label in URL spelling which refers to a help document and which can be called with the help of the control field. 11 HID_PROP_HELPTEXT 5b Provides the option of entering a help text that will be displayed as a tip on the control. 5 37933 cf Allows you to use line breaks and formatting in a control field, such as a text box or label. To manually enter a line break, press the Enter key. Select "Multi-line with formatting" to enter formatted text. 5 37912 58 Determines intervals to add or subtract with each activation of the spin button control. 15 HID_PROP_CONTROLLABEL 32 Specifies the source for the label of the control. 5 37928 55 Specifies to show or hide the positioning items in a selected Navigation Bar control. 5 37907 53 Specifies the color for symbols on controls, for example the arrows on a scrollbar. 12 HID_PROP_MULTILINE cf Allows you to use line breaks and formatting in a control field, such as a text box or label. To manually enter a line break, press the Enter key. Select "Multi-line with formatting" to enter formatted text. 5 37915 37 Adds the scrollbar type that you specify to a text box. c HID_PROP_TAG 4d Specifies additional information or a descriptive text for the control field. 5 37904 31 Specify the minimum value of a scrollbar control. d HID_PROP_FONT 3a Select the font for the text that is in the control field. 19 HID_PROP_CURRSYM_POSITION 65 Determines if the currency symbol is displayed before or after the number when using currency fields. 15 HID_PROP_DEFAULT_DATE 16 Sets the default date. 17 HID_PROP_DEFAULT_BUTTON 73 The Default button property specifies that the corresponding button will be operated when you press the Return key. 10 HID_PROP_VSCROLL 37 Adds the scrollbar type that you specify to a text box. 5 37906 3d Specifies the delay in milliseconds between repeating events. 18 HID_PROP_DEFAULT_CHECKED 42 Specifies whether an option or a check box is selected by default. 15 HID_PROP_EFFECTIVEMIN 67 You can determine here a value for the control field to prevent the user from entering a smaller value. 5 37913 7d Specifies if the action of a control such as a spin button repeats when you click the control and hold the mouse button down. 11 HID_PROP_EDITMASK 75 Defines the edit mask. By specifying a character code you can determine what the user can enter in the control field. 12 HID_PROP_ECHO_CHAR b5 If the text box is used as a password input, enter the ASCII-code of the display character. This character is displayed instead of the characters typed by the user for the password. d HID_PROP_SPIN 6e The "Yes" option transforms the control field into a spin button, where corresponding arrow buttons are added. 5 37931 5f Specifies to show or hide the filtering and sorting items in a selected Navigation Bar control. 5 37899 31 Resizes the image to fit the size of the control. 5 38104 65 Specifies whether Check boxes and Option buttons are displayed in a 3D look (default) or a flat look. 11 HID_PROP_TABINDEX 75 The Tab order property determines the order in which the controls are focused in the form when you press the Tab key. 12 HID_PROP_LINECOUNT 8b Specifies how many lines should be displayed in the dropdown list. This setting is only active if you chose "Yes" in the "Dropdown" option. 5 37892 5e Specify the value to add or subtract when the user clicks next to the slider on the scrollbar. 5 37896 3e Defines the Y position of the control, relative to the anchor. e HID_PROP_ALIGN 4f Specifies the alignment option for text or graphics that are used on a control. 10 HID_PROP_DATEMIN 33 Determines the earliest date that a user can enter. 5 37929 54 Specifies to show or hide the navigation items in a selected Navigation Bar control. 12 HID_PROP_IMAGE_URL 6f The Graphics property specifies the graphic's path and file name that you want to have displayed on the button. 13 HID_PROP_TIMEFORMAT 37 You can define the desired format for the time display. 15 HID_PROP_DEFAULTVALUE 2d Sets the default value for the control field. 19 HID_PROP_DECIMAL_ACCURACY 4c Determines the number of digits displayed to the right of the decimal point. 17 HID_PROP_MULTISELECTION 36 Allows you to select more than one item in a list box. 10 HID_PROP_TIMEMIN 32 Determines the minimum time that a user can enter. 10 HID_PROP_DATEMAX 54 Determines a date which can not be exceeded by another value introduced by the user. 5 38101 126 Specifies if a Push Button behaves as a Toggle Button. If you set Toggle to "Yes", you can switch between the "selected" and "not selected" control states when you click the button or press the spacebar while the the control has the focus. A button in the "selected" state appears "pressed in". 10 HID_PROP_TABSTOP 54 The Tabstop property determines if a control field can be selected with the tab key. 29 PCR_CHECKBOX_RID_DLG_SELECTLABELCONTROL_1 5e Check the No assignment box to remove the link between a control and the assigned label field. e HID_PROP_WIDTH 21 Defines the width of the control. 12 HID_PROP_FORMATKEY 5a Specifies the format code for the control. Click the ... button to select the format code. 15 HID_PROP_RECORDMARKER 73 Specifies whether the first column is displayed with row labels, in which the current record is marked by an arrow. 5 37862 68 Defines whether the control will be visible in live mode. In design mode, the control is always visible. 15 HID_PROP_AUTOCOMPLETE 2d Assigns the AutoFill function to a combo box. 5 37927 52 Specifies whether the icons in a selected Navigation Bar should be small or large. 5 37934 5e For text fields, select the line end code to be used when writing text into a database column. 18 HID_PROP_BACKGROUNDCOLOR 2f Sets the background color of the control field. 13 HID_PROP_MAXTEXTLEN 41 Defines the maximum number of characters that the user can enter. 15 HID_PROP_HIDDEN_VALUE 3f You can enter the data that is inherited by the hidden control. 18 HID_PROP_SHOWTHOUSANDSEP 1e Inserts a thousands separator. 11 HID_PROP_READONLY 49 Determines if the control is read-only (Yes) or if it can be edited (No). 5 37890 31 Specify the maximum value of a scrollbar control. 15 HID_PROP_DEFAULT_TIME 16 Sets the default time. 5 37909 67 You can determine here a value for the control field to prevent the user from entering a smaller value. 5 38103 6c Specifies whether a text selection on a control remains selected when a the focus is no longer on a control. 13 HID_PROP_DATEFORMAT 41 Here, you can determine the format you want for the date readout. 17 HID_PROP_CURRENCYSYMBOL 3e You can enter a character or a string for the currency symbol. 5 37930 50 Specifies to show or hide the action items in a selected Navigation Bar control. 10 HID_PROP_ENABLED 69 If a control field has the property "Enabled" (Yes), the form user will be able to use the control field. 12 HID_PROP_VALUESTEP 21 Determines spin button intervals. 12 HID_PROP_ROWHEIGHT 32 Specifies the row height of a table control field. 15 HID_PROP_STRICTFORMAT 5b If the strict format function is activated (Yes), only the allowed characters are accepted. e HID_PROP_LABEL 55 The Label property sets the label of the control field that is displayed in the form. 12 HID_PROP_PRINTABLE 50 Specifies whether you want the control field to appear in a document's printout. 11 HID_PROP_REFVALUE d3 You can enter a reference value for the web form, which will be remitted to a server when sending the form. With database forms, the value entered is written in the database field, assigned to the control field. 5 37900 85 Specifies the reference to a linked cell on a spreadsheet. The live state or contents of the control are linked to the cell contents. 5 37941 112 Check boxes and radio buttons in spreadsheets can be bound to cells in the current document. If the control is enabled, the value you enter in Reference value (on) is copied to the cell. If the control is disabled, the value from Reference value (off) is copied to the cell. 5 37902 4a Select the mode of linking a list box with a linked cell on a spreadsheet. 14 HID_PROP_BOUNDCOLUMN a9 Use an index to specify the table field or table SQL query to link to the field that is provided under Data field. Valid values for this property are 1, 2, 3, and so on. 17 HID_PROP_FILTERPROPOSAL f9 While designing your form, you can set the "Filter proposal" property for each text box in the Data tab of the corresponding Properties dialog. In subsequent searches in the filter mode, you can select from all information contained in these fields. 16 HID_PROP_CONTROLSOURCE 49 Specifies the field of the data source table to which the control refers. 13 HID_PROP_LISTSOURCE b3 With database forms, specifies the data source for the list content of the form-element. This field can be used to define a value list for documents without a database connection. 5 37901 5a Enter a cell range that contains the entries for a list box or combo box on a spreadsheet. 17 HID_PROP_LISTSOURCETYPE 3e Determines the data to fill the lists in list and combo boxes. 16 HID_PROP_EMPTY_IS_NULL c9 Defines how an empty string input should be handled. If set to Yes, an input string of length zero will be treated as a value NULL. If set to No, any input will be treated as-is without any conversion. 5 38090 4d This event takes place before an action is triggered by clicking the control. 5 38073 51 The When receiving focus event takes place if a control field receives the focus. 5 38083 71 The Mouse button released event occurs if the mouse button is released while the mouse pointer is on the control. 5 38081 41 The Mouse moved event occurs if the mouse moves over the control. 5 38075 59 The Item status changed event takes place if the status of the control field has changed. 5 38082 6f The Mouse button pressed event occurs if the mouse button is pressed while the mouse pointer is on the control. 5 38076 5b The Key pressed event occurs when the user presses any key while the control has the focus. 5 38089 82 The Changed event takes place when the control loses the focus and the content of the control has changed since it lost the focus. 5 38078 65 The Mouse moved while key pressed event takes place when the mouse is dragged while a key is pressed. 5 38068 3a The Execute action event occurs when an action is started. 5 38087 54 The Text modified event takes place if you enter or modify a text in an input field. 5 38092 5d The Key released event occurs when the user releases any key while the control has the focus. 5 38079 4c The Mouse inside event takes place if the mouse is inside the control field. 5 38080 50 The Mouse outside event takes place when the mouse is outside the control field. 5 38074 4c The When losing focus event takes place if a control field looses the focus. 5 10614 61 In this dialog you can specify, among others, the data source and the events for the whole form. 15 .uno%3AFormProperties 61 In this dialog you can specify, among others, the data source and the events for the whole form. 18 HID_PROP_SUBMIT_ENCODING 32 Specifies the type for encoding the data transfer. 16 HID_PROP_SUBMIT_METHOD 40 Specifies the method to transfer the completed form information. 5 38098 3e The Before reloading event occurs before the form is reloaded. 5 38091 37 The Prior to reset event occurs before a form is reset. 5 38096 4b The Before record action event occurs before the current record is changed. 5 38071 51 The Confirm deletion event occurs as soon as data has been deleted from the form. 5 38099 67 The Before unloading event occurs before the form is unloaded; that is, separated from its data source. 5 38069 72 The After update event occurs after the control content changed by the user has been written into the data source. 5 38097 58 The After record action event occurs directly after the current record has been changed. 5 38085 3d The After resetting event occurs after a form has been reset. 5 38093 63 The Fill parameters event occurs when the form to be loaded has parameters that must be filled out. 5 38088 73 The When unloading event occurs directly after the form has been unloaded; that is, separated from its data source. 5 38084 60 The After record change event occurs directly after the current record pointer has been changed. 5 38094 53 The Before record change event occurs before the current record pointer is changed. 5 38072 58 The Error occurred event is activated if an error occurs when accessing the data source. 5 38095 4a The When reloading event occurs directly after the form has been reloaded. 5 38077 46 The When loading event occurs directly after the form has been loaded. 5 38086 40 The Before submitting event occurs before the form data is sent. e HID_PROP_CYCLE 3f Determines how the navigation should be done using the tab key. 19 HID_PROP_CURSORSOURCETYPE 8a Defines whether the data source is to be an existing database table or query, or if the form is to be generated based on an SQL statement. 14 HID_PROP_ALLOW_EDITS 27 Determines if the data can be modified. 15 HID_PROP_MASTERFIELDS 80 If you create a subform, enter the data field of the parent form responsible for the synchronization between parent and subform. 14 HID_PROP_SLAVEFIELDS 6b If you create a subform, enter the variable where possible values from the parent form field can be stored. 12 HID_PROP_DATAENTRY 70 Determines if the form only allows the addition of new data (Yes) or if it allows other properties as well (No). 18 HID_PROP_ALLOW_ADDITIONS 20 Determines if data can be added. 15 HID_PROP_CURSORSOURCE fd Determines the content to be used for the form. The content can be an existing table or a query (previously created in the database), or it can be defined by an SQL-statement. Before you enter a content you have to define the exact type in Content type. 16 HID_PROP_SORT_CRITERIA 9c Specifies the conditions to sort the data in the form. The specification of the sorting conditions follows SQL rules without the use of the ORDER BY clause. 13 HID_PROP_DATASOURCE 37 Defines the data source to which the form should refer. 1a HID_PROP_ESCAPE_PROCESSING 46 Specifies whether the SQL statement is to be analyzed by %PRODUCTNAME. 18 HID_PROP_ALLOW_DELETIONS 26 Determines if the data can be deleted. 13 HID_PROP_NAVIGATION 4d Specifies whether the navigation functions in the lower form bar can be used. 18 HID_PROP_FILTER_CRITERIA 8c Enter the required conditions for filtering the data in the form. The filter specifications follow SQL rules without using the WHERE clause. 31 SVX_PUSHBUTTON_RID_SVXDLG_TAB_ORDER_PB_AUTO_ORDER 6f Click the Automatic Sort button to automatically sort the controls according to their position in the document. 30 SVX_PUSHBUTTON_RID_SVXDLG_TAB_ORDER_PB_MOVE_DOWN 5d Click the Move Down button to shift the selected control one position lower in the tab order. 2c pcr_PushButton_RID_DLG_TABORDER_PB_MOVE_DOWN 5d Click the Move Down button to shift the selected control one position lower in the tab order. 2d pcr_PushButton_RID_DLG_TABORDER_PB_AUTO_ORDER 6f Click the Automatic Sort button to automatically sort the controls according to their position in the document. 2a pcr_PushButton_RID_DLG_TABORDER_PB_MOVE_UP 5c Click the Move Up button to shift the selected control one position higher in the tab order. 10 .uno%3ATabDialog 79 In the Tab Order dialog you can modify the order in which control fields get the focus when the user presses the tab key. 5 38193 76 Lists all controls in the form. These controls can be selected with the tab key in the given order from top to bottom. 2e SVX_PUSHBUTTON_RID_SVXDLG_TAB_ORDER_PB_MOVE_UP 5c Click the Move Up button to shift the selected control one position higher in the tab order. 5 10615 79 In the Tab Order dialog you can modify the order in which control fields get the focus when the user presses the tab key. f .uno%3AAddField 52 Opens a window where you can select a database field to add to the form or report. 5 10623 52 Opens a window where you can select a database field to add to the form or report. 5 38070 88 The field selection window lists all database fields of the table or query that was specified as the data source in the Form Properties. 1e .uno%3ASwitchControlDesignMode b1 Toggles the Design mode on or off. This function is used to switch quickly between Design and User mode. Activate to edit the form controls, deactivate to use the form controls. 5 10629 b1 Toggles the Design mode on or off. This function is used to switch quickly between Design and User mode. Activate to edit the form controls, deactivate to use the form controls. 5 22300 b1 Toggles the Design mode on or off. This function is used to switch quickly between Design and User mode. Activate to edit the form controls, deactivate to use the form controls. 1d .uno%3ASwitchXFormsDesignMode b1 Toggles the Design mode on or off. This function is used to switch quickly between Design and User mode. Activate to edit the form controls, deactivate to use the form controls. 5 38068 68 The Form Navigator contains a list of all created (logical) forms with the corresponding control fields. 5 10609 1c Renames the selected object. 1a .uno%3AShowPropertyBrowser 34 Starts the Properties dialog for the selected entry. 15 .uno%3AShowFmExplorer 84 Opens the Form Navigator. The Form Navigator displays all forms and subforms of the current document with their respective controls. 5 10703 34 Starts the Properties dialog for the selected entry. 5 10640 23 Creates a new form in the document. 5 10608 a6 Creates a hidden control in the selected form that is not displayed on the screen. A hidden control serves to include data that is transmitted together with the form. 5 10638 6f Adds new elements to the form. The Add function can only be called if a form is selected in the Form Navigator. 5 10633 84 Opens the Form Navigator. The Form Navigator displays all forms and subforms of the current document with their respective controls. 5 10639 1b Deletes the selected entry. 31 DBP_LISTBOX_RID_PAGE_TABLESELECTION_LB_DATASOURCE 3a Specifies the data source that contains the desired table. 2c DBP_LISTBOX_RID_PAGE_TABLESELECTION_LB_TABLE 1c Specifies the desired table. 39 DBP_LISTBOX_RID_PAGE_GW_FIELDSELECTION_LB_SELECTED_FIELDS 3f Displays the data fields that are accepted into the form field. 3e DBP_LISTBOX_RID_PAGE_LCW_CONTENTSELECTION_TABLE_LB_SELECTTABLE 76 In the Table field, select the table containing the data field whose content should be displayed in the control field. 3e DBP_LISTBOX_RID_PAGE_LCW_CONTENTSELECTION_FIELD_LB_SELECTFIELD 3d Displays all table fields chosen on the previous Wizard page. 3e DBP_EDIT_RID_PAGE_LCW_CONTENTSELECTION_FIELD_ET_DISPLAYEDFIELD 4a Specifies the field whose data are to be shown in the combo or list boxes. 32 DBP_COMBOBOX_RID_PAGE_LCW_FIELDLINK_CMB_TABLEFIELD 5b Specifies the linked table data field, which is related to the specified value table field. 36 DBP_COMBOBOX_RID_PAGE_LCW_FIELDLINK_CMB_VALUELISTFIELD 5d Specifies the current form data field which should be related to a field in the linked table. 3b DBP_RADIOBUTTON_RID_PAGE_OPTION_DBFIELD_RB_STOREINFIELD_YES 6d Specifies whether the user's entered or selected combination field value should be saved in a database field. 3a DBP_RADIOBUTTON_RID_PAGE_OPTION_DBFIELD_RB_STOREINFIELD_NO 7a Specifies that the value of this combination field will not be written in the database and will only be saved in the form. 33 DBP_LISTBOX_RID_PAGE_OPTION_DBFIELD_LB_STOREINFIELD 4b Specifies the data field where the combination field value should be saved. 13 .uno%3AOpenReadOnly 3a Opens forms in Design Mode so that the form can be edited. 5 10709 3a Opens forms in Design Mode so that the form can be edited. 5 10727 51 Specifies whether to start the wizard automatically when inserting a new control. 11 .uno%3AUseWizards 51 Specifies whether to start the wizard automatically when inserting a new control. 4 5539 76 Specifies whether to show or hide the Styles and Formatting window, which is where you can assign and organize Styles. 15 .uno%3ADesignerDialog 76 Specifies whether to show or hide the Styles and Formatting window, which is where you can assign and organize Styles. 5 33900 57 Assigns a style to the current paragraph, selected paragraphs, or to a selected object. 4 5552 57 Assigns a style to the current paragraph, selected paragraphs, or to a selected object. 11 .uno%3AStyleApply 57 Assigns a style to the current paragraph, selected paragraphs, or to a selected object. 13 .uno%3ACharFontName 4d Allows you to select a font name from the list or enter a font name directly. 5 10007 4d Allows you to select a font name from the list or enter a font name directly. 11 .uno%3AFontHeight 5d Allows you to choose between different font sizes from the list, or to enter a size manually. 1f .uno%3ATextdirectionLeftToRight 2f Specifies the horizontal direction of the text. 5 10907 2f Specifies the horizontal direction of the text. 1f .uno%3ATextdirectionTopToBottom 2d Specifies the vertical direction of the text. 5 10908 2d Specifies the vertical direction of the text. 5 10461 8a Click the Decrease Indent icon to reduce the left indent of the current paragraph or cell content and set it to the previous tab position. 16 .uno%3ADecrementIndent 8a Click the Decrease Indent icon to reduce the left indent of the current paragraph or cell content and set it to the previous tab position. 5 10462 88 Click the Increase Indent icon to increase the left indent of the current paragraph or cell content and set it to the next tab position. 16 .uno%3AIncrementIndent 88 Click the Increase Indent icon to increase the left indent of the current paragraph or cell content and set it to the next tab position. 5 10489 14d Applies the current highlight color to the background of a text selection. If no text is selected, click the Highlighting icon, select the text that you want to highlight, and then click the Highlighting icon again. To change the highlight color, click the arrow next to the Highlighting icon, and then click the color that you want. 10 .uno%3ABackColor 14d Applies the current highlight color to the background of a text selection. If no text is selected, click the Highlighting icon, select the text that you want to highlight, and then click the Highlighting icon again. To change the highlight color, click the arrow next to the Highlighting icon, and then click the color that you want. 16 .uno%3ABackgroundColor ab Click to open a toolbar where you can click a background color for a paragraph. The color is applied to the background of the current paragraph or the selected paragraphs. 5 10185 ab Click to open a toolbar where you can click a background color for a paragraph. The color is applied to the background of the current paragraph or the selected paragraphs. 5 27346 5f Click the Increase Spacing icon to increase the paragraph spacing above the selected paragraph. 18 .uno%3AParaspaceIncrease 5f Click the Increase Spacing icon to increase the paragraph spacing above the selected paragraph. 5 27347 5f Click the Decrease Spacing icon to decrease the paragraph spacing above the selected paragraph. 18 .uno%3AParaspaceDecrease 5f Click the Decrease Spacing icon to decrease the paragraph spacing above the selected paragraph. 15 .uno%3ASetBorderStyle 71 Click the Borders icon to open the Borders toolbar, where you can modify the border of a sheet area or an object. 5 10187 71 Click the Borders icon to open the Borders toolbar, where you can modify the border of a sheet area or an object. 10 .uno%3ALineStyle 5b Click this icon to open the Line Style toolbar, where you can modify the border line style. 5 10200 5b Click this icon to open the Line Style toolbar, where you can modify the border line style. 15 .uno%3AFrameLineColor 86 Click the Line Color (of the border) icon to open the Border Color toolbar, which enables you to change the border color of an object. 5 10201 86 Click the Line Color (of the border) icon to open the Border Color toolbar, which enables you to change the border color of an object. 5 26412 2f Allows you to switch between anchoring options. 17 .uno%3AToggleAnchorType 2f Allows you to switch between anchoring options. 14 .uno%3AOptimizeTable 57 Opens a toolbar that contains functions for optimizing the rows and columns in a table. 5 20510 57 Opens a toolbar that contains functions for optimizing the rows and columns in a table. 5 10301 69 Opens the Arrowheads toolbar. Use the symbols shown to define the style for the end of the selected line. 13 .uno%3ALineEndStyle 69 Opens the Arrowheads toolbar. Use the symbols shown to define the style for the end of the selected line. 5 10129 1c Rotates the selected object. 1d .uno%3AToggleObjectRotateMode 1c Rotates the selected object. 12 .uno%3AObjectAlign 2b Modifies the alignment of selected objects. 5 10130 2b Modifies the alignment of selected objects. 15 .uno%3ADecrementLevel 50 Moves the selected paragraph down one level in a numbering or bullets hierarchy. 13 .uno%3AOutlineRight 50 Moves the selected paragraph down one level in a numbering or bullets hierarchy. 5 10153 50 Moves the selected paragraph down one level in a numbering or bullets hierarchy. 5 20130 50 Moves the selected paragraph down one level in a numbering or bullets hierarchy. 15 .uno%3AIncrementLevel 50 Moves the selected paragraph up one level in the numbering or bullets hierarchy. 5 20131 50 Moves the selected paragraph up one level in the numbering or bullets hierarchy. 12 .uno%3AOutlineLeft 50 Moves the selected paragraph up one level in the numbering or bullets hierarchy. 5 10152 50 Moves the selected paragraph up one level in the numbering or bullets hierarchy. 5 10150 39 Positions the selected paragraph before the one above it. 10 .uno%3AOutlineUp 39 Positions the selected paragraph before the one above it. d .uno%3AMoveUp 39 Positions the selected paragraph before the one above it. 5 20134 39 Positions the selected paragraph before the one above it. f .uno%3AMoveDown 38 Positions the selected paragraph after the one below it. 5 10151 38 Positions the selected paragraph after the one below it. 12 .uno%3AOutlineDown 38 Positions the selected paragraph after the one below it. 5 20135 38 Positions the selected paragraph after the one below it. 5 20138 5b Assigns bullet points to the selected paragraphs, or removes them from bulleted paragraphs. 14 .uno%3ADefaultBullet 5b Assigns bullet points to the selected paragraphs, or removes them from bulleted paragraphs. 4 5596 a3 Loads a document specified by an entered URL. You can type a new URL or select one from the list. %PRODUCTNAME automatically converts file paths into URL notation. e .uno%3AOpenUrl a3 Loads a document specified by an entered URL. You can type a new URL or select one from the list. %PRODUCTNAME automatically converts file paths into URL notation. 4 5508 3a Replaces the current document with the last saved version. d .uno%3AReload 3a Replaces the current document with the last saved version. 15 .uno%3ASelectTextMode d6 You can enable a selection cursor in a read-only text document or in the Help. Choose Edit - Select Text or open the context menu of a read-only document and choose Select Text. The selection cursor does not blink. e .uno%3AEditDoc 3b Enables you to edit a read-only document or database table. 5 20989 d6 You can enable a selection cursor in a read-only text document or in the Help. Choose Edit - Select Text or open the context menu of a read-only document and choose Select Text. The selection cursor does not blink. 4 6312 3b Enables you to edit a read-only document or database table. 5 33373 d6 You can enable a selection cursor in a read-only text document or in the Help. Choose Edit - Select Text or open the context menu of a read-only document and choose Select Text. The selection cursor does not blink. 11 .uno%3ADSBEditDoc 3d Turns the edit mode for the current database table on or off. 4 6302 73 Click to interrupt the current loading process, Ctrl-click (Mac: Command-click) to interrupt all loading processes. b .uno%3AStop 73 Click to interrupt the current loading process, Ctrl-click (Mac: Command-click) to interrupt all loading processes. 4 6674 4a Exports the current document directly as PDF. No settings dialog is shown. 18 .uno%3AExportDirectToPDF 4a Exports the current document directly as PDF. No settings dialog is shown. 15 .uno%3AStatusGetTitle 42 Displays information about the active %PRODUCTNAME Basic document. 5 30808 42 Displays information about the active %PRODUCTNAME Basic document. 5 30806 7d Displays the current cursor position in the %PRODUCTNAME Basic document. The row number is specified, then the column number. 18 .uno%3AStatusGetPosition 7d Displays the current cursor position in the %PRODUCTNAME Basic document. The row number is specified, then the column number. 5 35079 2a Assigns a name to an Internet URL or file. 5 35081 55 Allows you to either type a URL, or insert a URL from a document using drag-and-drop. 13 .uno%3ASetHyperlink 3c Inserts a hyperlink from the current URL into your document. 5 10362 3c Inserts a hyperlink from the current URL into your document. 5 35054 75 Click and choose one of the Internet search engines from the submenu. The search term is entered in the URL Name box. 5 35053 36 Specifies the target frame type for the specified URL. 16 .uno%3AHyperlinkDialog 3e Opens a dialog that enables you to create and edit hyperlinks. 5 10955 30 Opens the hyperlink in your default web browser. 5 34093 22 Applies the data to your document. 5 34089 2c Select the type of hyperlink to be inserted. 5 34088 39 Resets the entries in the dialog to their original state. 5 21835 1b Opens the Hyperlink dialog. 5 21840 20 Copies the URL to the clipboard. 5 27382 3e Opens a dialog that enables you to create and edit hyperlinks. 14 .uno%3AEditHyperlink 1b Opens the Hyperlink dialog. 5 21839 2a Removes the hyperlink, leaving plain text. 5 34094 21 Closes the dialog without saving. 4 5678 3e Opens a dialog that enables you to create and edit hyperlinks. 1c .uno%3AOpenHyperlinkOnCursor 30 Opens the hyperlink in your default web browser. 9 704474663 87 Opens the Assign Macro dialog, in which you can give events such as "mouse over object" or "trigger hyperlink" their own program codes. 5 34095 3f Inserts the target in the Target field of the Hyperlink dialog. 9 704458279 87 Opens the Assign Macro dialog, in which you can give events such as "mouse over object" or "trigger hyperlink" their own program codes. 9 704448550 1f Enter a name for the hyperlink. 9 704447499 3d Allows you to log in to the FTP address as an anonymous user. 9 704450082 43 Specifies whether the hyperlink is inserted as text or as a button. 9 704448522 3f Specifies your password, if you are working with FTP addresses. 9 704466466 43 Specifies whether the hyperlink is inserted as text or as a button. 9 704497702 1f Enter a name for the hyperlink. 9 704499234 43 Specifies whether the hyperlink is inserted as text or as a button. 9 704464934 1f Enter a name for the hyperlink. 9 704458253 24 Opens the Target in Document dialog. 9 704507431 87 Opens the Assign Macro dialog, in which you can give events such as "mouse over object" or "trigger hyperlink" their own program codes. 5 34090 a3 Enter a URL for the file that you want to open when you click the hyperlink. If you do not specify a target frame, the file opens in the current document or frame. 9 704448548 3f Specifies the visible text or button caption for the hyperlink. 9 704466976 c3 Enter the name of the frame that you want the linked file to open in, or select a predefined frame from the list. If you leave this box blank, the linked file opens in the current browser window. 9 704446979 19 Creates an FTP hyperlink. 9 704482850 43 Specifies whether the hyperlink is inserted as text or as a button. 9 704491047 87 Opens the Assign Macro dialog, in which you can give events such as "mouse over object" or "trigger hyperlink" their own program codes. 9 704499744 c3 Enter the name of the frame that you want the linked file to open in, or select a predefined frame from the list. If you leave this box blank, the linked file opens in the current browser window. 9 704450592 c3 Enter the name of the frame that you want the linked file to open in, or select a predefined frame from the list. If you leave this box blank, the linked file opens in the current browser window. 9 704446980 1b Creates a Telnet hyperlink. 9 704464932 3f Specifies the visible text or button caption for the hyperlink. 9 704497700 3f Specifies the visible text or button caption for the hyperlink. 5 34096 64 Once the hyperlink has been completely entered, click on Close to set the link and leave the dialog. 9 704483360 c3 Enter the name of the frame that you want the linked file to open in, or select a predefined frame from the list. If you leave this box blank, the linked file opens in the current browser window. 5 34083 1a Creates an http hyperlink. 9 704481316 3f Specifies the visible text or button caption for the hyperlink. 5 34097 48 Specifies the position in the target document where you wish to jump to. 9 704448520 41 Specifies your login name, if you are working with FTP addresses. 9 704446978 1a Creates an http hyperlink. 9 704481318 1f Enter a name for the hyperlink. 9 704458252 3d Opens a web browser, into which you can load the desired URL. 9 704463362 36 Assigns the specified e-mail address to the hyperlink. 9 704464903 57 Specifies the subject that is inserted in the subject line of the new message document. 9 704463363 28 Assigns a news address to the hyperlink. 5 34084 36 Assigns the specified e-mail address to the hyperlink. 5 34091 67 Specifies the full URL of the addressee, in the form mailto:name@provider.com or news:group.server.com. 9 704474632 27 Hides or shows the data source browser. 5 34092 a3 Enter a URL for the file that you want to open when you click the hyperlink. If you do not specify a target frame, the file opens in the current document or frame. 5 34085 a3 Enter a URL for the file that you want to open when you click the hyperlink. If you do not specify a target frame, the file opens in the current document or frame. 9 704491012 33 Opens the Open dialog, where you can select a file. 9 704481287 4c Specifies a target for the hyperlink into the document specified under Path. 9 704491020 24 Opens the Target in Document dialog. 9 704496130 4e Specifies that the new document is created and immediately opened for editing. 9 704499207 2d Specifies the file type for the new document. 9 704496131 48 Specifies that the document is created but it is not immediately opened. 9 704497669 4c Enter a URL for the file that you want to open when you click the hyperlink. 9 704507400 3a Opens the Select Path dialog, where you can select a path. 5 34086 4e Specifies that the new document is created and immediately opened for editing. 13 .uno%3APreviousPage 30 Moves back to the previous page in the document. 5 20937 30 Moves back to the previous page in the document. 5 26497 30 Moves back to the previous page in the document. d .uno%3APageUp 30 Moves back to the previous page in the document. 5 26496 2f Moves forward to the next page in the document. f .uno%3APageDown 2f Moves forward to the next page in the document. 5 20938 2f Moves forward to the next page in the document. f .uno%3ANextPage 2f Moves forward to the next page in the document. 15 .uno%3AGoToStartOfDoc 28 Moves to the first page of the document. 5 20907 28 Moves to the first page of the document. 5 26498 28 Moves to the first page of the document. 10 .uno%3AFirstPage 28 Moves to the first page of the document. 5 26499 27 Moves to the last page of the document. f .uno%3ALastPage 27 Moves to the last page of the document. 13 .uno%3AGoToEndOfDoc 27 Moves to the last page of the document. 5 20908 27 Moves to the last page of the document. f .uno%3ACloseWin 1a Closes the current window. 4 5621 1a Closes the current window. 5 38834 60 Closes the connection to the data source. See Tools - Options - %PRODUCTNAME Base - Connections. 5 38978 c6 To rename an entry, call this command and enter the new name.. You can also do this by selecting the entry and pressing F2. The database must support renaming, otherwise this command is not enabled. 5 10764 36 Turns on and off the view of the data source explorer. 1a HID_BROWSER_DSADMINISTRATE 2d Opens the selected database file for editing. 5 39064 ab Opens a dialog to add/edit/remove a database file from the list of registered databases. The same dialog opens by choosing Tools - Options - %PRODUCTNAME Base - Databases. 18 .uno%3ADSBrowserExplorer 36 Turns on and off the view of the data source explorer. 5 39064 ab Opens a dialog to add/edit/remove a database file from the list of registered databases. The same dialog opens by choosing Tools - Options - %PRODUCTNAME Base - Databases. 5 38833 2d Opens the selected database file for editing. 5 10713 39 Sorts the data of the selected field in descending order. f .uno%3ASortDown 39 Sorts the data of the selected field in descending order. 5 10716 4f Filters the records, based on the content of the currently selected data field. 11 .uno%3AAutoFilter 4f Filters the records, based on the content of the currently selected data field. 17 .uno%3ARemoveFilterSort 51 Cancels the filter settings and displays all of the records in the current table. 5 10711 51 Cancels the filter settings and displays all of the records in the current table. e .uno%3ARefresh 1d Refreshes the displayed data. 5 10724 1d Refreshes the displayed data. 5 38977 6b Rebuilds the view of the database table. Use this command when you have changed the structure of the table. 13 .uno%3ASbaBrwInsert 5a Inserts all fields of the marked record into the current document at the cursor position. 5 12202 5a Inserts all fields of the marked record into the current document at the cursor position. a 1435042316 1d Accepts the database formats. a 1435045390 63 Specifies a format from the list, if the format information of certain data fields is not accepted. a 1435045402 3c Lists all database columns to be inserted into the document. a 1435042844 4d Specifies whether to insert a heading line for the columns in the text table. a 1435042317 63 Specifies a format from the list, if the format information of certain data fields is not accepted. a 1435046431 7e Opens the Table Format dialog, which enables you to define the table properties such as borders, background, and column width. a 1435042306 50 Inserts data selected from the data source browser into the document as a table. a 1435053589 43 Moves all listed database fields into the Table column(s) list box. a 1435053591 45 Removes the selected database field from the Table column(s) list box a 1435042333 5a Uses the field names of the database table as headings for each of the text table columns. a 1435042334 32 Inserts an empty heading line into the text table. a 1435053590 44 Moves the selected database field into the Table column(s) list box. a 1435045396 42 Specifies the database columns to be inserted into the text table. a 1435053592 3e Removes all database fields from the Table column(s) list box. a 1435046432 79 Opens the AutoFormat dialog, in which you can select format styles that are immediately applied when inserting the table. a 1435042308 4d Inserts data selected from the data source browser into the document as text. 17 .uno%3ADSBInsertContent 4b Updates the contents of the existing database fields by the marked records. 28 .uno%3ADataSourceBrowser%2FInsertContent 4b Updates the contents of the existing database fields by the marked records. 5 38783 28 Allows you to set the filtering options. 11 .uno%3AFilterCrit 28 Allows you to set the filtering options. 5 10715 28 Allows you to set the filtering options. a 1388414979 26 Specifies a value to filter the field. a 2567081500 53 For the following arguments, you can choose between the logical operators AND / OR. a 1388416514 6f Specifies the comparative operators through which the entries in the Field name and Value fields can be linked. a 2567081497 4d Specifies the field names from the current table to set them in the argument. a 2567082016 26 Specifies a value to filter the field. a 2567081498 4d Specifies the field names from the current table to set them in the argument. a 1388416518 6f Specifies the comparative operators through which the entries in the Field name and Value fields can be linked. a 2567082018 26 Specifies a value to filter the field. a 1388416515 4d Specifies the field names from the current table to set them in the argument. a 2567081502 6f Specifies the comparative operators through which the entries in the Field name and Value fields can be linked. a 2567081499 53 For the following arguments, you can choose between the logical operators AND / OR. a 2567081496 4d Specifies the field names from the current table to set them in the argument. a 1388416516 6f Specifies the comparative operators through which the entries in the Field name and Value fields can be linked. a 1388414977 26 Specifies a value to filter the field. a 2567081503 6f Specifies the comparative operators through which the entries in the Field name and Value fields can be linked. a 1388416513 4d Specifies the field names from the current table to set them in the argument. a 1388416519 53 For the following arguments, you can choose between the logical operators AND / OR. 5 26323 3b Specifies the logical conditions to filter your table data. a 2567081501 6f Specifies the comparative operators through which the entries in the Field name and Value fields can be linked. a 2567082017 26 Specifies a value to filter the field. a 1388414978 26 Specifies a value to filter the field. 1f .uno%3ADataFilterStandardFilter 3b Specifies the logical conditions to filter your table data. a 1388416520 53 For the following arguments, you can choose between the logical operators AND / OR. a 1388416517 4d Specifies the field names from the current table to set them in the argument. 5 38784 31 Specifies the sort criteria for the data display. 10 .uno%3AOrderCrit 31 Specifies the sort criteria for the data display. 5 10714 31 Specifies the sort criteria for the data display. 5 10725 23 Searches database tables and forms. 5 38179 1c Searches through all fields. a 1368769029 36 Specifies that fields will be found that contain data. 5 38178 3c Enter the search term in the box or select it from the list. 5 38192 5d Closes the dialog. The settings of the last search will be saved until you quit %PRODUCTNAME. 5 38183 57 Specifies that all field formats are considered when searching in the current document. 5 38188 22 Searches with regular expressions. 10 .uno%3ARecSearch 23 Searches database tables and forms. 5 38191 1d Starts or cancels the search. 5 38184 53 Specifies that upper and lower case are taken into consideration during the search. a 1368769028 39 Specifies that fields will be found that contain no data. 5 38185 63 Specifies that the search process will run in reverse direction, from the last to the first record. 5 38181 28 Searches through a specified data field. a 1368769027 3c Enter the search term in the box or select it from the list. 5 38186 77 Restarts the search. A forward search restarts with the first record. A backwards search restarts with the last record. 5 38182 45 Specifies the relationship of the search term and the field contents. a 1368772097 46 Specifies the logical form in which you want the search to take place. a 1368769026 28 Searches through a specified data field. 5 38187 27 Allows a search with a * or ? wildcard. 5 10729 4d Prompts the database server to filter the visible data by specified criteria. 11 .uno%3AFormFilter 4d Prompts the database server to filter the visible data by specified criteria. 13 .uno%3AFormFiltered 3f Switches between the filtered and unfiltered view of the table. 5 10723 3f Switches between the filtered and unfiltered view of the table. 15 .uno%3AViewFormAsGrid 39 Activates an additional table view when in the form view. 5 10761 39 Activates an additional table view when in the form view. 1c .uno%3ADSBDocumentDataSource 57 Displays, in the data source browser, the table that is linked to the current document. 2d .uno%3ADataSourceBrowser%2FDocumentDataSource 57 Displays, in the data source browser, the table that is linked to the current document. 14 .uno%3ASbaExecuteSql 31 Runs the SQL query and displays the query result. 5 12307 31 Runs the SQL query and displays the query result. 5 10721 31 Runs the SQL query and displays the query result. 13 .uno%3ADBClearQuery 3f Clears the query and removes all tables from the design window. f .uno%3AAddTable 3b Specifies the tables to be inserted into the design window. a 2462286337 12 Shows only tables. a 2462290433 25 Inserts the currently selected table. 5 10722 3b Specifies the tables to be inserted into the design window. a 2462286338 13 Shows only queries. 5 38853 3b Specifies the tables to be inserted into the design window. 5 38852 1d Closes the Add Tables dialog. 19 .uno%3ADBChangeDesignMode 36 Displays the design view or the SQL view of the query. 13 .uno%3ASbaNativeSql 8c In Native SQL mode you can enter SQL commands that are not interpreted by $[officename], but are instead passed directly to the data source. 5 10720 8c In Native SQL mode you can enter SQL commands that are not interpreted by $[officename], but are instead passed directly to the data source. 16 .uno%3ADBViewFunctions 5c Displays the "Function" row in the lower part of the design view of the Query Design window. 17 .uno%3ADBViewTableNames 3f Displays the "Table" row in the lower part of the Query Design. 14 .uno%3ADBViewAliases 3f Displays the "Alias" row in the lower part of the Query Design. 17 .uno%3ADBDistinctValues 66 Expands the created select statement of the SQL Query in the current column by the parameter DISTINCT. 5 10128 35 Allows you to select objects in the current document. 13 .uno%3ASelectObject 35 Allows you to select objects in the current document. 4 5675 9b Displays the source text of the current HTML document. To view the HTML source of a new document, you must first save the new document as an HTML document. 11 .uno%3ASourceView 9b Displays the source text of the current HTML document. To view the HTML source of a new document, you must first save the new document as an HTML document. 5 52825 9b Displays the source text of the current HTML document. To view the HTML source of a new document, you must first save the new document as an HTML document. 5 27087 65 Displays the current Page Style. Double-click to edit the style, right-click to select another style. 13 .uno%3ALayoutStatus 65 Displays the current Page Style. Double-click to edit the style, right-click to select another style. 5 26115 65 Displays the current Page Style. Double-click to edit the style, right-click to select another style. 16 .uno%3AStatusPageStyle 65 Displays the current Page Style. Double-click to edit the style, right-click to select another style. 14 .uno%3APageStyleName 65 Displays the current Page Style. Double-click to edit the style, right-click to select another style. 5 21182 65 Displays the current Page Style. Double-click to edit the style, right-click to select another style. 10 .uno%3AStateZoom 2f Specifies the current page display zoom factor. 5 21183 2f Specifies the current page display zoom factor. 5 10221 5d Displays the current insert mode. You can toggle between INSRT = insert and OVER = overwrite. 11 .uno%3AInsertMode 5d Displays the current insert mode. You can toggle between INSRT = insert and OVER = overwrite. 14 .uno%3ASelectionMode 7b Displays the current selection mode. You can switch between STD = Standard, EXT = Extend, ADD = Add, BLK = Block selection. 5 21185 7b Displays the current selection mode. You can switch between STD = Standard, EXT = Extend, ADD = Add, BLK = Block selection. 5 26116 7b Displays the current selection mode. You can switch between STD = Standard, EXT = Extend, ADD = Add, BLK = Block selection. 1a .uno%3AStatusSelectionMode 7b Displays the current selection mode. You can switch between STD = Standard, EXT = Extend, ADD = Add, BLK = Block selection. 15 .uno%3AModifiedStatus 9a If changes to the document have not yet been saved, a "*" is displayed in this field on the Status Bar. This also applies to new, not yet saved documents. 5 27089 9a If changes to the document have not yet been saved, a "*" is displayed in this field on the Status Bar. This also applies to new, not yet saved documents. 5 30366 9a If changes to the document have not yet been saved, a "*" is displayed in this field on the Status Bar. This also applies to new, not yet saved documents. 4 5584 9a If changes to the document have not yet been saved, a "*" is displayed in this field on the Status Bar. This also applies to new, not yet saved documents. f .uno%3AModified 9a If changes to the document have not yet been saved, a "*" is displayed in this field on the Status Bar. This also applies to new, not yet saved documents. 4 5311 1a Displays the current time. 12 .uno%3ACurrentTime 1a Displays the current time. 4 5312 1a Displays the current date. 12 .uno%3ACurrentDate 1a Displays the current date. 5 10474 7e Displays the image as a charcoal sketch. The contours of the image are drawn in black, and the original colors are suppressed. 19 .uno%3AGraphicFilterSepia a0 All pixels are set to their gray values, and then the green and blue color channels are reduced by the amount you specify. The red color channel is not changed. 13 SID_GRAFTBX_FILTERS 75 This icon on the Picture bar opens the Graphic Filter bar, where you can use various filters on the selected picture. 1a .uno%3AGraphicFilterPopart 26 Converts an image to a pop-art format. 1a SID_GRAFFILTER_REMOVENOISE 2a Removes noise by applying a median filter. 5 10476 27 Displays a dialog for creating reliefs. 5 10475 46 Joins small groups of pixels into rectangular areas of the same color. 5 10473 2a Removes noise by applying a median filter. 1a .uno%3AGraphicFilterInvert 86 Inverts the color values of a color image, or the brightness values of a grayscale image. Apply the filter again to revert the effect. 16 SID_GRAFFILTER_SHARPEN 32 Sharpens the image by applying a high pass filter. 5 10470 86 Inverts the color values of a color image, or the brightness values of a grayscale image. Apply the filter again to revert the effect. a 1243022341 2f Enhances, or sharpens, the edges of the object. 5 10472 32 Sharpens the image by applying a high pass filter. 1a .uno%3AGraphicFilterRelief 27 Displays a dialog for creating reliefs. a 1243076610 43 Specifies the number of colors to which the image is to be reduced. a 1243044354 5b Specifies the degree of brightness, in percent, above which the pixels are to be solarized. a 1243060738 84 Defines the intensity of aging, in percent. At 0% you see the gray values of all pixels. At 100% only the red color channel remains. 1b .uno%3AGraphicFilterToolbox 75 This icon on the Picture bar opens the Graphic Filter bar, where you can use various filters on the selected picture. 1a .uno%3AGraphicFilterMosaic 46 Joins small groups of pixels into rectangular areas of the same color. a 1243027972 2b Defines the height of the individual tiles. 1f .uno%3AGraphicFilterRemoveNoise 2a Removes noise by applying a median filter. 1a .uno%3AGraphicFilterPoster 38 Opens a dialog to determine the number of poster colors. 19 .uno%3AGraphicFilterSobel 7e Displays the image as a charcoal sketch. The contours of the image are drawn in black, and the original colors are suppressed. 5 10479 a0 All pixels are set to their gray values, and then the green and blue color channels are reduced by the amount you specify. The red color channel is not changed. 5 10471 39 Softens or blurs the image by applying a low pass filter. a 1243038723 24 Specifies to also invert all pixels. 15 SID_GRAFFILTER_SMOOTH 39 Softens or blurs the image by applying a low pass filter. 15 SID_GRAFFILTER_INVERT 86 Inverts the color values of a color image, or the brightness values of a grayscale image. Apply the filter again to revert the effect. 5 10478 26 Converts an image to a pop-art format. 5 10480 c4 Opens a dialog for defining solarization. Solarization refers to an effect that looks like what can happen when there is too much light during photo development. The colors become partly inverted. 5 10477 38 Opens a dialog to determine the number of poster colors. 1c .uno%3AGraphicFilterSolarize c4 Opens a dialog for defining solarization. Solarization refers to an effect that looks like what can happen when there is too much light during photo development. The colors become partly inverted. 1b .uno%3AGraphicFilterSharpen 32 Sharpens the image by applying a high pass filter. 1a .uno%3AGraphicFilterSmooth 39 Softens or blurs the image by applying a low pass filter. a 1243027970 2a Defines the width of the individual tiles. f .uno%3AGrafMode a2 Lists view attributes for the selected graphic object. The embedded or linked graphic object in the current file will not be changed, only the view of the object. 5 10871 a2 Lists view attributes for the selected graphic object. The embedded or linked graphic object in the current file will not be changed, only the view of the object. e .uno%3AGrafRed 55 Specifies the proportion of red RGB color components for the selected graphic object. 5 10865 55 Specifies the proportion of red RGB color components for the selected graphic object. 5 10866 57 Specifies the proportion of green RGB color components for the selected graphic object. 10 .uno%3AGrafGreen 57 Specifies the proportion of green RGB color components for the selected graphic object. 5 10867 4f Specifies the proportion of blue RGB color components for the selected graphic. f .uno%3AGrafBlue 4f Specifies the proportion of blue RGB color components for the selected graphic. 5 10863 39 Specifies the brightness for the selected graphic object. 14 .uno%3AGrafLuminance 39 Specifies the brightness for the selected graphic object. 13 .uno%3AGrafContrast 3e Specifies the contrast for viewing the selected graphic image. 5 10864 3e Specifies the contrast for viewing the selected graphic image. 5 10868 72 Specifies the gamma value for the view of the selected object, which affects the brightness of the midtone values. 10 .uno%3AGrafGamma 72 Specifies the gamma value for the view of the selected object, which affects the brightness of the midtone values. 5 10869 31 Specifies the transparency in the graphic object. 17 .uno%3AGrafTransparence 31 Specifies the transparency in the graphic object. b .uno%3ACrop 3b Drag any of the eight cropping handles to crop the picture. 13 .uno%3AGrafAttrCrop 76 Allows to crop the display of an inserted picture. Only the display gets cropped, the inserted picture is not changed. 5 10883 76 Allows to crop the display of an inserted picture. Only the display gets cropped, the inserted picture is not changed. 17 .uno%3ABasicShapes.cube 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 18 .uno%3ABasicShapes.cross 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 1c .uno%3ABasicShapes.block-arc 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 20 .uno%3ABasicShapes.round-quadrat 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 1c .uno%3ABasicShapes.rectangle 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 17 .uno%3ABasicShapes.ring 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 1a .uno%3ABasicShapes.octagon 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 18 .uno%3ABasicShapes.paper 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 19 .uno%3ABasicShapes.circle 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 1a .uno%3ABasicShapes.ellipse 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 1c .uno%3ABasicShapes.trapezoid 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 21 .uno%3ABasicShapes.right-triangle 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 5 11047 57 Opens the Basic Shapes toolbar which you can use to insert graphics into your document. 1b .uno%3ABasicShapes.pentagon 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 1a .uno%3ABasicShapes.quadrat 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 20 .uno%3ABasicShapes.parallelogram 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 1a .uno%3ABasicShapes.hexagon 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 16 .uno%3ABasicShapes.can 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 25 .uno%3ABasicShapes.isosceles-triangle 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 22 .uno%3ABasicShapes.round-rectangle 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 1a .uno%3ABasicShapes.diamond 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 12 .uno%3ABasicShapes 57 Opens the Basic Shapes toolbar which you can use to insert graphics into your document. 18 .uno%3ABasicShapes.frame 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 1d .uno%3ABasicShapes.circle-pie 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 25 .uno%3AArrowShapes.left-arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 23 .uno%3AArrowShapes.up-arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 1a .uno%3AArrowShapes.chevron 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 1e .uno%3AArrowShapes.split-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 26 .uno%3AArrowShapes.striped-right-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 26 .uno%3AArrowShapes.up-right-down-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 22 .uno%3AArrowShapes.s-sharped-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 21 .uno%3AArrowShapes.up-right-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 24 .uno%3AArrowShapes.split-round-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 2b .uno%3AArrowShapes.left-right-arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 26 .uno%3AArrowShapes.notched-right-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 25 .uno%3AArrowShapes.quad-arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 5 11049 55 Opens the Block Arrows toolbar from which you can insert graphics into your document. 1d .uno%3AArrowShapes.quad-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 25 .uno%3AArrowShapes.corner-right-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 12 .uno%3AArrowShapes 55 Opens the Block Arrows toolbar from which you can insert graphics into your document. 1d .uno%3AArrowShapes.down-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 23 .uno%3AArrowShapes.left-right-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 20 .uno%3AArrowShapes.up-down-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 25 .uno%3AArrowShapes.down-arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 21 .uno%3AArrowShapes.circular-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 29 .uno%3AArrowShapes.up-right-arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 29 .uno%3AArrowShapes.up-down--arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 1e .uno%3AArrowShapes.right-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 1d .uno%3AArrowShapes.left-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 21 .uno%3AArrowShapes.pentagon-right 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 26 .uno%3AArrowShapes.right-arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 1b .uno%3AArrowShapes.up-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 5 11051 51 Opens the Callouts toolbar from which you can insert graphics into your document. 28 .uno%3ACalloutShapes.rectangular-callout 55 Click an icon from the Callouts toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 22 .uno%3ACalloutShapes.round-callout 55 Click an icon from the Callouts toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 2e .uno%3ACalloutShapes.round-rectangular-callout 55 Click an icon from the Callouts toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 22 .uno%3ACalloutShapes.cloud-callout 55 Click an icon from the Callouts toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 14 .uno%3ACalloutShapes 51 Opens the Callouts toolbar from which you can insert graphics into your document. 23 .uno%3ACalloutShapes.line-callout-3 55 Click an icon from the Callouts toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 23 .uno%3ACalloutShapes.line-callout-1 55 Click an icon from the Callouts toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 23 .uno%3ACalloutShapes.line-callout-2 55 Click an icon from the Callouts toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 14 .uno%3AColorSettings 4b With the Color toolbar you can edit some properties of the selected object. 26 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-merge 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 32 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-alternate-process 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 36 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-direct-access-storage 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 23 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-or 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 25 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-data 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 29 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-decision 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 28 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-collate 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 2e .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-multidocument 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 16 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes 52 Opens the Flowchart toolbar from which you can insert graphics into your document. 2d .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-manual-input 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 2e .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-magnetic-disk 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 28 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-process 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 31 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-internal-storage 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 32 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-sequential-access 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 31 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-summing-junction 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 33 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-predefined-process 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 2c .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-stored-data 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 28 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-display 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 25 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-card 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 5 11050 52 Opens the Flowchart toolbar from which you can insert graphics into your document. 2d .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-punched-tape 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 28 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-extract 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 2a .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-connector 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 29 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-document 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 2b .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-terminator 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 33 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-off-page-connector 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 31 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-manual-operation 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 2c .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-preparation 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 26 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-delay 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 25 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-sort 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape. 5 10977 64 The icon opens the Fontwork Gallery from which you can insert graphical text art into your document. 1d .uno%3AFontworkGalleryFloater 64 The icon opens the Fontwork Gallery from which you can insert graphical text art into your document. 17 .uno%3AFormatPaintbrush 93 First select some text or an object, then click this icon. Then click on or drag across other text or click an object to apply the same formatting. 4 5715 93 First select some text or an object, then click this icon. Then click on or drag across other text or click an object to apply the same formatting. 17 .uno%3AStarShapes.star5 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 11 .uno%3AStarShapes 5a Opens the Stars and Banners toolbar from which you can insert graphics into your document. 17 .uno%3AStarShapes.star8 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 1b .uno%3AStarShapes.doorplate 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 18 .uno%3AStarShapes.signet 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 17 .uno%3AStarShapes.star6 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 21 .uno%3AStarShapes.vertical-scroll 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 18 .uno%3AStarShapes.star24 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 23 .uno%3AStarShapes.horizontal-scroll 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 16 .uno%3AStarShapes.bang 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 1f .uno%3AStarShapes.concave-star6 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 5 11052 5a Opens the Stars and Banners toolbar from which you can insert graphics into your document. 17 .uno%3AStarShapes.star4 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 18 .uno%3AStarShapes.star12 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 1d .uno%3ASymbolShapes.lightning 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 1e .uno%3ASymbolShapes.brace-pair 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 5 11048 56 Opens the Symbol Shapes toolbar from which you can insert graphics into your document. 1e .uno%3ASymbolShapes.left-brace 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 1f .uno%3ASymbolShapes.right-brace 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 20 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.bracket-pair 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 21 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.right-bracket 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 1a .uno%3ASymbolShapes.smiley 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 18 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.moon 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 1e .uno%3ASymbolShapes.quad-bevel 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 13 .uno%3ASymbolShapes 56 Opens the Symbol Shapes toolbar from which you can insert graphics into your document. 20 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.left-bracket 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 1d .uno%3ASymbolShapes.forbidden 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 21 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.diamond-bevel 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 21 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.octagon-bevel 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 1a .uno%3ASymbolShapes.puzzle 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 19 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.cloud 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 17 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.sun 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 1a .uno%3ASymbolShapes.flower 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. 19 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.heart 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape. a 2187084816 3b Searches backwards from the current position of the cursor. 5 33355 20 Adds this page to your bookmarks 5 33363 23 Opens the Find on this page dialog. 5 33354 17 Prints the current page 5 33353 1e Moves forward to the next page 4 5400 27 Provides an overview of the Help system 5 33349 48 The Toolbar contains important functions for controlling the Help system a 2187087883 4e Enter the text that you want to search for or select a text entry in the list. 5 33350 23 Hides and shows the navigation pane 11 .uno%3AHelpOnHelp 27 Provides an overview of the Help system a 2187084815 4e Searches the entire Help page, starting at the current position of the cursor. 5 33347 5d The list box located at the very top is where you can select other %PRODUCTNAME Help modules. a 2187088401 2d Finds the next occurrence of the search term. 5 33348 62 The navigation pane of the Help window contains the tab pages Contents, Index, Find and Bookmarks. 5 33352 1f Moves back to the previous page 5 33351 31 Moves to the first page of the current Help topic a 2187084814 38 Distinguishes between uppercase text and lowercase text. a 2187084813 1a Finds complete words only. 9 546984460 24 Click to display the selected topic. 9 546983947 45 Double-click an entry or type the word you want to find in the index. 9 546999824 6a Lists the headings of the pages found in your full-text search. To display a page, double-click its entry. 9 547000849 28 Displays the entry selected in the list. 9 547000844 3b Click to start a full-text search for the term you entered. 9 547000331 3d Enter the search term here. The search is not case-sensitive. 9 546997263 4a Specifies whether to only search in document headings for the search term. 9 546997262 6c Specifies whether to carry out an exact search for the word you entered. Incomplete words will not be found. 5 33364 22 displays the selected help subject 5 33365 39 opens a dialog for entering another name for the bookmark 5 33366 1d deletes the bookmark selected a 1083901963 58 Displays the name of the bookmarked page. You can also type a new name for the bookmark. 9 547016203 7c Double-clicking a bookmark or pressing the Return key opens the assigned page in Help. A right-click opens the context menu. 5 33356 56 Displays the main help themes, arranged in a similar way to folders in a file manager. a 1237637634 19 Enter an extrusion depth. 1c .uno%3AExtrusionDepthFloater 21 Opens the Extrusion Depth window. 5 39981 32 Select a perspective or parallel extrusion method. 5 10964 30 Tilts the selected object right by five degrees. 1f .uno%3AExtrusionLightingFloater 24 Opens the Extrusion Lighting window. 18 .uno%3AExtrusionTiltLeft 2f Tilts the selected object left by five degrees. 5 34073 13 Select a direction. 17 .uno%3AExtrusion3DColor 22 Opens the Extrusion Color toolbar. 19 .uno%3AExtrusionTiltRight 30 Tilts the selected object right by five degrees. 18 .uno%3AExtrusionTiltDown 34 Tilts the selected object downwards by five degrees. 5 10960 3c Switches the 3D effects on and off for the selected objects. 5 10963 2f Tilts the selected object left by five degrees. 5 10965 21 Opens the Extrusion Depth window. 16 .uno%3AExtrusionTiltUp 32 Tilts the selected object upwards by five degrees. 5 10962 32 Tilts the selected object upwards by five degrees. 5 39984 1c Select a lighting intensity. 20 .uno%3AExtrusionDirectionFloater 25 Opens the Extrusion Direction window. 1e .uno%3AExtrusionSurfaceFloater 23 Opens the Extrusion Surface window. 5 39983 1a Select an extrusion depth. 16 .uno%3AExtrusionToggle 3c Switches the 3D effects on and off for the selected objects. 5 10961 34 Tilts the selected object downwards by five degrees. 5 10969 22 Opens the Extrusion Color toolbar. 5 10968 23 Opens the Extrusion Surface window. 5 10966 25 Opens the Extrusion Direction window. 5 10967 24 Opens the Extrusion Lighting window. 5 39986 31 Select a surface material or a wireframe display. 14 .uno%3AAutoPilotMenu 63 Guides you through creating business and personal letters, faxes, agendas, presentations, and more. 4 6381 63 Guides you through creating business and personal letters, faxes, agendas, presentations, and more. 38 service%3Acom.sun.star.wizards.letter.CallWizard%3Fstart 28 Starts the wizard for a letter template. 5 34573 46 Allows you to view the selections that you made on the previous steps. 5 34832 3a Saves the current settings and continues to the next page. 5 40822 46 Allows you to view the selections that you made on the previous steps. 16 .uno%3AAutoPilotLetter 28 Starts the wizard for a letter template. 5 40824 68 According to your selections, the wizard creates a new document template and saves it on your hard disk. 5 40823 3a Saves the current settings and continues to the next page. 5 34574 3a Saves the current settings and continues to the next page. 5 34831 46 Allows you to view the selections that you made on the previous steps. 5 40774 2b Select the design for your letter template. 5 40771 34 Specifies that you want to create a personal letter. 5 40772 2b Select the design for your letter template. 5 40775 2b Select the design for your letter template. 5 53269 45 Specifies whether you want to create a personal or a business letter. 5 40773 93 Specifies whether paper is used that already contains an imprinted logo, address, or footer line. The Wizard shows the Letterhead layout page next. 5 40770 3b Specifies that you want to create a formal personal letter. 5 40769 3d Specifies that you want to create a business letter template. 5 40782 21 Defines the height of the object. 5 40785 32 Sets the object distance from the top page margin. 5 40778 33 Sets the object distance from the left page margin. 5 53270 57 Allows you to specify the elements that are already imprinted on your letterhead paper. 5 40777 21 Defines the height of the object. 5 40780 32 Sets the object distance from the top page margin. 5 40776 66 Specifies that a logo is already printed on your letterhead paper. %PRODUCTNAME does not print a logo. 5 40788 81 Enter the height of the footer area that is already imprinted on your letterhead paper. %PRODUCTNAME does not print in that area. 5 40787 6f Specifies that a footer area is already printed on your letterhead paper. %PRODUCTNAME does not print a footer. 5 40783 33 Sets the object distance from the left page margin. 5 40779 20 Defines the width of the object. 5 40786 a3 Specifies that your own address is already imprinted in small size above the area of the recipient's address. %PRODUCTNAME does not print an address in small size. 5 40781 6e Specifies that an address is already printed on your letterhead paper. %PRODUCTNAME does not print an address. 5 40784 20 Defines the width of the object. 5 40797 59 Includes a complimentary close on the letter template. Select the text from the list box. 5 40794 56 Includes a salutation on the letter template. Select the salutation from the list box. 5 40799 29 Includes a footer on the letter template. 5 40798 59 Includes a complimentary close on the letter template. Select the text from the list box. 5 40790 27 Includes a logo on the letter template. 5 40792 4c Includes a line with references to a business letter on the letter template. 5 40791 3c Includes a small size return address on the letter template. 5 53271 38 Defines the items to be included in the letter template. 5 40793 2f Includes a subject line on the letter template. 5 40795 56 Includes a salutation on the letter template. Select the salutation from the list box. 5 40789 4b Select a country in order to use a typical letter layout from that country. 5 40796 2b Includes fold marks on the letter template. 5 40803 2b Specifies the street address of the sender. 5 40807 48 Specifies that placeholder fields are inserted into the letter template. 5 40801 33 Use the address data from the following text boxes. 5 40808 3e Address database fields are inserted into the letter template. 5 40806 29 Specifies the address data of the sender. 5 40804 29 Specifies the address data of the sender. 5 53272 2f Specifies the sender and recipient information. 5 40800 45 Use the address data from Tools - Options - %PRODUCTNAME - User data. 5 40802 21 Specifies the name of the sender. 5 40805 29 Specifies the address data of the sender. 5 40809 24 Enter the text for the footer lines. 5 40810 30 Select to suppress the footer on the first page. 5 53273 39 Specifies the information to include in the footer space. 5 40811 2e Includes page numbers in your letter template. 5 40814 31 Saves the template and keeps it open for editing. 5 53274 50 Specifies where and under which name you want to save the document and template. 5 40812 2d Specifies the title of the document template. 5 40815 68 Enter the path and file name for the template, or click the ... button to select the path and file name. 5 40816 68 Enter the path and file name for the template, or click the ... button to select the path and file name. 5 40813 5c Saves and closes the template, and then opens a new untitled document based on the template. 13 .uno%3AAutoPilotFax 1b Opens the wizard for faxes. 35 service%3Acom.sun.star.wizards.fax.CallWizard%3Fstart 1b Opens the wizard for faxes. 5 41182 c8 Click the Back button to view the settings chosen on the previous page. The current settings will not be modified or deleted if you click this button. Back will be active from the second page onwards. 5 41183 8a The wizard saves the current settings and goes to the next page. The Next button will become inactive once you have reached the last page. 5 41184 b0 According to your selections, the wizard creates a document template and saves it. A new document based on the template appears in the work area, with the filename "UntitledX". 5 41120 30 Creates a fax template for a business-style fax. 5 41122 29 Creates a fax template for a private fax. 5 53279 27 Defines the style of your fax document. 5 41121 1f Specifies the predefined style. 5 41123 1f Specifies the predefined style. 5 41138 12 Includes a footer. 5 41130 16 Includes a date field. 5 41132 46 Includes a communication type line. Select the line from the list box. 5 41137 3b Includes a greeting. Select the greeting from the list box. 5 53280 29 Specifies the fax elements to be printed. 5 41133 18 Includes a subject line. 5 41135 3f Includes a salutation. Select the salutation from the list box. 5 41134 3f Includes a salutation. Select the salutation from the list box. 5 41131 46 Includes a communication type line. Select the line from the list box. 5 41136 3b Includes a greeting. Select the greeting from the list box. 5 41129 18 Includes a company logo. 5 41141 76 Select to enter the address data in the following text boxes. The data is inserted as normal text in the fax document. 5 41143 1e Enter the sender address data. 5 41144 1e Enter the sender address data. 5 53281 3a Specifies the receiver and sender information for the fax. 5 41146 1e Enter the sender address data. 5 41147 1e Enter the sender address data. 5 41145 1e Enter the sender address data. 5 41148 84 Inserts placeholders for the address on the fax template. Later in the fax document, click the placeholder to enter the actual data. 5 41142 1e Enter the sender address data. 5 41140 84 Inserts placeholders for the address on the fax template. Later in the fax document, click the placeholder to enter the actual data. 5 41149 45 Inserts database fields for a later mail merge with the fax document. 5 53282 1a Specifies the footer data. 5 41160 28 Prints a page number in the footer area. 5 41158 34 Specifies the text to be printed in the footer area. 5 41159 44 Suppresses the footer on the first page of a multipage fax document. 5 41167 58 Click to enter or select the complete path, including the file name of the fax template. 5 41165 59 Creates and saves the fax template, then opens a new fax document based on that template. 5 41166 50 Creates and saves the fax template, then opens the template for further editing. 5 41163 23 Enter the name of the fax template. 5 53283 27 Defines the template name and location. 16 .uno%3AAutoPilotAgenda 38 Starts the wizard to help you create an agenda template. 38 service%3Acom.sun.star.wizards.agenda.CallWizard%3Fstart 38 Starts the wizard to help you create an agenda template. 5 41057 29 Select the page design from the list box. 5 53299 27 Specifies a page design for the agenda. 5 41058 4d Prints out a page on which you can write down the minutes during the meeting. 34 SW%3ATIMEFIELD%3ADLG_WIZARD_AG%3ADLG_AG2_TFLD_METTIM 22 Specifies the time of the meeting. 5 41060 22 Specifies the date of the meeting. 5 41061 23 Specifies the title of the meeting. 34 SW%3ADATEFIELD%3ADLG_WIZARD_AG%3ADLG_AG2_DFLD_METDAT 22 Specifies the date of the meeting. 2f SW%3AEDIT%3ADLG_WIZARD_AG%3ADLG_AG2_EDIT_METORT 26 Specifies the location of the meeting. 5 41062 26 Specifies the location of the meeting. 5 41059 22 Specifies the time of the meeting. 5 53300 3d Specifies the date, time, title, and location of the meeting. 5 41065 2f Specifies whether to print a Please bring line. 5 53301 3e Specifies the headings that you want to include in the agenda. 5 41063 34 Specifies whether to print the type of meeting line. 5 41064 2e Specifies whether to print a Please read line. 5 41066 28 Specifies whether to print a Notes line. 5 53302 30 Specifies the names to be printed on the agenda. 5 41072 44 Specifies whether to print a line where you can enter the observers. 5 41069 48 Specifies whether to print a line where you can enter the minute keeper. 5 41068 46 Specifies whether to print a line where you can enter the chairperson. 5 41073 4d Specifies whether to print a line where you can enter the facility personnel. 5 41070 44 Specifies whether to print a line where you can enter the moderator. 5 41071 44 Specifies whether to print a line where you can enter the attendees. 5 41067 58 Specifies whether to print a line where you can enter the person who called the meeting. 5 41084 52 Enter the agenda topics. Use the Move up and Move down buttons to sort the topics. 5 41079 34 Inserts a new empty topic row above the current row. 5 41081 1f Moves the current topic row up. 5 41085 52 Enter the agenda topics. Use the Move up and Move down buttons to sort the topics. 5 41080 1e Removes the current topic row. 5 41086 52 Enter the agenda topics. Use the Move up and Move down buttons to sort the topics. 5 41082 21 Moves the current topic row down. 5 53303 3a Specifies the topics to be printed on the agenda template. 5 41075 4c Specifies the complete path, including the file name of the agenda template. 5 41078 53 Creates and saves the agenda template, then opens the template for further editing. 5 41076 4c Specifies the complete path, including the file name of the agenda template. 5 41077 5f Creates and saves the agenda template, then opens a new agenda document based on that template. 5 53304 36 Choose the title and location for the agenda template. 5 41074 2a Specifies the name of the agenda template. 1d .uno%3AAutoPilotPresentations 7f Use the wizard to interactively create a presentation. With the wizard, you can modify the sample templates to suit your needs. 16 .uno%3ANewPresentation 7f Use the wizard to interactively create a presentation. With the wizard, you can modify the sample templates to suit your needs. a 1088492035 44 Returns to the previous step without deleting your current settings. c slot%3A10425 7f Use the wizard to interactively create a presentation. With the wizard, you can modify the sample templates to suit your needs. d SID_AUTOPILOT 7f Use the wizard to interactively create a presentation. With the wizard, you can modify the sample templates to suit your needs. a 1088492036 34 Accepts the new settings and moves to the next page. a 1088487947 23 Creates a new (empty) presentation. 5 59885 3a Lists the available template categories for presentations. 5 59887 100 Lists the presentations that you created and saved to the Templates directory that is specified under Tools - Options - %PRODUCTNAME - Paths. To edit the layout and formatting of a presentation with the wizard, select the presentation, and then click Next. a 1088488455 36 Specifies that templates appear in the preview window. a 1088492049 2a Click Open to see a file selection dialog. 5 59886 3a Lists the available template categories for presentations. a 1088488456 71 Specifies that you only want the Wizard to start when you expressly request it with File - Wizard - Presentation. a 1088487948 3d Opens a list box containing various modifiable presentations. a 1088487951 34 Displays a list of previously created presentations. 5 59771 44 Specifies the presentation type and allows you to select a template. a 1088487975 2e Uses the original page format of the template. 5 59772 5e Allows you to select a slide design for the presentation you selected on page 1 of the Wizard. a 1088491041 5e Allows you to select a slide design for the presentation you selected on page 1 of the Wizard. a 1088487973 3d Creates a presentation to be used as overhead transparencies. 5 59888 5e Allows you to select a slide design for the presentation you selected on page 1 of the Wizard. a 1088487972 2c Creates a presentation to be used as slides. a 1088487971 2c Creates a computer screen presentation only. a 1088487974 34 Creates a presentation that can be printed on paper. a 1088491051 2a Specifies an effect for your presentation. a 1088487984 49 Runs the presentation automatically, and restarts it again after a break. a 1088487983 60 The Default option runs the presentation as a full screen presentation with the specified speed. a 1088495668 2c Defines the pause between each presentation. a 1088488501 5f Specifies whether to display the $[officename] logo during the pause between each presentation. 5 59773 46 Assigns special effects to your presentation and determines its speed. a 1088495666 2f Defines the duration of each presentation page. a 1088491053 1c Determines the effect speed. a 1088490011 66 Use this field for further thoughts and ideas that you would like to cover later in your presentation. a 1088489495 30 Specifies your name or the name of your company. 5 59774 30 Specifies your name or the name of your company. a 1088489497 29 Specifies the topic of your presentation. a 1088488511 2f Creates a summary of all presentation contents. 5 59775 2f Creates a summary of all presentation contents. 5 34400 28 Activates the Wizard for creating forms. 5 34404 39 Click to create the form without answering further pages. 5 40853 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 34433 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 41215 3a Click to move the selected field up one entry in the list. 5 41216 3c Click to move the selected field down one entry in the list. 5 34214 3c Click to move the selected field down one entry in the list. 37 DBP_PUSHBUTTON_RID_PAGE_GW_FIELDSELECTION_PB_FIELDRIGHT 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 40915 47 Lists the names of the data base fields in the selected table or query. 5 40858 3c Click to move the selected field down one entry in the list. 5 40854 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 40855 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 40851 47 Lists the names of the data base fields in the selected table or query. 5 34417 2d Displays the fields that are in the new form. 1b HID_DLGFORM_FIELDSAVAILABLE 47 Lists the names of the data base fields in the selected table or query. 3a DBP_PUSHBUTTON_RID_PAGE_GW_FIELDSELECTION_PB_ALLFIELDSLEFT 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 34436 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 41239 3c Click to move the selected field down one entry in the list. 5 34418 3a Click to move the selected field up one entry in the list. 1b HID_DLGFORM_CMDMOVESELECTED 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 39 DBP_LISTBOX_RID_PAGE_GW_FIELDSELECTION_LB_EXISTING_FIELDS 47 Lists the names of the data base fields in the selected table or query. 5 40852 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 34438 3a Click to move the selected field up one entry in the list. 5 34412 47 Lists the names of the data base fields in the selected table or query. 3b DBP_PUSHBUTTON_RID_PAGE_GW_FIELDSELECTION_PB_ALLFIELDSRIGHT 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 34439 3c Click to move the selected field down one entry in the list. 5 41210 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 41213 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 34419 3c Click to move the selected field down one entry in the list. 5 34432 47 Lists the names of the data base fields in the selected table or query. 1d HID_DLGFORM_CMDREMOVESELECTED 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 34213 3a Click to move the selected field up one entry in the list. 5 34413 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 34434 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 40920 3c Click to move the selected field down one entry in the list. 5 34415 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 40916 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 41211 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 40917 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 16 HID_DLGFORM_CMDMOVEALL 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 41212 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 14 HID_DLGFORM_LBTABLES 42 Specifies the table or query that you want to create the form for. 18 HID_DLGFORM_CMDREMOVEALL 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 34411 42 Specifies the table or query that you want to create the form for. 5 34416 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 34414 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 41238 3a Click to move the selected field up one entry in the list. 5 40857 3a Click to move the selected field up one entry in the list. 36 DBP_PUSHBUTTON_RID_PAGE_GW_FIELDSELECTION_PB_FIELDLEFT 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 34435 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 40919 3a Click to move the selected field up one entry in the list. 1a HID_DLGFORM_FIELDSSELECTED 2d Displays the fields that are in the new form. 5 41209 47 Lists the names of the data base fields in the selected table or query. 5 34424 32 Select the relation on which the subform is based. 5 34423 3d Click to add a subform based on a manual selection of fields. 5 34422 35 Click to add a subform based on an existing relation. 5 34421 18 Select to add a subform. 5 34431 44 Specifies the table or query for which the subform is to be created. 5 34437 3d Displays all fields that will be included in the new subform. 5 34444 77 Select the main form field that is joined to the subform field, which you select in the list box next to this list box. 5 34448 77 Select the main form field that is joined to the subform field, which you select in the list box next to this list box. 5 34446 77 Select the main form field that is joined to the subform field, which you select in the list box next to this list box. 5 34445 77 Select the subform field that is joined to the main form field, which you select in the list box next to this list box. 5 34442 77 Select the main form field that is joined to the subform field, which you select in the list box next to this list box. 5 34443 77 Select the subform field that is joined to the main form field, which you select in the list box next to this list box. 5 34447 77 Select the subform field that is joined to the main form field, which you select in the list box next to this list box. 5 34441 77 Select the subform field that is joined to the main form field, which you select in the list box next to this list box. 5 34453 51 Aligns the database fields column-wise with the labels to the left of the fields. 5 34455 2d Aligns the database fields in a tabular form. 5 34454 47 Aligns the database fields column-wise with the labels above the field. 5 34456 31 Arranges the labels above the corresponding data. 5 34451 1c The labels are left-aligned. 5 34452 1d The labels are right-aligned. 5 34464 21 Select to disallow deleting data. 5 34463 20 Select to disallow editing data. 5 34465 23 Select to disallow adding new data. 5 34461 37 Creates a form that is only used for entering new data. 5 34462 4f Creates a form that can be used to display existing data and to enter new data. 5 34474 2b Specifies that the field borders look flat. 5 34472 29 Specifies that the fields have no border. 5 34473 30 Specifies that the field borders have a 3D look. 5 34471 26 Specifies the page style for the form. 5 34483 3f Saves the form, and opens it in edit mode to change the layout. 5 34482 4a Saves the form, and opens it as a form document to enter and display data. 5 34481 1f Specifies the name of the form. 5 38995 2a Activates the wizard for creating reports. 5 34320 1d Select the report properties. 5 34330 40 Select the table or query for which the report is to be created. 5 34336 38 Displays all fields that are included in the new report. 5 34335 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 34333 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 34332 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 34334 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 34331 4a Displays the names of the data base fields in the selected table or query. 5 34381 94 Displays the names of the fields to be included in the report. At the right you can enter a label for each field that will be printed in the report. 5 34386 94 Displays the names of the fields to be included in the report. At the right you can enter a label for each field that will be printed in the report. 5 34385 94 Displays the names of the fields to be included in the report. At the right you can enter a label for each field that will be printed in the report. 5 34383 94 Displays the names of the fields to be included in the report. At the right you can enter a label for each field that will be printed in the report. 5 34382 94 Displays the names of the fields to be included in the report. At the right you can enter a label for each field that will be printed in the report. 5 34384 94 Displays the names of the fields to be included in the report. At the right you can enter a label for each field that will be printed in the report. 5 34341 4a Click to move the selected field to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 34342 4a Click to move the selected field to the box that the arrow is pointing to. 5 34340 c6 Lists the fields from your selection on the previous page of the Wizard. To group the report by a field, select the field name, then click the > button. You may select up to four levels of grouping. 5 34343 b4 Lists the fields by which the report will be grouped. To remove one level of grouping, select the field name, then click the < button. You may select up to four levels of grouping. 5 34353 2c Sorts the field contents in ascending order. 5 34352 37 Select an additional field by which to sort the report. 5 34346 33 Select the first field by which to sort the report. 5 34354 2d Sorts the field contents in descending order. 5 34356 2c Sorts the field contents in ascending order. 5 34357 2d Sorts the field contents in descending order. 5 34351 2d Sorts the field contents in descending order. 5 34355 37 Select an additional field by which to sort the report. 5 34348 2d Sorts the field contents in descending order. 5 34347 2c Sorts the field contents in ascending order. 5 34350 2c Sorts the field contents in ascending order. 5 34349 37 Select an additional field by which to sort the report. 5 34365 34 Selects a landscape page orientation for the report. 5 34366 33 Selects a portrait page orientation for the report. 5 34363 65 Defines a set of styles for the report. The styles assign fonts, indents, table background, and more. 5 34364 8a Defines a page layout for the report. The page layouts are loaded from template files, which assign a header, footer, and page background. 5 34362 43 Specifies the title that is printed at the title line of each page. 5 34370 6f Saves the report as a template. When you open a dynamic report, it will display with the current data contents. 5 34371 89 Saves the report as a static report. When you open a static report, it will always display the data from the time the report was created. 5 34375 30 When you click Finish, the report will be saved. 5 34374 44 When you click Finish, the report will be saved and opened for edit. 5 59873 35 Creates a new design in the next pages of the Wizard. a 1085853189 1e Displays all existing designs. a 1085854214 31 Deletes the selected design from the design list. a 1085850116 81 Loads an existing design from the design list to use as a starting point for the steps to follow on the next pages of the Wizard. a 1085850115 35 Creates a new design in the next pages of the Wizard. a 1085850656 2d Specifies that your notes are also displayed. a 1085850134 2e Creates standard HTML pages from export pages. 5 59874 2e Creates standard HTML pages from export pages. a 1085851696 48 Specifies the URL (absolute or relative) for the generated Perl scripts. a 1085850137 52 In a WebCast export, automatic scripts will be generated with Perl or ASP support. a 1085850136 87 Creates a default HTML presentation as a kiosk export, in which the slides are automatically advanced after a specified amount of time. a 1085851694 6f Specifies the URL (absolute or relative), where the created HTML presentation on the web server has been saved. a 1085850153 99 When you select the ASP option, the WebCast export creates ASP pages. Note that the HTML presentation can only be offered by a web server supporting ASP. a 1085850146 d4 The slide transition depends on the timing that you set for each slide in the presentation. If you set a manual page transition, the HTML presentation introduces a new page by pressing any key from your keyboard. a 1085850655 27 Creates a title page for your document. a 1085857829 32 Defines the amount of time for each slide display. a 1085850147 8b The page transition takes place automatically after the specified period of time elapses and does not depend on the presentation's contents a 1085851692 66 Specifies the URL (absolute or relative) to be entered by the viewer in order to see the presentation. a 1085850135 b2 Creates standard HTML pages with frames. The exported page will be placed in the main frame, and the frame to the left will display a table of contents in the form of hyperlinks. a 1085850154 3d Used by WebCast export to create HTML pages and Perl scripts. a 1085850662 55 Automatically restarts the HTML presentation after the last slide has been displayed. a 1085850171 3a Select a high resolution for a high quality slide display. a 1085850164 75 The files are exported as GIF files. GIF files are compressed without loss of data, and have a maximum of 256 colors. a 1085850685 60 Specifies that the sound files that are defined as an effect for slide transitions are exported. a 1085850165 82 The files are exported as JPEG files. JPEG files are compressed, with adjustable compression and can contain more than 256 colors. 5 59875 79 The files are exported as PNG files. PNG files are compressed without loss of data, and can contain more than 256 colors. a 1085850169 5f Select the low resolution to keep the file size small, even for presentations with many slides. a 1085853751 b4 Specifies the compression factor of the JPEG graphic. A 100% value offers the best quality for a large data range. The 25% factor indicates small files with inferior image quality. a 1085850163 79 The files are exported as PNG files. PNG files are compressed without loss of data, and can contain more than 256 colors. a 1085850170 3d Select the medium resolution for a medium-sized presentation. a 1085852234 36 Specifies additional text to appear on the title page. a 1085851720 49 Specifies your homepage. A hyperlink will be inserted in the publication. a 1085851718 1d Specifies the e-mail address. 5 59876 2f Specifies the name of the publication's author. a 1085851716 2f Specifies the name of the publication's author. 5 59877 30 Inserts only text hyperlinks instead of buttons. a 1085850706 30 Inserts only text hyperlinks instead of buttons. a 1085854314 55 Opens the Color dialog, where you can select the hyperlink color of the presentation. a 1085850221 43 Determines the colors from the styles used in the current document. a 1085854313 50 Opens the Color dialog, where you can select the text color of the presentation. a 1085854316 57 Opens the Color dialog, where you can select the active link color of the presentation. a 1085854312 56 Opens the Color dialog, where you can select the background color of the presentation. a 1085854315 58 Opens the Color dialog, where you can select the visited link color of the presentation. a 1085850215 43 Allows you to define your own colors for some presentation objects. a 1085850214 34 Uses the default colors of the viewer's Web Browser. 5 59878 43 Determines the colors from the styles used in the current document. 5 34812 13 Creates the object. 5 34820 13 Creates the object. 5 34816 13 Creates the object. 34 DBP_EDIT_RID_PAGE_GROUPRADIOSELECTION_ET_RADIOLABELS 6d Specifies the respective label for each option field. You will see the label of the option field in the form. 38 DBP_LISTBOX_RID_PAGE_GROUPRADIOSELECTION_LB_RADIOBUTTONS 46 Displays all option fields which have to be included in the group box. 3a DBP_PUSHBUTTON_RID_PAGE_GROUPRADIOSELECTION_PB_MOVETORIGHT 4a Confirms the current label and copies the label to the Option fields list. 39 DBP_PUSHBUTTON_RID_PAGE_GROUPRADIOSELECTION_PB_MOVETOLEFT 31 Removes the selected option fields from the list. 42 DBP_RADIOBUTTON_RID_PAGE_DEFAULTFIELDSELECTION_RB_DEFSELECTION_YES 5b Specifies that you want an option field to be selected as a default after opening the form. 41 DBP_RADIOBUTTON_RID_PAGE_DEFAULTFIELDSELECTION_RB_DEFSELECTION_NO 49 Specifies that you do not want any option field to be the default choice. 3f DBP_LISTBOX_RID_PAGE_DEFAULTFIELDSELECTION_LB_DEFSELECTIONFIELD 53 Select the option field that you want to have as the default when opening the form. 31 DBP_LISTBOX_RID_PAGE_OPTIONVALUES_LB_RADIOBUTTONS 49 Select the option field for which you want to assign the reference value. 2d DBP_EDIT_RID_PAGE_OPTIONVALUES_ET_OPTIONVALUE 4d Select a number or a text as a reference value for the selected option field. 29 DBP_EDIT_RID_PAGE_OPTIONS_FINAL_ET_NAMEIT 66 Specifies the label for the option box. You will see the label of the group box displayed in the form. 5 34571 55 Copies and converts documents into the OpenDocument XML format used by $[officename]. 27 macro%3A%2F%2F%2FImportWizard.Main.Main 55 Copies and converts documents into the OpenDocument XML format used by $[officename]. 5 34580 5a Converts documents in Microsoft PowerPoint format *.ppt into OpenDocument *.odp documents. 5 34579 55 Converts documents in Microsoft Excel format *.xls into OpenDocument *.ods documents. 5 34597 63 Converts documents in the old format of $[officename] Calc *.sdc into OpenDocument *.ods documents. 5 34578 54 Converts documents in Microsoft Word format *.doc into OpenDocument *.odt documents. 5 34577 56 Creates a log file in your work directory showing which documents have been converted. 5 34599 b6 Converts documents in the old format of $[officename] Writer master documents *.sgl into OpenDocument *.odm documents, and $[officename] Math *.smf into OpenDocument *.odf documents. 5 34598 a6 Converts documents in the old format of $[officename] Draw *.sda into OpenDocument *.odg documents, and $[officename] Impress *.sdd into OpenDocument *.odp documents. 5 34575 77 Converts binary $[officename] documents (StarOffice 5.2 and before) into the OpenDocument format used by $[officename]. 5 34596 65 Converts documents in the old format of $[officename] Writer *.sdw into OpenDocument *.odt documents. 5 34576 54 Converts documents in Microsoft Word format *.doc into OpenDocument *.odt documents. 5 34586 31 Indicates that the documents are to be converted. 5 34582 61 Indicates that the subdirectories of the selected directory are also searched for matching files. 5 34584 43 Specifies the directory to which the destination files are written. 5 34590 2a Opens a dialog to select the desired path. 5 34585 2a Opens a dialog to select the desired path. 5 34587 61 Indicates that the subdirectories of the selected directory are also searched for matching files. 5 34583 34 Specifies the directory containing the source files. 5 34581 2d Specifies that templates are to be converted. 5 34588 34 Specifies the directory containing the source files. 5 34589 43 Specifies the directory to which the destination files are written. 5 34670 4b Indicates the directory or the name of the single document to be converted. 14 .uno%3AEuroConverter 8a Converts the currency amounts found in $[officename] Calc documents and in fields and tables of $[officename] Writer documents into euros. 5 34668 6b Converts all $[officename] Calc and $[officename] Writer documents and templates in the selected directory. 5 34667 2a Converts a single $[officename] Calc file. 5 34661 1d Converts the entire document. 5 34662 36 All cells with the selected Cell Styles are converted. 5 34666 32 Displays the ranges to be converted from the list. 5 34680 57 Converts currency amounts found in fields and tables of $[officename] Writer documents. 5 34675 30 Returns to the first page of the Euro Converter. 5 34671 48 Specifies whether all subfolders of the selected directory are included. 5 34672 4b Specifies the folder and path in which the converted files are to be saved. 5 34677 3b Opens a dialog to select the desired directory or document. 31 macro%3A%2F%2F%2FEuro.AutoPilotRun.StartAutoPilot 8a Converts the currency amounts found in $[officename] Calc documents and in fields and tables of $[officename] Writer documents into euros. 5 34674 22 Activates the help for the dialog. 5 34669 32 Specifies the currency to be converted into euros. 5 34665 5b All currency cells in the range selected before the converter was called will be converted. 5 34663 3f All currency cells in the active spreadsheet will be converted. 5 34678 4f Opens a dialog in which you can select a directory to hold the converted files. 5 34676 16 Starts the conversion. 5 34673 1a Closes the Euro Converter. 5 26083 8a Converts the currency amounts found in $[officename] Calc documents and in fields and tables of $[officename] Writer documents into euros. 5 34664 3c All currency cells in the active document will be converted. 5 34679 bc Specifies that sheet protection will be disabled during conversion and thereafter re-enabled. If sheet protection is covered by a password, you will see a dialog for entering the password. 21 .uno%3AAutoPilotAddressDataSource 51 This wizard registers an existing address book as a data source in $[officename]. 9 860619265 4d Select this option if you already use an address book in Mozilla or Netscape. 9 860619273 60 Select this option if you want to register another data source as address book in $[officename]. 9 860619275 48 Select this option if you already use an address book in Evolution LDAP. 5 34834 44 Establishes the connection to the data source and closes the dialog. 9 860619271 61 Select this option if you already use an address book in Microsoft Outlook (not Outlook Express). 9 860619266 45 Select this option if you already use an address book in Thunderbird. 9 860619272 53 Select this option if you already use an address book in Microsoft Outlook Express. 9 860619274 43 Select this option if you already use an address book in Groupwise. 9 860619267 43 Select this option if you already use an address book in Evolution. 5 34833 32 Exits the wizard without implementing any changes. c slot%3A10934 51 This wizard registers an existing address book as a data source in $[officename]. 9 860619270 46 Select this option if you already have address data on an LDAP server. 9 860619268 4a Select this option if you already use an address book in KDE Address book. 9 860619269 4b Select this option if you already use an address book in OS X Address book. 9 860618752 51 This wizard registers an existing address book as a data source in $[officename]. 9 860639745 3a Calls a dialog in which you can enter additional settings. 3d extensions%3AListBox%3ARID_PAGE_TABLESELECTION%3ALB_TABLELIST 59 Specifies the table that is to serve as the address book for the $[officename] templates. 5 38809 2b Specifies the location using a file dialog. 9 860686337 1f Specifies the data source name. 9 860688899 2b Specifies the location using a file dialog. 9 860685313 db Registers the newly created database file in %PRODUCTNAME. The database will then be listed in the data source window (F4). If this check box is cleared, the database will be available only by opening the database file. 9 860672514 34 Opens the Templates: Address Book Assignment dialog. 5 42775 b2 Read and accept the license text to continue. You need to scroll to the end of the license text before you can continue. If you decline the license, the installation is canceled. 5 42778 d2 The user name is used for the document properties, templates, and when you record changes made to documents. This page is only displayed if a previous installation of %PRODUCTNAME is not found on your computer. 5 42776 5e You can use this page to import user data from a previously installed version of %PRODUCTNAME. 5 42774 68 The Start-up Wizard helps you to specify the user settings for %PRODUCTNAME. This wizard only runs once. 5 42773 68 The Start-up Wizard helps you to specify the user settings for %PRODUCTNAME. This wizard only runs once. 35 service%3Acom.sun.star.wizards.web.CallWizard%3Fstart 46 The Web Wizard helps you to maintain a web site on an Internet server. 5 34200 46 The Web Wizard helps you to maintain a web site on an Internet server. 5 34207 7f Select the settings that you want to load and then click Load. To start the wizard with the default settings, select "default". 5 34209 1e Deletes the selected settings. 5 34210 f9 Lists the documents that you want to publish to your web site. The wizard can convert %PRODUCTNAME documents to HTML, PDF, or, in some cases, Flash format before the documents are uploaded. All other files are uploaded in their original file format. 5 34211 dd Opens a dialog where you can select the files that you want to upload to your web site. The order of the list determines the order in which the hyperlinks to the documents are displayed on the index page of your web site. 5 34218 44 Select the file format that you want to export the selected file to. 5 34217 37 Enter the name of the author for the selected document. 5 34212 28 Removes the selected file from the list. 5 34216 2e Enter a description for the selected document. 5 34215 88 Enter the title for the selected document. The title appears as a hyperlink to the selected document on the index page of your web site. 5 34222 25 Select the layout for the index page. 5 34228 25 Select the layout for the index page. 5 34220 25 Select the layout for the index page. 5 34225 25 Select the layout for the index page. 5 34223 25 Select the layout for the index page. 5 34226 25 Select the layout for the index page. 5 34227 25 Select the layout for the index page. 5 34224 25 Select the layout for the index page. 5 34221 25 Select the layout for the index page. 5 34236 44 Includes the summary information of the documents on the index page. 5 34243 36 Displays the file size in kilobytes on the index page. 5 34241 30 Displays the file format icon on the index page. 5 34240 33 Displays the format of the files on the index page. 5 34235 3b Includes the file names of the documents on the index page. 5 34237 4d Includes the names of the people who created the documents on the index page. 5 34245 3d Optimizes the web site for a 800x600 pixel screen resolution. 5 34242 3c Displays the number of pages in your site on the index page. 5 34238 3f Includes the creation dates of the documents on the index page. 5 34239 49 Includes the date of the last time a file was modified on the index page. 5 34246 3e Optimizes the web site for a 1024x768 pixel screen resolution. 5 34244 3d Optimizes the web site for a 640x480 pixel screen resolution. 5 34249 54 Select the Icons that you want to use for the navigation elements on the index page. 5 34247 2b Select the color scheme for the index page. 5 34248 2d Select a Background image for the index page. 5 34291 4e Opens a file open dialog to select a background image file for the index page. 5 34290 36 Specifies a background image for the Web Wizard style. 5 34292 30 Clears the background image from the index page. 5 41002 28 Clears the icon set from the index page. 5 41000 53 Select an icon set for navigation on HTML presentation documents in the Web Wizard. 5 34255 53 Enter the creation date for the index page. The date is stored in an HTML meta tag. 5 34253 56 Enter a description for the index page. The description is stored in an HTML meta tag. 5 34259 58 Enter the copyright notice for the index page. The notice is stored in an HTML meta tag. 5 34258 57 Enter the e-mail address for the index page. The address is stored in an HTML meta tag. 5 34250 5f Enter the title for the index page. This element is displayed on the title bar of web browsers. 5 34256 53 Enter the modified date for the index page. The date is stored in an HTML meta tag. 5 34270 35 Saves the settings that you specified in this wizard. 5 34271 25 Enter the name for the settings file. 5 34267 c6 Uploads your files to an FTP server. The index page is saved to the location that you specified. All other files are saved to the "myWebsite" directory in the directory that contains the index page. 5 34265 104 Adds your index page and files to a compressed archive file and uploads the file to your web site. The index page is saved to the location that you specified. All other files are saved to the "myWebsite" directory in the directory that contains the index page. 5 34264 104 Adds your index page and files to a compressed archive file and uploads the file to your web site. The index page is saved to the location that you specified. All other files are saved to the "myWebsite" directory in the directory that contains the index page. 5 34262 d9 Uploads your index page and files to a local directory. The index page is saved to the location that you specified. All other files are saved to the "myWebsite" directory in the directory that contains the index page. 5 34261 d9 Uploads your index page and files to a local directory. The index page is saved to the location that you specified. All other files are saved to the "myWebsite" directory in the directory that contains the index page. 5 34268 c6 Uploads your files to an FTP server. The index page is saved to the location that you specified. All other files are saved to the "myWebsite" directory in the directory that contains the index page. 5 34263 22 Opens a dialog to select a folder. 5 34260 48 Opens your web page in the default web browser of your operating system. 5 34266 46 Opens a dialog where you can specify the location of the archive file. 5 34269 67 Opens the FTP Connection dialog where you can edit and test the connection settings for the FTP server. 5 41046 51 Opens a dialog where you can specify the FTP server directory to store the files. 5 41045 57 Enter the location of a directory on the FTP server where you want to store your files. 5 41043 3d Enter the password that is required to access the FTP server. 5 41042 3e Enter the user name that is required to access the FTP server. 5 41040 44 Edit and test the FTP server connection settings for the Web Wizard. 5 41044 33 Tests the FTP connection with the current settings. 5 41041 2f Enter the name or IP address of the FTP server. 5 38868 51 Specifies the criteria by which the content of the data field should be filtered. 5 38861 26 Select conditions to define the query. a 1388496899 2a Enter the name of the query or table view. 5 38854 50 Double-click fields to add them to the query. Drag-and-drop to define relations. 5 38863 4b The corresponding database table of the selected data field is listed here. 5 38865 66 If you click the cell, you can select among the sorting options: ascending, descending and not sorted. 5 38866 2b Select a function to run in the query here. 5 38864 7c Enter the name of the data field that you referred to in the Query. All settings made in the lower rows refer to this field. 5 38979 15 Edit Join Properties. 5 38862 5a If you mark the Visible property for a data field, that field will be visible in the query a 1388498946 49 Enter the name of the schema that is assigned to the query or table view. 5 38867 8d Specifies an alias. This alias will be listed in a query instead of the field name. This makes it possible to use user-defined column labels. 5 38856 2d Specifies the link type of the selected link. 5 39150 f7 Inserts the keyword NATURAL into the SQL statement that defines the relation. The relation joins all columns that have the same column name in both tables. The resulting joined table contains only one column for each pair of equally named columns. 5 38982 35 Specifies two different tables that you want to join. 5 38981 35 Specifies two different tables that you want to join. a 1388693525 17 Enter the new password. a 1388693527 1d Enter the new password again. a 1388693523 17 Enter the old password. a 1111689228 23 Specifies the name of the new user. 5 38896 2a This button opens the Field Format dialog. 5 38890 4f If this command has a check mark, the data field in this line is a primary key. 5 38886 84 Specifies the name of the data field. Note the database restrictions, such as the length of the name, special characters and spaces. 5 38895 41 Displays the format code that you can select with the ... button. 5 38884 32 This area is where you define the table structure. 5 38894 3c Specifies the value that is the default in new data records. 5 38887 19 Specifies the field type. 5 38888 22 Specifies an optional description. 5 38889 96 Inserts an empty row above the current row, if the table has not been saved. Inserts an empty row at the end of the table if the table has been saved. 5 38881 14 Displays help texts. 5 38969 50 Resets the current index to the setting that it had when the dialog was started. 5 38970 85 Displays the available indexes. Select an index from the list to edit. The details of the selected index are displayed in the dialog. 5 38967 1a Renames the current index. a 1388630529 12 Closes the dialog. 5 38966 1a Deletes the current index. 5 38965 14 Creates a new index. a 1388625920 4a The Index Design dialog allows you edit the indexes for the current table. 5 38974 1a Determines the sort order. a 1388626945 3e Specifies whether the current index allows only unique values. 5 38973 57 Displays a list of the fields in the current table. You can select more than one field. 14 .uno%3ADBIndexDesign 4a The Index Design dialog allows you edit the indexes for the current table. 5 38968 2b Saves the current index in the data source. 5 38920 57 Here you can link together tables from the current database through common data fields. 3b DBACCESS_RADIOBUTTON_DLG_REL_PROPERTIES_RB_CASC_DEL_DEFAULT 60 If you delete the corresponding primary key, a set value will be set to all external key fields. 33 DBACCESS_RADIOBUTTON_DLG_REL_PROPERTIES_RB_CASC_DEL 69 Specifies that all external key fields will be deleted if you delete the corresponding primary key field. 5 38922 4a The names of the tables selected for the link appear here as column names. 5 38924 28 Defines the key fields for the relation. 36 DBACCESS_RADIOBUTTON_DLG_REL_PROPERTIES_RB_NO_CASC_DEL 63 Specifies that the deletion of a primary key will not have any effect on other external key fields. 36 DBACCESS_RADIOBUTTON_DLG_REL_PROPERTIES_RB_NO_CASC_UPD 5a Specifies that any change made to a primary key does not affect other external key fields. 32 DBACCESS_LISTBOX_DLG_REL_PROPERTIES_LB_RIGHT_TABLE 30 This is where the two related tables are listed. 33 DBACCESS_RADIOBUTTON_DLG_REL_PROPERTIES_RB_CASC_UPD 77 Updates all the external key fields if the value of the corresponding primary key has been modified (Cascading Update). 5 38923 4a The names of the tables selected for the link appear here as column names. 14 .uno%3ADBAddRelation 3c Allows you to define and edit a relation between two tables. 3b DBACCESS_RADIOBUTTON_DLG_REL_PROPERTIES_RB_CASC_UPD_DEFAULT 76 If the corresponding primary key has been modified, use this option to set a default value to all external key fields. 38 DBACCESS_RADIOBUTTON_DLG_REL_PROPERTIES_RB_CASC_UPD_NULL a1 If the corresponding primary key has been modified, use this option to set the "IS NULL" value to all external key fields. IS NULL means that the field is empty. 31 DBACCESS_LISTBOX_DLG_REL_PROPERTIES_LB_LEFT_TABLE 30 This is where the two related tables are listed. 38 DBACCESS_RADIOBUTTON_DLG_REL_PROPERTIES_RB_CASC_DEL_NULL 6d If you delete the corresponding primary key, the "IS NULL" value will be assigned to all external key fields. 9 851640834 40 Copies only the table definition and not the corresponding data. 9 851640833 29 Creates a 1:1 copy of the database table. 5 38919 1e Specifies a name for the copy. 9 851641349 4a Automatically generates a primary key data field and fills it with values. 9 851640836 40 Appends the data of the table to be copied to an existing table. 9 851640835 b4 If the database supports Views, you can select this option only when a query is copied in a table container. This option enables you to see and edit a query as a normal table view. 9 851642371 46 Specifies a name for the primary key generated. This name is optional. 9 851602945 5a Adds or removes the selected field (> or < button) or all of the fields (<< or >> button). 9 851602946 5a Adds or removes the selected field (> or < button) or all of the fields (<< or >> button). 9 851594242 3e Lists the fields that you want to include in the copied table. 9 851602948 5a Adds or removes the selected field (> or < button) or all of the fields (<< or >> button). 9 851594241 bc Lists the available data fields that you can include in the copied table. To copy a data field, click its name, and then click the > button. To copy all of the fields, click the >> button. 9 851602947 5a Adds or removes the selected field (> or < button) or all of the fields (<< or >> button). 9 851612165 23 Enables automatic type recognition. 5 38905 7a Enter the number of decimal places for the data field. This option is only available for numerical or decimal data fields. 5 38902 54 Displays the name of the selected data field. If you want, you can enter a new name. 9 851613697 40 Enter the number of lines to use for automatic type recognition. 5 38901 14 Select a field type. 5 38900 32 Enter the number of characters for the data field. 5 38897 2c Select the default value for a Yes/No field. 9 851610626 43 Lists the data fields that will be included in to the copied table. 5 38904 32 Enter the number of characters for the data field. 9 851628561 2a Clears all of the check boxes in the list. 5 38917 a0 Lists the possible data fields in the destination table. Only the data fields that are selected in the source table list will be included the destination table. 9 851635727 37 Moves the selected entry down one position in the list. 9 851635725 37 Moves the selected entry down one position in the list. 9 851628560 2b Selects all of the data fields in the list. 5 38916 168 Lists the data fields in the source table. To include a data field from the source table in the destination table, select the check box in front of the data field name. To map the contents of a data field in the source table to a different data field in the destination table, click the data field in the source table list, and then click the up or down arrow. 9 851635724 35 Moves the selected entry up one position in the list. 9 851635726 35 Moves the selected entry up one position in the list. 5 38998 67 Enables $[officename] support of auto-incremented data fields for the current ODBC or JDBC data source. 5 38993 89 Only allows names that use characters that conform to the SQL92 naming constraints in the data source. All other characters are rejected. 5 38997 63 Enter an SQL statement that returns the last auto-incremented value for the primary key data field. 18 HID_DSADMIN_CHARSET_ODBC 79 Select the code conversion that you want to use to view the database in $[officename]. This does not affect the database. 5 38929 b2 Uses the current data source of the Catalog. This is useful when the ODBC data source is a database server. If the ODBC data source is a dBASE driver, leave this check box clear. 5 38816 56 Use this text field to enter additional optional driver settings if this is necessary. 5 38994 70 Enter the SQL command specifier that instructs the data source to auto-increment a specified Integer data field. 5 38812 7f Displays all the records in a file, including those marked as deleted. If you select this check box, you cannot delete records. 5 38814 61 Opens the Indexes dialog, where you can organize the table indexes in the current dBASE database. 19 HID_DSADMIN_CHARSET_DBASE 79 Select the code conversion that you want to use to view the database in $[officename]. This does not affect the database. a 1388342785 33 Moves the selected index to the Table Indexes list. a 1388335105 31 Select the database table that you want to index. a 1388334593 3a Lists the current indexes for the selected database table. a 1388342786 3a Moves the selected table indexes to the Free Indexes list. a 1388334594 3b Lists the available indexes that you can assign to a table. a 1388342788 38 Moves all of the table indexes to the Free Indexes list. a 1388342787 38 Moves all of the free indexes to the Table Indexes list. a 1388679684 40 Runs the command that you entered in the Command to execute box. a 1388678662 6a Lists the previously executed SQL commands. To run a command again, click the command, and then click Run. a 1388677640 48 Displays the results, including errors, of the SQL command that you ran. a 1388677635 3a Enter the SQL administration command that you want to run. d .uno%3ASortup 5b Sorts the list of table names in ascending order starting at the beginning of the alphabet. 5 38827 ed Some databases track changes to each record by assigning version number to fields that are changed. This number is incremented by 1 each time the field is changed. Displays the internal version number of the record in the database table. 5 10712 5b Sorts the list of table names in ascending order starting at the beginning of the alphabet. 5 38951 1a Removes the selected user. 5 38949 34 Adds a new user for accessing the selected database. 5 38950 3d Changes the current user password for accessing the database. 5 38953 32 Select the user whose settings you want to modify. 5 38952 4c Displays and lets you edit the database access rights for the selected user. 3b DBACCESS_NUMERICFIELD_TAB_PAG_ADABAS_SETTINGS_NF_CACHE_SIZE 33 Enter the size of the data buffer for the database. 3f DBACCESS_NUMERICFIELD_TAB_PAG_ADABAS_SETTINGS_NF_DATA_INCREMENT 6f Enter the size by which you want to automatically increment the database. The maximum increment size is 100 MB. 35 DBACCESS_EDIT_TAB_PAG_ADABAS_SETTINGS_ET_CTRLPASSWORD 27 Enter the password of the Control User. 35 DBACCESS_EDIT_TAB_PAG_ADABAS_SETTINGS_ET_CTRLUSERNAME 69 Enter the name of a user that you want to give limited control to modify some parameters of the database. 33 DBACCESS_CHECKBOX_TAB_PAG_ADABAS_SETTINGS_CB_SHUTDB 3d Exits the Adabas database server when you exit $[officename]. 33 DBACCESS_PUSHBUTTON_TAB_PAG_ADABAS_SETTINGS_PB_STAT 5e Opens the Database Statistics dialog, where you can view statistics about the Adabas database. a 1388611586 3a Displays the path and the name of the TRANSACTIONLOG file. a 1388613121 38 Displays the path and the name of the DATADEVSPACE file. a 1388611585 37 Displays the path and the name of the SYSDEVSPACE file. a 1388611588 36 Displays the full size (in megabytes) of the database. a 1388611589 53 Displays the amount of free space (in megabytes) that is available in the database. a 1388615683 42 Displays the amount of used space in the database as a percentage. 5 37274 4d Enter the size of the database in megabytes here. The maximum size is 100 MB. 5 37282 2c Enter the path for the transaction log file. 5 37281 48 Locate the directory where you want to save the file, and then click OK. 5 37276 a1 Enter the name of the domain user that is used by Adabas internally. Normally, the default settings for the name and password of the domain user are not changed. 5 37283 48 Locate the directory where you want to save the file, and then click OK. 5 37275 2e Enter the size of the data cache in megabytes. 5 37287 34 Enter the size of the transaction file in megabytes. 5 37280 27 Enter the path for the system DEVSPACE. 5 37273 11 Enter a password. 5 37284 25 Enter the path for the data DEVSPACE. 5 37286 48 Locate the directory where you want to save the file, and then click OK. 5 37270 2d Enter the name of the database administrator. 5 37277 11 Enter a password. 5 37271 11 Enter a password. 20 SD_EDIT_DLG_INSERT_PAGE_EDT_NAME 2d Enter the name of the database administrator. 5 37272 cb Enter the name of a user that you want to give limited control to modify some parameters of the database. Normally, the default settings for the name and the password of the control user are not changed. 5 37269 1e Type the name of the database. 5 39066 d8 When you enter a new record or update an existing record in a form, and you leave a field empty which is bound to a database column which requires input, then you will see a message complaining about the empty field. 5 39031 39 Appends the alias to the table name in SELECT statements. 5 39063 6d Select to use the CR + LF code pair to end every text line (preferred for DOS and Windows operating systems). 5 39067 30 Check to use ODBC conformant date/time literals. 5 39052 5c Use escape sequences for outer joins. The syntax for this escape sequence is {oj outer-join} 5 38827 49 Displays the internal version number of the record in the database table. 5 39062 2d Creates an index with ASC or DESC statements. 5 39033 43 Ignores access privileges that are provided by the database driver. 5 39061 37 Allows you to use the schema name in SELECT statements. 5 39060 b7 Uses the current data source of the catalog. This option is useful when the ODBC data source is a database server. Do not select this option if the ODBC data source is a dBASE driver. 5 39032 44 Replaces named parameters in a data source with a question mark (?). 5 39017 3b Select the type of Boolean comparison that you want to use. 5 38777 54 Select the character set that you want to use to view the database in $[officename]. 5 38840 38 Select the type of database that you want to connect to. 9 851543041 61 If checked, the user will be asked to enter the password that is required to access the database. 5 39015 4e Enter the path to the spreadsheet document that you want to use as a database. 5 39116 3c Tests the database connection through the JDBC driver class. 9 851546626 38 Tests the database connection with the current settings. 5 39110 49 Enter the name of the JDBC driver class that connects to the data source. 5 39014 2f Enter the path to the folder of the text files. 5 39111 3c Tests the database connection through the JDBC driver class. 5 39115 49 Enter the name of the JDBC driver class that connects to the data source. 5 39112 1f Enter the name of the database. 5 39007 3e Enter the path to the directory that contains the dBASE files. 5 39148 57 The Database Wizard creates a database file that contains information about a database. 9 851448326 a6 Opens a file selection dialog where you can select a database file. Click Open or OK in the file selection dialog to open the file immediately and to exit the wizard. 2c HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_GENERAL_RB_OPENEXISTINGDOC 62 Select to open a database file from a list of recently used files or from a file selection dialog. 29 HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_GENERAL_LB_DOCUMENTLIST 86 Select a database file to open from the list of recently used files. Click Finish to open the file immediately and to exit the wizard. 29 HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_GENERAL_PB_OPENDOCUMENT a6 Opens a file selection dialog where you can select a database file. Click Open or OK in the file selection dialog to open the file immediately and to exit the wizard. 5 38807 3e Select the database type for the existing database connection. 5 39070 49 Select to create a database document for an existing database connection. 9 851447299 86 Select a database file to open from the list of recently used files. Click Finish to open the file immediately and to exit the wizard. 9 851444227 62 Select to open a database file from a list of recently used files or from a file selection dialog. 5 39069 20 Select to create a new database. 5 39143 46 Select to call the Table Wizard after the Database Wizard is finished. 5 39144 4f Select to display the database file, where you can edit the database structure. 5 39142 4e Select to keep the database information only within the created database file. 5 39141 118 Select to register the database within your user copy of %PRODUCTNAME. After registering, the database is displayed in the View - Data Sources window. You must register a database to be able to insert the database fields in a document (Insert - Fields - Other) or in a mail merge. 5 39085 28 Specifies the path to the database file. 5 39086 26 Click to open a file selection dialog. 5 39095 26 Click to open a file selection dialog. 5 39094 24 Enter the name of the database file. 5 39133 2b A password must contain 3 to 18 characters. 5 39134 30 A user name can have a maximum of 18 characters. 5 39118 2a Click to open a database selection dialog. 5 39117 1a Enter the data source URL. 5 39073 1d Open a path selection dialog. 5 39072 28 Enter the path to the dBASE *.dbf files. 5 39108 df Enter the URL for the database. For example, for the MySQL JDBC driver, enter "jdbc:mysql:///". For more information on the JDBC driver, consult the documentation that came with the driver. 5 39114 df Enter the URL for the database. For example, for the MySQL JDBC driver, enter "jdbc:mysql:///". For more information on the JDBC driver, consult the documentation that came with the driver. 5 39113 41 hostname is the name of the machine that runs the MySQL database. 5 38815 22 Enter the name of the JDBC driver. 9 852248660 22 Enter the name of the JDBC driver. 9 852330580 22 Enter the name of the JDBC driver. 9 852251216 2f Tests the connection with the current settings. 5 38944 4c Enter the starting point to search the LDAP database, for example, "dc=com". 5 39088 4c Enter the starting point to search the LDAP database, for example, "dc=com". 5 39090 56 Creates a secure connection to the LDAP server through the Secure Sockets Layer (SSL). 5 39087 45 Enter the name of the LDAP server using the format "ldap.server.com". 5 39089 30 Enter the port of the LDAP server, normally 389. 5 38945 30 Enter the port of the LDAP server, normally 389. 5 38943 45 Enter the name of the LDAP server using the format "ldap.server.com". 5 39097 48 Connects to an existing ODBC data source that was set on a system level. 5 39098 48 Connects to an existing JDBC data source that was set on a system level. 5 39123 24 Enter the path to the database file. 5 39124 33 Click to open an ODBC data source selection dialog: 5 39104 26 Enter the URL for the database server. 9 852234832 2f Tests the connection with the current settings. 5 39102 26 Enter the name of the Oracle database. 5 39103 2e Enter the port number for the database server. 9 852231276 22 Enter the name of the JDBC driver. 5 39127 35 Enter the path and file name to the spreadsheet file. 5 39128 26 Click to open a file selection dialog. 5 39129 44 Select to request a password from the user of the database document. 5 39077 42 Click to access custom files. Enter the extension in the text box. 5 38821 87 Enter or select the character that is used as a thousands separator in the text file, for example a comma (1,000), or a period (1.000). 5 38820 81 Enter or select the character that is used as a decimal separator in the text file, for example, a period (0.5) or a comma (0,5). 5 39075 1a Click to access txt files. 5 38818 4a Enter or select the character that separates data fields in the text file. 5 39078 42 Click to access custom files. Enter the extension in the text box. 5 38819 4c Enter or select the character that identifies a text field in the text file. 5 39076 1a Click to access csv files. 5 39080 26 Click to open a file selection dialog. 5 39079 fd Enter the path to the text file or files. If you just want one text file, you can use any extension of the file name. If you enter a folder name, the text files in that folder must have the extension *.csv to be recognized as files of the text database. 5 38907 4d Opens a window where you can edit the selected table, query, form, or report. 15 .uno%3ADBDSProperties 25 Opens the Database Properties dialog. f .uno%3ADBRename 71 Renames the selected object. Depending on the database, some names, characters, and name length might be invalid. d .uno%3ADBOpen 32 Opens the selected object in the last saved state. 16 .uno%3ADBConvertToView cf Converts the selected query to a view. The original query remains in your database file and an additional view is generated on the database server. You must have write permission to add a view to a database. 5 12293 4d Opens a window where you can edit the selected table, query, form, or report. 1f .uno%3ADBDatabasePropertiesMenu 10 Opens a submenu. d .uno%3ADBEdit 4d Opens a window where you can edit the selected table, query, form, or report. 1b .uno%3ADBDSAdvancedSettings 25 Opens the Advanced Properties dialog. 5 38908 33 Deletes the selected table, query, form, or report. 19 .uno%3ADBDSConnectionType 21 Opens the Connection Type Wizard. 29 .uno%3ADBNewFormAutoPilotWithPreSelection 3e Starts the Form Wizard for the selected table, query, or view. 2b .uno%3ADBNewReportAutoPilotWithPreSelection 40 Starts the Report Wizard for the selected table, query, or view. 5 12291 33 Deletes the selected table, query, form, or report. f .uno%3ADBDelete 33 Deletes the selected table, query, form, or report. 1b .uno%3ADBSendReportToWriter 86 Exports the selected report to a text document. A dynamic report is exported as a copy of the database contents at the time of export. 19 .uno%3ADBSendReportAsMail fe Opens the default e-mail application to send a new e-mail. The selected report is appended as an attachment. You can enter the subject, the recipients and a mail body. A dynamic report is exported as a copy of the database contents at the time of export. a 1388761603 2c Click to save the form to the database file. a 1388759041 27 Enter the file name for the saved form. a 1388768770 31 Click to go up one level in the folder hierarchy. a 1388768769 36 Click to create a new folder within the database file. 14 .uno%3ADBNewQuerySql 1e Opens a new query in SQL mode. 11 .uno%3ADBNewTable 1c Opens the table design view. 10 .uno%3ADBNewForm 27 Opens a new text document in form mode. 11 .uno%3ADBNewQuery 21 Opens a new query in design mode. 5 38906 1c Opens the table design view. 13 .uno%3ADBNewViewSQL 1d Opens a new view in SQL mode. 12 .uno%3ADBNewReport 48 Starts the Report Builder window for the selected table, view, or query. 10 .uno%3ADBNewView 20 Opens a new view in design mode. 12 .uno%3ADBNewFolder 44 Opens a dialog where you can save a new folder in the database file. 12 .uno%3ADBUserAdmin 4b Opens the User Administration dialog if the database supports this feature. 5 38826 64 Opens the Table Filter dialog where you can specify which tables of the database to show or to hide. 17 .uno%3ADBRelationDesign 5d Opens the Relation Design view and checks whether the database connection supports relations. 12 .uno%3ADBDirectSQL 38 Opens the SQL dialog where you can enter SQL statements. 14 .uno%3ADBTableFilter 64 Opens the Table Filter dialog where you can specify which tables of the database to show or to hide. 1c .uno%3ADBDatabaseObjectsMenu 10 Opens a submenu. 17 .uno%3ADBShowDocPreview 36 The preview displays the document of a form or report. 12 .uno%3ADBViewForms 43 Selects the forms container and shows all forms in the detail view. 17 .uno%3ADBDisablePreview 2c Disables the preview in the database window. 14 .uno%3ADBViewQueries 47 Selects the queries container and shows all queries in the detail view. d .uno%3ADBSort 10 Opens a submenu. 1b .uno%3ADBShowDocInfoPreview 49 The preview window displays the document information of a form or report. 10 .uno%3ADBPreview 10 Opens a submenu. 16 .uno%3ADBRefreshTables 15 Refreshes the tables. 14 .uno%3ADBViewReports 47 Selects the reports container and shows all reports in the detail view. 13 .uno%3ADBViewTables 45 Selects the tables container and shows all tables in the detail view. 9 851495426 42 The list shows all changes that were applied to the database file. 17 .uno%3ADBMigrateScripts 96 The Database Document Macro Migration Wizard moves existing macros from sub-documents of an old Base file into the new Base file's macro storage area. 9 851464705 c1 Choose a location and file name to save the new database file. By default, the new file gets the same name as the old file, while the old file gets renamed with the string "backup" in the name. a 1336428573 31 Enter the password to connect to the data source. a 1336427552 99 Select to use the same user name and password without further dialog, when you connect again to the same data source in the current %PRODUCTNAME session. a 1336428570 32 Enter the user name to connect to the data source. 5 40970 36 The Query Wizard helps you to design a database query. 5 40850 39 Specifies the table for which the query is to be created. 5 40856 3b Displays all fields that will be included in the new query. 5 40876 40 Click to sort in alphabetically or numerically descending order. 5 40872 3f Click to sort in alphabetically or numerically ascending order. 5 40875 3f Click to sort in alphabetically or numerically ascending order. 5 40865 39 Specifies the field by which the created query is sorted. 5 40870 40 Click to sort in alphabetically or numerically descending order. 5 40873 40 Click to sort in alphabetically or numerically descending order. 5 40867 40 Click to sort in alphabetically or numerically descending order. 5 40868 64 Specifies additional fields by which the created query is sorted, if previous sort fields are equal. 5 40866 3f Click to sort in alphabetically or numerically ascending order. 5 40869 3f Click to sort in alphabetically or numerically ascending order. 5 40871 64 Specifies additional fields by which the created query is sorted, if previous sort fields are equal. 5 40874 64 Specifies additional fields by which the created query is sorted, if previous sort fields are equal. 5 40880 2f Select the field name for the filter condition. 5 40879 47 Select to filter the query by any of the conditions using a logical OR. 5 40883 2f Select the field name for the filter condition. 5 40881 24 Select the condition for the filter. 5 40887 24 Select the condition for the filter. 5 40888 29 Enter the value for the filter condition. 5 40878 45 Select to filter the query by all the conditions using a logical AND. 5 40884 24 Select the condition for the filter. 5 40882 29 Enter the value for the filter condition. 5 40885 29 Enter the value for the filter condition. 5 40886 2f Select the field name for the filter condition. 5 40898 1e Select the numeric field name. 5 40907 1e Appends a new row of controls. 5 40908 21 Removes the last row of controls. 5 40895 28 Select to show all records of the query. 5 40896 33 Select to show only results of aggregate functions. 5 40897 1e Select the aggregate function. 5 40918 3b Displays all fields that are to be used to group the query. 5 40930 2b Enter the value for the grouping condition. 5 40927 2b Enter the value for the grouping condition. 5 40923 44 Select to group the query by all the conditions using a logical AND. 5 40933 2b Enter the value for the grouping condition. 5 40931 31 Select the field name for the grouping condition. 5 40924 46 Select to group the query by any of the conditions using a logical OR. 5 40925 31 Select the field name for the grouping condition. 5 40929 26 Select the condition for the grouping. 5 40928 31 Select the field name for the grouping condition. 5 40926 26 Select the condition for the grouping. 5 40932 26 Select the condition for the grouping. 5 40940 23 Enter the alias for the field name. 5 40956 25 Select to save and display the query. 5 40957 31 Select to save the query and open it for editing. 5 40958 20 Displays a summary of the query. 5 40955 1c Enter the name of the query. a 1577878020 24 Select a format to display the date. a 1577878529 94 Enable Include Date to insert a date field into the active area of the report. The date field displays the current date when the report is executed. a 1577878019 24 Select a format to display the date. a 1577878023 24 Select a format to display the time. a 1577878533 94 Enable Include Time to insert a time field into the active area of the report. The time field displays the current time when the report is executed. a 1577878024 24 Select a format to display the time. a 1577878018 24 Select a format to display the date. 1a .uno%3AInsertDateTimeField 5f You can open the Date and Time dialog of the Report Builder by choosing Insert - Date and Time. a 1577878022 24 Select a format to display the time. 17 .uno%3ASectionAlignLeft 63 Select two or more objects and click this icon to align the objects at the left margin of the area. 1a .uno%3ASectionShrinkBottom 3a Shrinks the selected section to remove bottom empty space. 16 .uno%3ASectionAlignTop 62 Select two or more objects and click this icon to align the objects at the top margin of the area. 11 .uno%3AHFixedLine 2e Inserts a horizontal line to the current area. 14 .uno%3ASectionShrink 42 Shrinks the selected section to remove top and bottom empty space. 14 .uno%3AGreatestWidth 5b Select two or more objects and click this icon to resize the objects to the greatest width. 15 .uno%3ASmallestHeight 5c Select two or more objects and click this icon to resize the objects to the smallest height. 11 .uno%3AVFixedLine 2c Inserts a vertical line to the current area. 14 .uno%3ASmallestWidth 5b Select two or more objects and click this icon to resize the objects to the smallest width. 17 .uno%3ASectionShrinkTop 37 Shrinks the selected section to remove top empty space. 19 .uno%3ASectionAlignBottom 65 Select two or more objects and click this icon to align the objects at the bottom margin of the area. 15 .uno%3AGreatestHeight 5c Select two or more objects and click this icon to resize the objects to the greatest height. 18 .uno%3ASectionAlignRight 64 Select two or more objects and click this icon to align the objects at the right margin of the area. 5 64518 e8 If Deep traversing is enabled, functions are evaluated considering all lower levels of hierarchy. This would be used for instance for line numbering. If Deep traversing is not enabled, only the first level of hierarchy is evaluated. 12 .uno%3ANewFunction a9 In the context menu of the Report Navigator, you see the same commands as in the Report Builder view, plus additional commands to create new functions or to delete them. 5 64519 57 If Pre evaluation is enabled, functions are evaluated only when the report is finished. 16 .uno%3AReportNavigator 7f The Report Navigator reveals the structure of the report. You can use the Report Navigator to insert functions into the report. 5 64521 9f Click an entry in the Report Navigator. The corresponding object or area is selected in the Report Builder view. Right-click an entry to open the context menu. 5 64523 5a Enter the initial value for the evaluation of the formula. Often this is set to 0 or to 1. 5 64522 44 Enter the formula that defines the function. Use OpenFormula syntax. a 1577861638 17 Bottom of Page (Footer) a 1577861635 b Page N of M a 1577861637 14 Top of Page (Header) a 1577864712 9 Alignment a 1577861634 6 Page N 5 64479 78 Keep Together specifies to print the current object starting on top of a new page if it doesn't fit on the current page. 5 64505 5c Groups are kept together by page or by column (default). You must enable Keep Together also. 5 64501 17 Print when group change 5 64526 f5 For a picture, you can specify to either insert the picture as a link to a file or only as an embedded object in the Base file. The embedded option increases the size of the Base file, while the link option is not as portable to other computers. 13 .uno%3ASelectReport 5a To display the Data or General tab page for the whole report, choose Edit - Select Report. 5 64511 53 Sets the background color for the selected object, both on screen and for printing. 5 64512 2a Set the X Position for the selected object 5 64507 78 Specifies in which context the page footer will be printed: on all pages, or not on pages with a report header or footer 5 64513 2a Set the Y Position for the selected object 5 64478 93 New Row Or Column specifies, for a multi-column design, whether the current section and/or the next section will be printed on a new row or column. 5 64527 51 Specifies whether the background of the selected object is transparent or opaque. 5 64515 2a Defines the height of the selected object. 5 64477 66 Force New Page specifies whether the current section and/or the next section is printed on a new page. 5 64493 23 Specifies to print repeated values. 5 64514 26 Sets the width of the selected object. 5 64510 43 On the Data tab page, you can change the data contents to be shown. 5 37854 f Vert. Alignment 5 64504 68 An invisible object is not shown in the executed report. It is still visible in the Report Builder view. 5 64506 79 Specifies in which context the page header will be printed: on all pages, or not on pages with a report header or footer. 5 64473 c4 The Add Field window is shown automatically when you have selected a table in the Contents box and leave that box. You can also click the Add Field icon on the toolbar, or choose View - Add Field. 5 64494 5b If the Conditional Print Expression evaluates to TRUE, the selected object will be printed. 5 64524 2d Select the font for the selected text object. a 2114727444 28 Moves the selected field up in the list. 5 64532 2a Moves the selected field down in the list. 5 64461 37 Click to open a list from which you can select a field. a 2114727445 2a Moves the selected field down in the list. a 2114719242 4e Select the level of detail by which a group is kept together on the same page. 1b .uno%3ADbSortingAndGrouping b2 In the Sorting and Grouping dialog of Report Builder, you can define the fields that should be sorted in your report, and the fields that should be kept together to form a group. a 2114721800 3b Enter the group interval value that records are grouped by. a 2114719249 19 Select the sorting order. 5 64533 29 Removes the selected field from the list. 5 64463 9f Lists the fields that will be used for sorting or grouping. The field at the top has the highest priority, the second field has the second priority, and so on. 5 64531 28 Moves the selected field up in the list. a 2114719234 28 Select to show or hide the Group Header. a 2114719238 4b Select to create a new group on each changed value, or on other properties. a 2114719236 28 Select to show or hide the Group Footer. 5 41200 36 The Table Wizard helps you to create a database table. 5 41207 3e Select the private category to see only private sample tables. 5 41208 a2 Select one of the sample tables. Then select fields from that table from the left list box. Repeat this step until you have selected all the fields that you need. 5 41214 3b Displays all fields that will be included in the new table. 5 41206 40 Select the business category to see only business sample tables. 5 38996 70 Enter the SQL command specifier that instructs the data source to auto-increment a specified Integer data field. 5 38898 2c If set to Yes, this field must not be empty. 5 41223 2c Remove the selected field from the list box. 5 38899 53 If set to Yes, the values for this data field are generated by the database engine. 5 41220 36 Select a field in order to edit the field information. 5 41225 54 Displays the name of the selected data field. If you want, you can enter a new name. 5 41224 25 Add a new data field to the list box. 5 41229 b6 Select to automatically insert a value and increment the field's value for each new record. The database must support automatic incrementation in order to use the Auto value feature. 5 41236 aa Select a field and click < to remove it from the list of primary key fields. The primary key is created as a concatenation of the fields in this list, from top to bottom. 5 41233 4d Select to create a primary key from a combination of several existing fields. 5 41227 cd Select to create a primary key. Add a primary key to every database table to uniquely identify each record. For some database systems within %PRODUCTNAME, a primary key is mandatory for editing the tables. 5 41231 16 Select the field name. 5 41234 47 Select a field and click > to add it to the list of primary key fields. 5 41228 41 Select to automatically add a primary key as an additional field. 5 41230 44 Select to use an existing field with unique values as a primary key. 5 41232 b6 Select to automatically insert a value and increment the field's value for each new record. The database must support automatic incrementation in order to use the Auto value feature. 5 41242 29 Select to save and edit the table design. 5 41241 41 Select to save the table design and open the table to enter data. 5 41243 83 Select to create a form based on this table. The form is created on a text document with the last used settings of the Form Wizard. 5 41240 19 Specifies the table name. 5 41245 52 Select the schema for the table. (Available only if the database supports schemas) 5 41244 54 Select the catalog for the table. (Available only if the database supports catalogs) 13 .uno%3ADBReportOpen 44 Opens the selected report so you can enter, edit, or delete records. 14 .uno%3ADBQueryDelete 1b Deletes the selected query. 15 .uno%3ADBReportRename 1c Renames the selected report. 14 .uno%3ADBTableRename 1b Renames the selected table. 12 .uno%3ADBTableEdit 39 Opens the selected table so you can change the structure. 11 .uno%3ADBFormOpen 42 Opens the selected form so you can enter, edit, or delete records. 14 .uno%3ADBTableDelete 1b Deletes the selected table. 15 .uno%3ADBReportDelete 1c Deletes the selected report. 12 .uno%3ADBTableOpen 43 Opens the selected table so you can enter, edit, or delete records. 12 .uno%3ADBQueryEdit 39 Opens the selected query so you can change the structure. 12 .uno%3ADBQueryOpen 43 Opens the selected query so you can enter, edit, or delete records. 14 .uno%3ADBQueryRename 1b Renames the selected query. 13 .uno%3ADBFormDelete 1a Deletes the selected form. 11 .uno%3ADBFormEdit 35 Opens the selected form so you can change the layout. 13 .uno%3ADBReportEdit 37 Opens the selected report so you can change the layout. 13 .uno%3ADBFormRename 1a Renames the selected form. 20 .uno%3AFontworkSameLetterHeights 6b Switches the letter height of the selected Fontwork objects from normal to the same height for all objects. 5 10982 2c Opens the Fontwork Character Spacing window. 18 SID_FONTWORK_SHAPE_TYPES 64 Opens the Fontwork Shape toolbar. Click a shape to apply the shape to all selected Fontwork objects. 1a SID_FONTWORK_SHAPE_FLOATER 64 Opens the Fontwork Shape toolbar. Click a shape to apply the shape to all selected Fontwork objects. 1f .uno%3AFontworkAlignmentFloater 24 Opens the Fontwork Alignment window. 5 40016 3e Click to apply the alignment to the selected Fontwork objects. a 1237899783 2b Enter the Fontwork character spacing value. 5 10981 24 Opens the Fontwork Alignment window. 19 .uno%3AFontworkShapeTypes 64 Opens the Fontwork Shape toolbar. Click a shape to apply the shape to all selected Fontwork objects. 26 .uno%3AFontworkCharacterSpacingFloater 2c Opens the Fontwork Character Spacing window. 5 10980 6b Switches the letter height of the selected Fontwork objects from normal to the same height for all objects. 5 40018 46 Click to apply the character spacing to the selected Fontwork objects. a 1495598081 dc Enable to share the current document with other users. Disable to use the document unshared. This will invalidate the not yet saved edits that other users applied in the time since you last opened or saved this document. a 1495585283 2a Keeps your change, voids the other change. 14 .uno%3AShareDocument 66 Opens the Share Document dialog where you can enable or disable collaborative sharing of the document. a 1495585287 39 Keeps the changes of all other users, voids your changes. a 1495585284 36 Keeps the change of the other user, voids your change. a 1495585286 30 Keeps all your changes, voids all other changes. 5 59023 89 If the same contents are changed by different users, the Resolve Conflicts dialog opens. For each conflict, decide which changes to keep. 5 10730 64 If you click on the Close button on the Form Filter toolbar, the form is displayed without a filter. 15 .uno%3AFormFilterExit 64 If you click on the Close button on the Form Filter toolbar, the form is displayed without a filter. 18 .uno%3AFormFilterExecute 65 If you click the Apply Form-Based Filter icon on the Form Filter toolbar, the filter will be applied. 5 10731 65 If you click the Apply Form-Based Filter icon on the Form Filter toolbar, the filter will be applied. a 1311773188 45 If you are sure both domains are the same, click the Continue button. a 1311344669 14 Enter your password. a 1311343648 94 If you enable Remember password till end of session, your password will be remembered for subsequent WebDAV connections until you exit %PRODUCTNAME. a 1311773189 22 Opens the View Certificate dialog. a 1311344666 34 Enter your user name to log on to the WebDAV server. a 1311736321 4a Choose this setting to accept the certificate until you exit %PRODUCTNAME. a 1311740419 2a Click to open the View Certificate dialog. a 1311736326 2d Choose this setting to cancel the connection. 1e .uno%3AConfigureToolboxVisible 39 Opens a dialog where you can add, edit, and remove icons. 5 10759 de You can edit the filter conditions in this area directly as text. If you wish to check if a field has content or no content, you can select the filter conditions "empty" (SQL:"Is Null") or "not empty" (SQL: "Is not Null"). 1a .uno%3AFormFilterNavigator 69 To connect several filter conditions with Boolean OR, click the Filter navigation icon on the filter bar. 5 10758 de You can edit the filter conditions in this area directly as text. If you wish to check if a field has content or no content, you can select the filter conditions "empty" (SQL:"Is Null") or "not empty" (SQL: "Is not Null"). 5 10760 de You can edit the filter conditions in this area directly as text. If you wish to check if a field has content or no content, you can select the filter conditions "empty" (SQL:"Is Null") or "not empty" (SQL: "Is not Null"). 5 10732 69 To connect several filter conditions with Boolean OR, click the Filter navigation icon on the filter bar. 5 38072 195 The filter conditions that have been set appear in the Filter navigator. As soon as a filter is set, you see a blank filter entry at the bottom of the Filter navigator . You can select this entry by clicking the word "Or". Once you have selected the blank filter entry, you can enter additional filter conditions in the form. These conditions are linked by Boolean OR to the previously defined conditions. 5 21760 99 To export a bitmap in Writer: Right-click the bitmap, choose Save Graphics. You see the Graphics Export dialog. Enter a file name and select a file type. 5 40368 61 Click an icon to open a new document, to open a file dialog, or to browse to a featured web page. c .uno%3AAbout 4b Displays general program information such as version number and copyrights. 4 5401 4a Opens the main page of the $[officename] Help for the current application. 4 5301 4b Displays general program information such as version number and copyrights. 10 .uno%3AHelpIndex 4a Opens the main page of the $[officename] Help for the current application. 4 6683 28 Shows information on how to get support. f .uno%3AHelpMenu 4c The Help menu allows you to start and control the $[officename] Help system. 13 .uno%3AOnlineUpdate ee Enable an Internet connection for %PRODUCTNAME. If you need a Proxy, check the %PRODUCTNAME Proxy settings in Tools - Options - Internet. Then choose Check for Updates to check for the availability of a newer version of your office suite. 4 5410 4c The Help menu allows you to start and control the $[officename] Help system. 2c service%3Acom.sun.star.tab.tabreg%3Fpurchase 79 This menu command is visible for the evaluation version of %PRODUCTNAME. Choose to open the Purchase %PRODUCTNAME Wizard. 12 .uno%3AHelpSupport 28 Shows information on how to get support. 4 5402 47 Enables extended help tips under the mouse pointer till the next click. 3 560 41 The Standard bar is available in every $[officename] application. 13 .uno%3AExtendedHelp 47 Enables extended help tips under the mouse pointer till the next click. 5 35040 9a Use the Hyperlink Bar to create and edit the hyperlinks in your documents, and to enter criteria for searches using the available Internet search engines. 17 .uno%3ADSBInsertColumns 59 Inserts all fields of the marked record into the current document at the cursor position. 10 .uno%3ANewRecord 15 Creates a new record. 5 10622 59 Shows the number of the current record. Enter a number to go to the corresponding record. e .uno%3ARecSave 41 Saves a new data entry. The change is registered in the database. 5 10617 1d Takes you to the next record. 5 10618 21 Takes you to the previous record. 5 10616 1e Takes you to the first record. 15 .uno%3AAbsoluteRecord 59 Shows the number of the current record. Enter a number to go to the corresponding record. 11 .uno%3ANextRecord 1d Takes you to the next record. 5 10627 41 Saves a new data entry. The change is registered in the database. 13 .uno%3ADeleteRecord 40 Deletes a record. A query needs to be confirmed before deleting. 5 10620 15 Creates a new record. 5 10621 40 Deletes a record. A query needs to be confirmed before deleting. 11 .uno%3APrevRecord 21 Takes you to the previous record. 11 .uno%3ALastRecord 1d Takes you to the last record. 12 .uno%3AFirstRecord 1e Takes you to the first record. e .uno%3ARecUndo 20 Allows you to undo a data entry. 5 10619 1d Takes you to the last record. 5 10630 20 Allows you to undo a data entry. 5 27154 3d Specifies that you can move objects only between grid points. e .uno%3AGridUse 3d Specifies that you can move objects only between grid points. 11 .uno%3ABezierEdge 39 Converts the selected point or points into corner points. 5 27065 4f Converts a curve into a straight line or converts a straight line into a curve. 16 .uno%3ABezierSymmetric 4d This icon converts a corner point or a smooth point into a symmetrical point. 1c .uno%3ABezierEliminatePoints 3c Marks the current point or the selected points for deletion. 11 .uno%3ABezierMove 2e Activates a mode in which you can move points. 5 10119 41 Activates the insert mode. This mode allows you to insert points. 13 .uno%3ABezierInsert 41 Activates the insert mode. This mode allows you to insert points. 5 54834 53 The Edit Points Bar appears when you select a polygon object and click Edit Points. 5 27066 39 Converts the selected point or points into corner points. 5 10123 41 Converts a corner point or symmetrical point into a smooth point. 5 27067 4d This icon converts a corner point or a smooth point into a symmetrical point. 14 .uno%3ABezierCutLine 76 The Split Curve icon splits a curve. Select the point or points where you want to split the curve, then click the icon 13 .uno%3ABezierDelete a8 Use the Delete Points icon to delete one or several selected points. If you wish to select several points click the appropriate points while holding down the Shift key. 12 .uno%3ABezierClose 19 Closes a line or a curve. 13 .uno%3ABezierSmooth 41 Converts a corner point or symmetrical point into a smooth point. 5 27030 3c Marks the current point or the selected points for deletion. 5 10120 a8 Use the Delete Points icon to delete one or several selected points. If you wish to select several points click the appropriate points while holding down the Shift key. 5 10127 76 The Split Curve icon splits a curve. Select the point or points where you want to split the curve, then click the icon 5 10121 2e Activates a mode in which you can move points. 5 10122 19 Closes a line or a curve. 14 .uno%3ABezierConvert 4f Converts a curve into a straight line or converts a straight line into a curve. 18 .uno%3AOptionsTreeDialog 43 This command opens a dialog for a customized program configuration. 5 35098 18 Select an entry to edit. 5 31630 43 This command opens a dialog for a customized program configuration. 13 SID_GENERAL_OPTIONS cb Use this dialog to create general settings for working with $[officename]. The information covers topics such as user data, saving, printing, paths to important files and directories, and color defaults. 9 879233065 10 Type your state. 9 879216681 10 Type your state. 9 879216676 2b Type the name of your street in this field. 9 733497371 1c Type your ZIP in this field. 9 879216673 14 Type your last name. 9 733497375 1e Type your title in this field. 9 733497379 24 Type your work number in this field. 9 733497364 2b Type the name of your street in this field. 9 733497382 19 Type your e-mail address. 9 879216678 1c Type your ZIP in this field. 9 733497355 2c Type the name of your company in this field. 9 733497361 13 Type your initials. 9 733497376 30 Type your position in the company in this field. 9 879216672 15 Type your first name. 9 879216689 23 Type your fax number in this field. 9 879233076 19 Type your e-mail address. 9 879216674 13 Type your initials. 9 879233062 1c Type your ZIP in this field. 9 879233060 2b Type the name of your street in this field. 9 733497359 15 Type your first name. 9 733497370 10 Type your state. 9 879216692 19 Type your e-mail address. 9 733497360 14 Type your last name. 9 733497378 31 Type your private telephone number in this field. 9 879216679 1d Type the city where you live. 9 879216684 1e Type your title in this field. 9 733497369 1d Type the city where you live. 9 879233073 23 Type your fax number in this field. 9 733497368 1d Type the city where you live. 9 879233085 30 Type your position in the company in this field. 9 733497373 10 Type your state. 9 733497381 23 Type your fax number in this field. 9 879233079 2c Type the name of your company in this field. 9 733497367 1c Type your ZIP in this field. 9 879233063 1d Type the city where you live. 5 33811 2d Use this tab page to enter or edit user data. 9 733479947 47 Loads the user-specific settings saved in a document with the document. 9 733485073 49 Specifies the time interval in minutes for the automatic recovery option. 5 33809 72 In the General section, you can select default settings for saving documents, and can select default file formats. 9 733479977 3f Select this box for relative saving of URLs in the file system. 9 733479956 61 When saving the document, %PRODUCTNAME writes the XML data without indents and extra line breaks. 9 733479950 5b Specifies that the Properties dialog will appear every time you select the Save As command. a 1111557136 ba You can choose to get a warning message when you save a document in a format that is not OpenDocument or which you did not set as default format in Tools - Options - Load/Save - General. 9 733482541 51 Specifies the document type for which you want to define the default file format. 9 733479951 d5 Saves the previous version of a document as a backup copy whenever you save a document. Every time %PRODUCTNAME creates a backup copy, the previous backup copy is replaced. The backup copy gets the extension .BAK. 9 733482543 b1 Specifies how documents of the type selected on the left will always be saved as this file type. You may select another file type for the current document in the Save as dialog. 9 733479948 16c If enabled, the printer settings will be loaded with the document. This can cause a document to be printed on a distant printer, if you do not change the printer manually in the Print dialog. If disabled, your standard printer will be used to print this document. The current printer settings will be stored with the document whether or not this option is checked. 9 733482520 fc Some companies or organizations may require ODF documents in the ODF 1.0/1.1 format. You can select that format to save in the listbox. This older format cannot store all new features, so the new format ODF 1.2 (Extended) is recommended where possible. 9 733479978 3c Select this box for relative saving of URLs to the Internet. 9 733479958 ba You can choose to get a warning message when you save a document in a format that is not OpenDocument or which you did not set as default format in Tools - Options - Load/Save - General. 9 733479952 94 Specifies that %PRODUCTNAME saves the information needed to restore all open documents in case of a crash. You can specify the saving time interval. 5 33810 75 This section contains the default paths to important folders in $[officename]. These paths can be edited by the user. 9 733581837 36 Click to display the Select Path or Edit Paths dialog. 5 33888 65 To modify an entry in this list, click the entry and click Edit. You can also double click the entry. 9 733581838 48 The Default button resets the predefined paths for all selected entries. a 1240878603 5f Contains a list of the paths that have already been added. Mark the default path for new files. a 1240879630 60 Opens the Select Path dialog to select another folder or the Open dialog to select another file. 5 34172 28 Contains the installed language modules. 5 33815 71 Opens the Edit custom dictionary dialog, in which you can add to your custom dictionary or edit existing entries. a 1270400014 44 Specifies whether you wish to avoid certain words in your documents. 9 733598522 8a Opens the New Dictionary dialog, in which you can name a new user-defined dictionary or dictionary of exceptions and specify the language. a 1270418957 38 Assigns a new language to the current custom dictionary. 5 34168 50 Type the minimum number of characters that must come before or after the hyphen. a 1251186996 50 Type the minimum number of characters that must come before or after the hyphen. a 1270417446 a6 This input field is only available if you are editing an exception dictionary. The field shows the alternative suggestion for the current word in the "Word" text box. 5 34170 26 Lists the available user dictionaries. a 1270420007 a0 Adds the word in the Word text field to your current custom dictionary. The word in the Suggestion field is also added when working with exception dictionaries. 5 33814 8a Opens the New Dictionary dialog, in which you can name a new user-defined dictionary or dictionary of exceptions and specify the language. a 1270402573 4f By selecting a certain language you can limit the use of the custom dictionary. 12 .uno%3ASpellOnline 41 Automatically checks spelling as you type, and underlines errors. 9 733598331 44 If you want to change a value, select the entry and then click Edit. 5 34173 37 Defines the options for the spellcheck and hyphenation. a 1270418976 20 Specifies the book to be edited. 9 733598523 71 Opens the Edit custom dictionary dialog, in which you can add to your custom dictionary or edit existing entries. 5 12021 41 Automatically checks spelling as you type, and underlines errors. 5 33812 46 Specifies the properties of the spellcheck, thesaurus and hyphenation. a 1270401035 30 Specifies the name of the new custom dictionary. 9 733598524 59 Deletes the selected dictionary after a confirmation, provided it is not write-protected. a 1270420008 3b Removes the marked word from the current custom dictionary. 9 733598321 34 To edit a language module, select it and click Edit. a 1270417444 86 You can type a new word for inclusion in the dictionary. In the list below you will see the contents of the current custom dictionary. a 1251200831 25 Specifies the language of the module. a 1251201847 37 Click here to undo the current changes in the list box. a 1251201846 4b Decreases the priority of the module selected in the list box by one level. 5 34171 71 Specifies the language and the available spelling, hyphenation and Thesaurus sub-modules for the selected module. a 1251201845 4b Increases the priority of the module selected in the list box by one level. 9 701697538 5c To modify, select the color model: Red-Green-Blue (RGB) or Cyan-Magenta-Yellow-BlacK (CMYK). 9 701696001 69 Specifies the name of a selected color. You can also type a name in this field when defining a new color. 5 33894 4 Blue 5 33892 3 Red 9 701698563 1a Changes the current color. 7 dummyid 4 Cyan 9 701697537 51 Contains a list of available colors. To select a color, choose one from the list. 9 701705734 63 Opens the Save As dialog, which enables you to save the current color table under a specified name. 9 701705733 44 Accesses the Open dialog, which allows you to select a color palette 9 701698561 11 Adds a new color. 9 701698562 44 Accesses the Open dialog, which allows you to select a color palette 5 33893 5 Green 5 33808 5e Allows you to select a color from a color table, edit an existing color, or define new colors. 5 33895 32 Sets the Cyan color value in the CMYK color model. a 1090064898 b7 Sets the small selection cursor in the right window on the color, which corresponds to the selected color in the left window and updates the respective values in the numerical fields. a 1090066435 31 Sets the Blue color value in the RGB color model. 9 701700612 42 Sets the Black color value or key (black) in the CMYK color model. a 1090066434 32 Sets the Green color value in the RGB color model. a 1090066953 34 Sets the Yellow color value in the CMYK color model. a 1090064897 b7 Click the <-- button to replace the selected color in the color palette with the color selected at the right. The button is enabled when you select a color in one of the four corners. a 1090066952 35 Sets the Magenta color value in the CMYK color model. a 1090066437 2b Sets the Saturation in the HSB color model. 5 33897 34 Sets the Yellow color value in the CMYK color model. a 1090066954 42 Sets the Black color value or key (black) in the CMYK color model. a 1090066438 2b Sets the Brightness in the HSB color model. a 1090066951 32 Sets the Cyan color value in the CMYK color model. 5 33896 35 Sets the Magenta color value in the CMYK color model. a 1090066436 24 Sets the Hue in the HSB color model. a 1090066433 30 Sets the Red color value in the RGB color model. 30 OFFMGR_PUSHBUTTON_OFA_TP_MISC_PB_HELPAGENT_RESET 67 Click Reset Help Agent to restore the default list of situations for which the Help Agent is displayed. 9 810484749 b0 Specifies that the Help Agent will be displayed automatically in selected situations. Click the Help Agent window to see a Help page with information about the current context. 28 OFFMGR_CHECKBOX_OFA_TP_MISC_CB_DOCSTATUS 48 Specifies whether the printing of the document counts as a modification. 9 810484747 86 Displays the icon names and more bubble help information, for example, chapter names when you scroll through a document with chapters. 9 810484797 48 Specifies whether the printing of the document counts as a modification. 9 810484791 84 Specifies whether $[officename] dialogs are used to open and save documents. Otherwise the dialogs of the operating system are used. 9 810487312 27 Choose the style of $[officename] Help. 32 OFFMGR%3ANUMERICFIELD%3AOFA_TP_MISC%3ANF_YEARVALUE 4a Defines a date range, within which the system recognizes a two-digit year. 9 810484748 63 Displays a help text when you rest the cursor on an icon, a menu command, or a control on a dialog. 28 OFFMGR_CHECKBOX_OFA_TP_MISC_CB_HELPAGENT b0 Specifies that the Help Agent will be displayed automatically in selected situations. Click the Help Agent window to see a Help page with information about the current context. 9 810488334 67 Click Reset Help Agent to restore the default list of situations for which the Help Agent is displayed. 28 OFFMGR_LISTBOX_OFA_TP_MISC_LB_STYLESHEET 27 Choose the style of $[officename] Help. 9 810489898 4a Defines a date range, within which the system recognizes a two-digit year. 26 OFFMGR_CHECKBOX_OFA_TP_MISC_CB_FILEDLG 84 Specifies whether $[officename] dialogs are used to open and save documents. Otherwise the dialogs of the operating system are used. 9 701009923 3e Enter or select the name of the font that you want to replace. 38 OFFMGR%3ACOMBOBOX%3ARID_SVX_FONT_SUBSTITUTION%3ACB_FONT1 3e Enter or select the name of the font that you want to replace. 34 OFFMGR_LISTBOX_RID_SVX_FONT_SUBSTITUTION_LB_FONTNAME 3e Select the font for the display of HTML and Basic source code. 9 701009925 31 Enter or select the name of the replacement font. 9 701006869 36 Enables the font replacement settings that you define. 38 OFFMGR%3ACOMBOBOX%3ARID_SVX_FONT_SUBSTITUTION%3ACB_FONT2 31 Enter or select the name of the replacement font. 9 701009435 41 Select a font size for the display of HTML and Basic source code. 36 OFFMGR_LISTBOX_RID_SVX_FONT_SUBSTITUTION_LB_FONTHEIGHT 41 Select a font size for the display of HTML and Basic source code. 5 35085 26 Applies the selected font replacement. 34 OFFMGR_CHECKBOX_RID_SVX_FONT_SUBSTITUTION_CB_NONPROP 43 Check to display only non-proportional fonts in the Fonts list box. 3b OFFMGR%3ACHECKBOX%3ARID_SVX_FONT_SUBSTITUTION%3ACB_USETABLE 36 Enables the font replacement settings that you define. 9 701006873 43 Check to display only non-proportional fonts in the Fonts list box. 5 35086 26 Deletes the selected font replacement. 9 701009432 3e Select the font for the display of HTML and Basic source code. 5 35084 f0 Lists the original font and the font that will replace it. Select Always to replace the font, even if the original font is installed on your system. Select Screen only to replace the screen font only and never replace the font for printing. 5 35083 e6 Substitutes a font with a font of your choice. The substitution replaces a font only when it is displayed on screen, or on screen and when printing. The replacement does not change the font settings that are saved in the document. 29 OFFMGR_CHECKBOX_OFA_TP_VIEW_CB_MENU_ICONS a4 Displays icons next to the corresponding menu items. Select from "Automatic", "Hide" and "Show". "Automatic" displays icons according to system settings and themes. 9 810520120 38 Select the icon style for icons in toolbars and dialogs. 5 35057 17 Specifies view options. 9 810520120 38 Select the icon style for icons in toolbars and dialogs. 26 svx_CheckBox_OFA_TP_VIEW_CB_MENU_ICONS a4 Displays icons next to the corresponding menu items. Select from "Automatic", "Hide" and "Show". "Automatic" displays icons according to system settings and themes. 9 810517567 2f Select to smooth the screen appearance of text. 9 810520118 2c Specifies the display size of toolbar icons. 9 810517572 63 Directly accesses hardware features of the graphical display adapter to improve the screen display. 9 810520105 a4 Displays icons next to the corresponding menu items. Select from "Automatic", "Hide" and "Show". "Automatic" displays icons according to system settings and themes. 2e OFFMGR%3ACHECKBOX%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3ACB_FONT_SHOW 7b Displays the names of selectable fonts in the corresponding font, for example, fonts in the Font box on the Formatting bar. 29 OFFMGR_LISTBOX_OFA_TP_VIEW_LB_MOUSEMIDDLE 30 Defines the function of the middle mouse button. 9 810520118 2c Specifies the display size of toolbar icons. 9 810520098 30 Defines the function of the middle mouse button. 2f OFFMGR%3AMETRICFIELD%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3AMF_SCALING 62 Uses percentile scaling for font size in user interface elements, such as dialogs and icon labels. 9 810517573 af When supported, you can enable and disable anti-aliasing of graphics. With anti-aliasing enabled, the display of most graphical objects looks smoother and with less artifacts. 9 810522688 33 Enter the smallest font size to apply antialiasing. 2c OFFMGR%3ALISTBOX%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3ALB_MOUSEPOS 52 Specifies if and how the mouse pointer will be positioned in newly opened dialogs. 9 810517561 67 Specifies to use the system font to display all menus and dialogs. Else another installed font is used. 21 OFFMGR_LISTBOX_OFA_TP_VIEW_LB_BIG 2c Specifies the display size of toolbar icons. 19 .uno%3ARestoreEditingView 87 Specifies whether to restore the last used document view. Many view properties valid when the document was last saved will be restored. 31 OFFMGR%3ACHECKBOX%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3ACB_FONT_HISTORY 82 Lists the last five fonts that you used in the current document at the top of the list in the Font Name box on the Formatting bar. 9 810517564 7b Displays the names of selectable fonts in the corresponding font, for example, fonts in the Font box on the Formatting bar. 9 810523158 62 Uses percentile scaling for font size in user interface elements, such as dialogs and icon labels. 9 810517561 67 Specifies to use the system font to display all menus and dialogs. Else another installed font is used. 9 810517566 82 Lists the last five fonts that you used in the current document at the top of the list in the Font Name box on the Formatting bar. 9 810520095 52 Specifies if and how the mouse pointer will be positioned in newly opened dialogs. 12 .uno%3ARefreshView 4a Press Shift+Ctrl+R to restore or refresh the view of the current document. 5 20201 4a Press Shift+Ctrl+R to restore or refresh the view of the current document. 9 576160802 75 If this field is marked, the reduction in print quality for bitmaps also applies to the transparent areas of objects. 9 576160278 49 Specifies that gradients are only printed in a single intermediate color. 9 576160289 61 Specifies the maximum print quality in dpi. The resolution can only be reduced and not increased. 9 576160267 76 Specifies that the transparency is only printed if the transparent area covers less than a quarter of the entire page. 9 576165911 3e Specifies the maximum number of gradient stripes for printing. 9 576160268 2f With this option transparency is never printed. 9 576160259 57 Specifies whether the print settings apply to direct printing or to printing to a file. 9 576160821 69 Mark this check box if you always want to be warned if transparent objects are contained in the document. 9 576160287 75 High print quality corresponds to a resolution of 300dpi. Normal print quality corresponds to a resolution of 200dpi. 9 576163363 61 Specifies the maximum print quality in dpi. The resolution can only be reduced and not increased. 9 576160820 5e Mark this check box if you need a certain paper orientation for printing the current document. 9 576160808 38 Specifies that all colors are printed only as grayscale. 9 576160798 6e Specifies that bitmaps are printed with reduced quality. The resolution can only be reduced and not increased. 9 576160819 58 Mark this check box if a certain paper size is needed for printing the current document. 9 576160788 44 If this field is marked, gradients are printed with reduced quality. 9 576160288 75 High print quality corresponds to a resolution of 300dpi. Normal print quality corresponds to a resolution of 200dpi. 9 576160260 57 Specifies whether the print settings apply to direct printing or to printing to a file. 9 576160778 a5 If you mark this field the transparent objects will be printed like normal, non-transparent objects, depending on your selection in the following two option buttons. 9 576160277 3e Specifies the maximum number of gradient stripes for printing. 9 811303963 89 Mark this check box if you want $[officename] to enable quickstart. This option is available if the Quickstart module has been installed. 9 811309068 5c You can specify the number of steps which can be undone by selecting a number from the list. 9 811309074 30 Specifies the total cache size for all graphics. 9 811309076 64 Specifies that objects which are larger than the selected megabytes will not be placed in the cache. 37 OFFMGR_NUMERICFIELD_OFA_TP_MEMORY_NF_GRAPHICOBJECTCACHE 64 Specifies that objects which are larger than the selected megabytes will not be placed in the cache. 2d OFFMGR_NUMERICFIELD_OFA_TP_MEMORY_NF_OLECACHE 46 Choose the maximum number of OLE objects that are pooled in the cache. 33 OFFMGR_TIMEFIELD_OFA_TP_MEMORY_TF_GRAPHICOBJECTTIME 4f Specifies the time that each graphic remains in the cache in hours and minutes. 31 OFFMGR_NUMERICFIELD_OFA_TP_MEMORY_NF_GRAPHICCACHE 30 Specifies the total cache size for all graphics. 9 811311126 4f Specifies the time that each graphic remains in the cache in hours and minutes. 9 811309081 46 Choose the maximum number of OLE objects that are pooled in the cache. 2c OFFMGR_CHECKBOX_OFA_TP_MEMORY_CB_QUICKLAUNCH 89 Mark this check box if you want $[officename] to enable quickstart. This option is available if the Quickstart module has been installed. 29 OFFMGR_NUMERICFIELD_OFA_TP_MEMORY_ED_UNDO 5c You can specify the number of steps which can be undone by selecting a number from the list. 5 39875 22 Enter a name for the color scheme. 9 704795141 57 Deletes the color scheme shown in the Scheme box. You cannot delete the Default scheme. 5 39871 32 Select the colors for the user interface elements. 9 704795140 47 Saves the current settings as a color scheme that you can reload later. 9 704794115 29 Selects the color scheme you want to use. 9 704813061 35 Enter the number of seconds to display the Help tips. 9 704807944 48 Previews animated text, such as blinking and scrolling, in %PRODUCTNAME. 3b SVX_CHECKBOX_RID_SVXPAGE_ACCESSIBILITYCONFIG_CB_SYSTEM_FONT 63 Displays fonts in menus, dialogs, and other user interface elements using the system font settings. 9 704807947 e1 Allows you to use assistive tools, such as external screen readers, Braille devices or speech recognition input devices. The Java Runtime Environment must be installed on your computer before you can enable assistive support. 9 704807938 4c Applies the high contrast settings of the operating system to page previews. 9 704807949 5c Switches %PRODUCTNAME into high contrast mode when the system background color is very dark. 9 704807945 6c Displays fonts in %PRODUCTNAME using the system color settings. This option only affects the screen display. 9 704807948 27 Displays cursor in read-only documents. 9 704807940 3f Hides the Help tips after the number of seconds that you enter. 9 704807943 40 Previews animated graphics, such as GIF images, in %PRODUCTNAME. 28 SVX_LISTBOX_RID_SVXPAGE_SSO_LB_MECHANISM 3d Choose your security mechanism for access to the LDAP server. 28 SVX_CHECKBOX_RID_SVXPAGE_SSO_CB_PASSWORD 56 Using "simple" authentication method, check this box to make your password persistent. 24 SVX_EDIT_RID_SVXPAGE_SSO_ED_USERNAME 57 Using "simple" authentication method, you enter your user name on the LDAP server here. 24 SVX_EDIT_RID_SVXPAGE_SSO_ED_PASSWORD 5d Using "simple" authentication method, enter your password for access to the LDAP server here. 9 703285263 31 Type the port for the corresponding proxy server. 9 703285262 53 Type the name of the proxy server for HTTPS. Type the port in the right-hand field. 9 703286786 27 Specifies the type of proxy definition. 9 703285254 31 Type the port for the corresponding proxy server. 9 703285253 2a Type the name of the proxy server for FTP. 9 703285256 31 Type the port for the corresponding proxy server. 5 33844 27 Specifies the type of proxy definition. 9 703285259 62 Specifies the names of the servers that do not require any proxy servers, separated by semicolons. 9 703285251 2b Type the name of the proxy server for HTTP. 9 703285252 31 Type the port for the corresponding proxy server. 9 703337013 4f Click this button to apply the modifications made to an existing configuration. 5 33847 47 Use this tab page to define the settings for searching in the Internet. 9 703334446 7e This text box displays the URL and the first part of the query command for a search machine. A URL can also be typed directly. 9 703335985 2f Determines the case match for running a search. 9 703337014 69 Click this button to delete the selected search engine from the list. There will be no security response. 9 703332908 6f Sets the advanced search preferences (and, or, exact) as well as the way the results are defined and displayed. 9 703337016 2f Use this button to include a new search engine. 9 703332907 6f Sets the advanced search preferences (and, or, exact) as well as the way the results are defined and displayed. 9 703334441 30 Displays the name of the selected search engine. 9 703334448 75 If you type more than one word while running a search, these words will be separated by the character specified here. 9 703337015 39 Click this button to add a new configuration to the list. 9 703332909 6f Sets the advanced search preferences (and, or, exact) as well as the way the results are defined and displayed. 9 703335976 26 Displays the available search engines. 9 703334447 46 The suffix provides the command sequence, sent at the end of a search. 9 703255045 31 Opens a file dialog to select the e-mail program. 9 703252484 27 Enter the e-mail program path and name. 9 736117762 c4 Enables the Browser Plug-in to show %PRODUCTNAME documents in a browser window. Select, click OK, then restart your browser. Then, in the browser window, click any %PRODUCTNAME document hyperlink. a 1242498074 88 If enabled, you must hold down the Ctrl key while clicking a hyperlink to follow that link. If not enabled, a click opens the hyperlink. 9 703992341 20 Opens the Macro Security dialog. 9 703988750 bb If enabled, %PRODUCTNAME will securely store all passwords that you use to access files from web servers. You can retrieve the passwords from the list after you enter the master password. a 1311655959 20 Enter the master password again. 9 703988760 50 Select to enable recording changes. This is the same as Edit - Changes - Record. a 1242518030 51 Opens a dialog where you can view and change the password for the selected entry. 9 703992345 d7 Protects the change recording state with a password. If change recording is protected for the current document, the button is named Unprotect. Click Unprotect and type the correct password to disable the protection. a 1311655957 1a Enter the master password. 26 SVX_TABPAGE_RID_SVXPAGE_INET_SCRIPTING 60 Defines the security options for saving documents and for opening documents that contain macros. 9 703988759 42 Select to allow this document to be opened in read-only mode only. 9 703992337 70 Asks for the master password. If master password is correct, shows the Stored Web Connection Information dialog. 3c svx_CheckBox_RID_SVXPAGE_INET_SECURITY_CB_SEC_REMOVEPERSINFO d8 Select to always remove user data from the file properties. If this option is not selected, you can still remove the personal information for the current document with the Reset button on File - Properties - General. a 1311508501 26 Enter the master password to continue. a 1242498067 93 Select to see a warning dialog when you try to export a document to PDF format that displays recorded changes in Writer, or that displays comments. a 1242518028 29 Removes the selected entry from the list. a 1242498065 6b Select to see a warning dialog when you try to print a document that contains recorded changes or comments. 3a svx_CheckBox_RID_SVXPAGE_INET_SECURITY_CB_SEC_RECOMMPASSWD 8e Select to always enable the Save with password option in the file save dialogs. Deselect the option to save files by default without password. 9 703988758 42 Select to allow this document to be opened in read-only mode only. 37 svx_CheckBox_RID_SVXPAGE_INET_SECURITY_CB_SEC_PRINTDOCS 6b Select to see a warning dialog when you try to print a document that contains recorded changes or comments. a 1242498061 7d Select to see a warning dialog when you try to save or send a document that contains recorded changes, versions, or comments. a 1242498070 d8 Select to always remove user data from the file properties. If this option is not selected, you can still remove the personal information for the current document with the Reset button on File - Properties - General. 36 svx_CheckBox_RID_SVXPAGE_INET_SECURITY_CB_SEC_SIGNDOCS cb Select to see a warning dialog when you try to sign a document that contains recorded changes, versions, fields, references to other sources (for example linked sections or linked pictures), or comments. 9 703992335 27 Opens the Enter Master Password dialog. 9 703992332 30 Opens the "Security options and warning" dialog. 9 703988759 50 Select to enable recording changes. This is the same as Edit - Changes - Record. a 1242498072 8e Select to always enable the Save with password option in the file save dialogs. Deselect the option to save files by default without password. a 1242518029 22 Removes all entries from the list. 9 703992340 20 Opens the Macro Security dialog. 3c svx_CheckBox_RID_SVXPAGE_INET_SECURITY_CB_SEC_SAVEORSENDDOCS 7d Select to see a warning dialog when you try to save or send a document that contains recorded changes, versions, or comments. a 1242498063 cb Select to see a warning dialog when you try to sign a document that contains recorded changes, versions, fields, references to other sources (for example linked sections or linked pictures), or comments. 9 703992344 d7 Protects the change recording state with a password. If change recording is protected for the current document, the button is named Unprotect. Click Unprotect and type the correct password to disable the protection. 37 svx_CheckBox_RID_SVXPAGE_INET_SECURITY_CB_SEC_CREATEPDF 93 Select to see a warning dialog when you try to export a document to PDF format that displays recorded changes in Writer, or that displays comments. 3d OFFMGR%3ACHECKBOX%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ACB_IGNORE_FONTNAMES 97 Mark this check box to ignore all font settings when importing. The fonts that were defined in the HTML Page Style will be the fonts that will be used. 9 808846357 67 Mark this check box if you want tags that are not recognized by $[officename] to be imported as fields. 36 OFFMGR%3ANUMERICFIELD%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ANF_SIZE7 7b Use the spin buttons Size 1 to Size 7 to define the respective font sizes for the HTML to tags. 9 808851469 7b Use the spin buttons Size 1 to Size 7 to define the respective font sizes for the HTML to tags. 39 OFFMGR%3ACHECKBOX%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ACB_UNKNOWN_TAGS 67 Mark this check box if you want tags that are not recognized by $[officename] to be imported as fields. 9 808846358 97 Mark this check box to ignore all font settings when importing. The fonts that were defined in the HTML Page Style will be the fonts that will be used. 3c OFFMGR%3ACHECKBOX%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ACB_PRINT_EXTENSION 55 If you mark this field, the print layout of the current document is exported as well. 36 OFFMGR%3ACHECKBOX%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ACB_STARBASIC 62 Mark this check box to include the $[officename] Basic instructions when exporting to HTML format. 9 808846374 55 If you mark this field, the print layout of the current document is exported as well. 9 808846373 dd Mark this check box to automatically upload the embedded pictures to the Internet server when uploading using FTP. Use the Save As dialog to save the document and enter a complete FTP URL as the file name in the Internet. 2d OFFMGR_LISTBOX_RID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT_LB_CHARSET 33 Select the appropriate character set for the export 9 808851465 7b Use the spin buttons Size 1 to Size 7 to define the respective font sizes for the HTML to tags. 36 OFFMGR%3ANUMERICFIELD%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ANF_SIZE6 7b Use the spin buttons Size 1 to Size 7 to define the respective font sizes for the HTML to tags. 36 OFFMGR%3ANUMERICFIELD%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ANF_SIZE4 7b Use the spin buttons Size 1 to Size 7 to define the respective font sizes for the HTML to tags. 9 808848935 32 Defines the settings for exporting HTML documents. 26 OFFMGR%3ATABPAGE%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT 20 Defines settings for HTML pages. 36 OFFMGR%3ACHECKBOX%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ACB_LOCAL_GRF dd Mark this check box to automatically upload the embedded pictures to the Internet server when uploading using FTP. Use the Save As dialog to save the document and enter a complete FTP URL as the file name in the Internet. 9 808846368 6f If this field is marked, when exporting to HTML a warning is shown that %PRODUCTNAME Basic macros will be lost. 9 808851467 7b Use the spin buttons Size 1 to Size 7 to define the respective font sizes for the HTML to tags. 9 808846367 62 Mark this check box to include the $[officename] Basic instructions when exporting to HTML format. 36 OFFMGR%3ANUMERICFIELD%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ANF_SIZE5 7b Use the spin buttons Size 1 to Size 7 to define the respective font sizes for the HTML to tags. 9 808848937 33 Select the appropriate character set for the export 9 808846359 ce If not checked, numbers will be interpreted according to the setting in Tools - Options - Language Settings - Language of - Locale setting. If checked, numbers will be interpreted as 'English (USA)' locale. 36 OFFMGR%3ANUMERICFIELD%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ANF_SIZE2 7b Use the spin buttons Size 1 to Size 7 to define the respective font sizes for the HTML to tags. 36 OFFMGR%3ANUMERICFIELD%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ANF_SIZE3 7b Use the spin buttons Size 1 to Size 7 to define the respective font sizes for the HTML to tags. 9 808851461 7b Use the spin buttons Size 1 to Size 7 to define the respective font sizes for the HTML to tags. 9 808851471 7b Use the spin buttons Size 1 to Size 7 to define the respective font sizes for the HTML to tags. 3e OFFMGR%3ACHECKBOX%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ACB_STARBASIC_WARNING 6f If this field is marked, when exporting to HTML a warning is shown that %PRODUCTNAME Basic macros will be lost. 9 808851463 7b Use the spin buttons Size 1 to Size 7 to define the respective font sizes for the HTML to tags. 9 808851459 7b Use the spin buttons Size 1 to Size 7 to define the respective font sizes for the HTML to tags. 36 OFFMGR%3ANUMERICFIELD%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ANF_SIZE1 7b Use the spin buttons Size 1 to Size 7 to define the respective font sizes for the HTML to tags. 32 OFFMGR%3ALISTBOX%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ALB_EXPORT 32 Defines the settings for exporting HTML documents. 5 10433 a4 These settings determine the way text documents that are created in $[officename] are handled. It is also possible to define settings for the current text document. 14 .uno%3ASwEditOptions a4 These settings determine the way text documents that are created in $[officename] are handled. It is also possible to define settings for the current text document. 9 878396432 20 Displays the vertical scrollbar. 9 878396419 3e Displays the drawings and controls contained in your document. 9 878396433 5f Displays the horizontal ruler. Select the desired measurement unit from the corresponding list. 9 878396430 a4 Displays guides around the frames when frames are moved. You can select the Guides while moving option to show the exact position of the object using lineal values. 9 878396431 22 Displays the horizontal scrollbar. 9 878399065 5d Displays the vertical ruler. Select the desired measurement unit from the corresponding list. 9 878396453 2d Activates the smooth page scrolling function. 9 878396417 40 Specifies whether to display graphics and objects on the screen. 9 878396439 dc Displays comments. Click a comment to edit the text. Use the context menu in Navigator to locate or delete a comment. Use the comments's context menu to delete this comment or all comments or all comments of this author. 9 878396440 30 Aligns the vertical ruler with the right border. 9 878396428 59 Enables the rulers. Use the following two check boxes to select the ruler(s) to be shown. 9 878396418 2f Displays the tables contained in your document. 9 878399064 5f Displays the horizontal ruler. Select the desired measurement unit from the corresponding list. 9 878396475 66 Displays the handles (the eight points on a delimiting rectangle) as simple squares without 3D effect. 5 20227 8c To display the table boundaries, right-click any table and choose Table Boundaries, or choose Table - Table Boundaries in a Writer document. 9 878396420 4f Displays the field names in the document instead of the contents of the fields. 9 878396434 5d Displays the vertical ruler. Select the desired measurement unit from the corresponding list. 9 878399003 26 Specifies the Unit for HTML documents. 16 .uno%3ATableBoundaries 8c To display the table boundaries, right-click any table and choose Table Boundaries, or choose Table - Table Boundaries in a Writer document. 9 878396441 4b Displays larger sized handles (the eight points on a delimiting rectangle). 9 878437998 1f Specifies the size of the font. 9 878432355 52 Specifies the font used for indexes, alphabetical indexes, and tables of contents. 9 878437999 1f Specifies the size of the font. 9 878432347 3e Specifies the font to be used for the Default Paragraph Style. 5 53193 3d Specifies the settings for the basic fonts in your documents. 9 878438000 1f Specifies the size of the font. 9 878432351 43 Specifies the fonts for lists and numbering and all derived styles. 9 878432349 2b Specifies the font to be used for headings. 9 878432353 3e Specifies the font used for the captions of images and tables. 9 878437996 1f Specifies the size of the font. 9 878437997 1f Specifies the size of the font. 9 878429286 3f Specifies that the settings apply to the current document only. 9 878084690 56 Specifies that comments are printed at the end of the document, after the actual text. 9 878085214 78 Enable this option to print text placeholders. Disable this option to leave the text placeholders blank in the printout. 9 878085207 30 Specifies whether to always print text in black. 9 878084688 39 Specifies that comments in your document are not printed. 9 878085213 3a Enable this option to print text that is marked as hidden. 9 878085185 4a Specifies whether to print all right (odd numbered) pages of the document. 9 878085190 a9 For printers with multiple trays, the "Paper tray from printer settings" option specifies whether the paper tray used is specified by the system settings of the printer. 9 878087766 84 If you have installed fax software on your computer and wish to fax directly from the text document, select the desired fax machine. 9 878084691 60 Specifies that comments are printed on an extra page that follows each page containing comments. 9 878085189 4b Specifies whether the form control fields of the text document are printed. 9 878085184 4a Specifies whether to print all left (even numbered) pages of the document. 9 878085188 62 Specifies that each new print job will begin on a new page even if you are using a duplex printer. 9 878085181 41 Specifies whether the graphics of your text document are printed. 9 878085260 59 Check to print the pages of the brochure in the correct order for a right-to-left script. 9 878085182 3e Specifies whether the tables of the text document are printed. 9 878085183 54 Specifies whether graphics created with $[officename] drawing functions are printed. 9 878085212 190 If this option is enabled, automatically-inserted blank pages are being printed. This is best if you are printing double-sided. For example, in a book, a "chapter" paragraph style has been set to always start with an odd numbered page. If the previous chapter ends on an odd page, %PRODUCTNAME inserts an even numbered blank page. This option controls whether to print that even numbered page or not. 9 878085186 72 Specifies whether to reverse the printing order. The last page of the document will then be the first one printed. 9 878085187 45 Select the Brochure option to print your document in brochure format. 9 878085199 95 Specifies whether to include colors and objects that are inserted to the background of the page (Format - Page - Background) in the printed document. 5 53179 38 Specifies print settings within a text or HTML document. 9 878084689 4e Specifies that comments in your document are printed, but not the actual text. 9 878576251 40 Specifies that changes to a row or column affect the table size. 9 878576749 9a If Number format recognition is not marked, only input in the format that has been set at the cell is accepted. Any other input resets the format to Text. 9 878576741 60 Specifies that the first row of the table is formatted with the "Table heading" Paragraph Style. 9 878576743 43 Specifies that tables are not split by any type of text flow break. 9 878582384 30 Specifies the value to be used for moving a row. 9 878576746 43 Specifies that numbers are always bottom right aligned in the cell. 9 878582386 33 Specifies the value to be used for moving a column. 9 878576744 34 Specifies that table cells have a border by default. 1d .uno%3ATableNumberRecognition 4f Specifies that numbers in a text table are recognized and formatted as numbers. 9 878576250 4d Specifies that changes to a row or column have an effect on the entire table. 5 53199 33 Defines the attributes of tables in text documents. 9 878576742 59 Specifies whether the table heading is carried over onto the new page after a page break. 9 878582391 32 Specifies the default value for inserting columns. 5 20252 4f Specifies that numbers in a text table are recognized and formatted as numbers. 9 878576745 4f Specifies that numbers in a text table are recognized and formatted as numbers. 9 878576249 56 Specifies that changes to a row or column only affect the corresponding adjacent area. 9 878582389 2f Specifies the default value for inserting rows. 9 878806026 47 Displays text that is hidden by Conditional Text or Hidden Text fields. 9 878806018 1c Activates the direct cursor. 9 878805511 7f When the direct cursor is used, as many tabs as necessary are added in the new paragraph until the clicked position is reached. 9 878806028 57 Specifies that you can set the cursor in a protected area, but cannot make any changes. 9 878805509 102 Sets the paragraph alignment when the direct cursor is used. Depending on where the mouse is clicked, the paragraph is formatted left aligned, centered or right aligned. The cursor before the mouse-click shows, by means of a triangle, which alignment is set. 9 878806077 66 Displays text that uses the character format "hidden", when View - Non-printing Characters is enabled. 24 SW_CHECKBOX_TP_OPTSHDWCRSR_CB_HIDDEN 47 Displays text that is hidden by Conditional Text or Hidden Text fields. 9 878806022 37 Specifies that tab stops are displayed as small arrows. 9 878806024 c7 Specifies that non-breaking spaces are shown as gray boxes. Non-breaking spaces are not broken at the end of a line and are entered with the Command+Shift+Spacebar Ctrl+Shift+Spacebar shortcut keys. 9 878805512 9f When the Direct Cursor is used, a corresponding number of tabs and spaces are inserted in the new paragraph as necessary until the clicked position is reached. 9 878806025 179 Specifies whether user-defined delimiters are displayed. These are hidden delimiters that you enter within a word by pressing Command+Hyphen(-) Ctrl+Hyphen(-). Words with user-defined delimiters are only separated at the end of a line at the point where a user-defined delimiter has been inserted, irrespective of whether the automatic hyphenation is activated or deactivated. 9 878805510 9d When the direct cursor is used, the left paragraph indent is set at the horizontal position where you click the direct cursor. The paragraph is left aligned. 9 878806052 6e If you have inserted text using the Hidden Paragraph field, specifies whether to display the hidden paragraph. 9 878806027 82 Displays all line breaks inserted with the Shift+Enter shortcut. These breaks create a new line, but do not start a new paragraph. 9 878806021 79 Specifies whether paragraph delimiters are displayed. The paragraph delimiters also contain paragraph format information. 29 SW_CHECKBOX_TP_OPTSHDWCRSR_CB_HIDDEN_PARA 6e If you have inserted text using the Hidden Paragraph field, specifies whether to display the hidden paragraph. 9 878806023 42 Specifies whether to represent every space in the text with a dot. 5 53211 6f In $[officename] text and HTML documents, defines the display for certain characters and for the direct cursor. 9 878874114 4a Specifies how changes in the document are displayed when text is inserted. 5 53217 32 Defines the appearance of changes in the document. 9 878874116 e8 You can also choose a color to display each type of recorded change. When you choose the condition "By author" in the list, the color is automatically determined by $[officename], then modified to match to the author of each change. 9 878874126 e8 You can also choose a color to display each type of recorded change. When you choose the condition "By author" in the list, the color is automatically determined by $[officename], then modified to match to the author of each change. 9 878874130 3e Defines if and where changed lines in the document are marked. 9 878874119 ca Specifies how changes in the document are displayed when text is deleted. If you record text deletions, the text is displayed with the selected attribute (for example, strikethrough) and is not deleted. 9 878874132 43 Specifies the color for highlighting the changed lines in the text. 9 878874121 e8 You can also choose a color to display each type of recorded change. When you choose the condition "By author" in the list, the color is automatically determined by $[officename], then modified to match to the author of each change. 9 878874124 88 Defines how changes to text attributes are displayed in the document. These changes affect attributes such as bold, italic or underline. 9 958202371 37 Updates links only on request while loading a document. 9 878969873 be Specifies whether to automatically update charts. Whenever a Writer table cell value changes and the cursor leaves that cell, the chart that displays the cell value is updated automatically. 9 878969356 2e Always updates links while loading a document. 9 878972435 35 Specifies the unit of measurement for text documents. 9 878975510 37 Specifies the spacing between the individual tab stops. 9 878969358 31 Links are never updated while loading a document. 9 878969872 c8 The contents of all fields are updated automatically whenever the screen contents are displayed as new. Even with this box unchecked, some fields are updated each time a special condition takes place. 9 878969357 37 Updates links only on request while loading a document. 9 958202372 31 Links are never updated while loading a document. 9 958202370 2e Always updates links while loading a document. 5 53230 2e Specifies general settings for text documents. 5 53251 8c Specifies compatibility settings for text documents. These options help in fine-tuning %PRODUCTNAME when importing Microsoft Word documents. 3e SW%3ACHECKBOX%3ATP_OPTLOAD_PAGE%3ACB_MERGE_PARA_DIST_PAGESTART b6 Specifies whether paragraph spacing at the top of a page will also be effective at the beginning of a page or column if the paragraph is positioned on the first page of the document. 2c SW_CHECKBOX_TP_OPTLOAD_PAGE_CB_TAB_ALIGNMENT 95 Specifies how to align text at tab stops beyond the right margin, how to handle decimal tab stops, and how to handle tab stops close to a line break. 34 SW%3ACHECKBOX%3ATP_OPTLOAD_PAGE%3ACB_MERGE_PARA_DIST 79 Specifies whether to add MS Word-compatible spacing between paragraphs and tables in $[officename] Writer text documents. 9 879350288 69 Click to use the current settings on this tab page as the default for further sessions with %PRODUCTNAME. 2e SW_CHECKBOX_TP_OPTLOAD_PAGE_CB_PRINTER_METRICS 6a Specifies that printer metrics are applied for printing and also for formatting the display on the screen. 9 546685992 6a Specifies that printer metrics are applied for printing and also for formatting the display on the screen. 9 878938137 57 Defines the character to be displayed after the number of the heading or chapter level. 9 878939676 1e Specifies the character style. 9 878938130 57 Defines the character to be displayed after the number of the heading or chapter level. 9 878939671 4f Specifies the headings or chapter levels where you want the numbering to start. 9 878940174 2e Specifies the category of the selected object. 2a SW%3ACHECKBOX%3ADLG_CAPTION%3ACB_COPY_ATTR 41 Applies the border and shadow of the object to the caption frame. 9 878939664 29 Specifies the type of numbering required. 9 878937117 41 Applies the border and shadow of the object to the caption frame. 9 878939668 42 Determines the position of the caption with respect to the object. 5 53801 4a Select the object type for which the AutoCaption settings are to be valid. 14 SID_SW_ONLINEOPTIONS 46 Defines the basic settings for $[officename] documents in HTML format. 9 703202308 5a Specifies whether to move frames, drawing elements, and controls only between grid points. 9 703207438 4c Specify the number of intermediate points between grid points on the Y-axis. 9 703207948 4e Defines the unit of measure for the spacing between grid points on the X-axis. 5 27323 2e Sets the visible grid in front of all objects. 5 33816 cc Specifies the settings for the configurable grid on your document pages. This grid helps you determine the exact position of your objects. You can also set this grid in line with the "magnetic" snap grid. 10 .uno%3AGridFront 2e Sets the visible grid in front of all objects. 15 .uno%3AHelplinesFront 2c Sets the snap lines in front of all objects. 9 703207945 51 Defines the grid points spacing in the desired unit of measurement on the Y-axis. 5 27325 2c Sets the snap lines in front of all objects. 5 27322 26 Specifies whether to display the grid. 9 703202309 44 Specifies whether to change the current grid settings symmetrically. 9 703202312 26 Specifies whether to display the grid. 9 703207437 4c Specify the number of intermediate points between grid points on the X-axis. 12 .uno%3AGridVisible 26 Specifies whether to display the grid. 13 .uno%3AToolsOptions f4 Defines various settings for spreadsheets, contents to be displayed, and the cursor direction after a cell entry. You can also define sorting lists, determine the number of decimal places and the settings for recording and highlighting changes. 5 26309 f4 Defines various settings for spreadsheets, contents to be displayed, and the cursor direction after a cell entry. You can also define sorting lists, determine the number of decimal places and the settings for recording and highlighting changes. 14 .uno%3AScEditOptions f4 Defines various settings for spreadsheets, contents to be displayed, and the cursor direction after a cell entry. You can also define sorting lists, determine the number of decimal places and the settings for recording and highlighting changes. 5 10435 f4 Defines various settings for spreadsheets, contents to be displayed, and the cursor direction after a cell entry. You can also define sorting lists, determine the number of decimal places and the settings for recording and highlighting changes. 9 958186571 bf Specifies that each reference is highlighted in color in the formula. The cell range is also enclosed by a colored border as soon as the cell containing the reference is selected for editing. 9 958189115 3d Specifies a color for the grid lines in the current document. 9 958186517 43 Specifies whether to show formulas instead of results in the cells. 9 958186556 5a Specifies whether to view guides when moving drawings, frames, graphics and other objects. 9 958186531 74 If checked, all sheets are shown with the same zoom factor. If not checked, each sheet can have its own zoom factor. 9 958186549 56 Specifies whether to display a vertical scrollbar at the right of the document window. 9 958189084 34 Defines if objects and graphics are shown or hidden. 9 958186518 36 Specifies whether to show numbers with the value of 0. 9 958186529 f3 If a cell contains text that is wider than the width of the cell, the text is displayed over empty neighboring cells in the same row. If there is no empty neighboring cell, a small triangle at the cell border indicates that the text continues. 5 58892 86 Defines which elements of the %PRODUCTNAME Calc main window are displayed. You can also show or hide highlighting of values in tables. 9 958186562 46 Specifies whether to view the page breaks within a defined print area. 9 958186520 d1 Mark the Value highlighting box to highlight all values in the sheet. Text cells are highlighted in black, cells with numbers in blue, and cells containing formulas, logical values, dates, and so on, in green. 9 958186563 73 Specifies whether to display the handles (the eight points on a selection box) as simple squares without 3D effect. 9 958189086 37 Defines if charts in your document are shown or hidden. 9 958186521 67 Specifies whether the anchor icon is displayed when an inserted object, such as a graphic, is selected. 9 958186547 34 Specifies whether to display row and column headers. 9 958186519 c9 Specifies that a small rectangle in the top right corner of the cell indicates that a comment exists. The comment will be shown only when you enable tips under Tools - Options - %PRODUCTNAME - General. 5 26630 5f To display a comment permanently, select the Show comment command from the cell's context menu. 9 958186564 5e Specifies that larger than normal handles (the eight points on a selection box) are displayed. 9 958186548 59 Specifies whether to display a horizontal scrollbar at the bottom of the document window. 9 958186553 3a Specifies whether to display grid lines between the cells. 9 958186551 84 If you have defined an outline, the Outline symbols option specifies whether to view the outline symbols at the border of the sheet. 9 958186550 56 Specifies whether to display the sheet tabs at the bottom of the spreadsheet document. 12 .uno%3ANoteVisible 5f To display a comment permanently, select the Show comment command from the cell's context menu. 9 958189088 40 Defines if drawing objects in your document are shown or hidden. 9 958205512 64 Determines the direction that the cursor in the spreadsheet will move after you press the Enter key. 9 958202957 56 Specifies whether to highlight column and row headers in the selected columns or rows. 9 958208577 1f Defines the tab stops distance. 9 958202956 f9 Specifies whether to expand references when inserting columns or rows adjacent to the reference range. This is only possible if the reference range, where the column or row is inserted, originally spanned at least two cells in the desired direction. 13 .uno%3ASetInputMode 4e Allows you to immediately edit the selected cell after pressing the Enter key. 9 958202951 64 Determines the direction that the cursor in the spreadsheet will move after you press the Enter key. 9 958202954 74 Specifies whether to automatically apply the formatting attributes of the selected cell to the empty adjacent cells. 9 958202959 6d Specifies that, when you paste cells from the clipboard to a cell range that is not empty, a warning appears. 9 958205502 2c Defines the unit of measure in spreadsheets. 9 958202958 6a Specifies that printer metrics are applied for printing and also for formatting the display on the screen. 9 958202953 4e Allows you to immediately edit the selected cell after pressing the Enter key. 9 956845569 4a Displays all the available lists. These lists can be selected for editing. 9 956846596 10d Copies the contents of the cells in the Copy list from box. If you select a reference to related rows and columns, the Copy List dialog appears after clicking the button. You can use this dialog to define if the reference is converted to sort lists by row or by column. 5 58880 9c All user-defined lists are displayed in the Sort Lists dialog. You can also define and edit your own lists. Only text can be used as sort lists, no numbers. 9 956846594 23 Adds a new list into the Lists box. 9 956844546 50 Displays the content of the currently selected list. This content can be edited. 9 956846593 37 Enters the contents of a new list into the Entries box. 9 956844035 99 Defines the spreadsheet and the cells to copy, in order to include them in the Lists box. The currently selected range in the spreadsheet is the default. a 1494368769 56 Select the Columns option to summarize the contents of the selected columns in a list. a 1494368256 2f Allows you to copy marked cells to a sort list. a 1494368771 50 Select the Rows option to summarize the contents of the selected rows in a list. 9 957252106 62 Sets 1/1/1900 as day zero. Use this setting for StarCalc 1.0 spreadsheets containing date entries. 9 957252625 11b Specifies whether to make calculations using the rounded values displayed in the sheet. Charts will be shown with the displayed values. If the Precision as shown option is not marked, the displayed numbers are rounded, but they are calculated internally using the non-rounded number. 9 957252627 cc Specifies that you can use the text in any cell as a label for the column below the text or the row to the right of the text. The text must consist of at least one word and must not contain any operators. 9 957252628 68 Specifies that regular expressions are enabled when searching and also for character string comparisons. 9 957257735 af Defines the number of decimals to be displayed for numbers with the Standard number format. The numbers are displayed as rounded numbers, but are not saved as rounded numbers. 9 957252107 63 Sets 1/1/1904 as day zero. Use this setting for spreadsheets that are imported in a foreign format. 9 957257732 2b Sets the maximum number of iteration steps. 5 58879 fb Defines the calculation settings for spreadsheets. Defines the behavior of spreadsheets with iterative references, the date settings, the number of decimal places, and if capitalization or lower cases are to be considered when searching within sheets. 9 957252105 1c Sets 12/30/1899 as day zero. 9 957252609 b1 Specifies whether formulas with iterative references (formulas that are continuously repeated until the problem is solved) are calculated after a specific number of repetitions. 9 957253637 ad Specifies the difference between two consecutive iteration step results. If the result of the iteration is lower than the minimum change value, then the iteration will stop. 9 957252623 64 Specifies whether to distinguish between upper and lower case in texts when comparing cell contents. 9 957252626 117 Specifies that the search criteria you set for the Calc database functions must match the whole cell exactly. When the Search criteria = and <> must apply to whole cells box is marked, $[officename] Calc behaves exactly as MS Excel when searching cells in the database functions. 5 58933 5c The Changes dialog specifies various options for highlighting recorded changes in documents. 9 958369283 3a Specifies the color to highlight insertions in a document. 9 958369282 39 Specifies the color to highlight deletions in a document. 9 958369281 31 Specifies the color for changes of cell contents. 9 958369284 35 Specifies the color to highlight moved cell contents. 9 957481986 56 Specifies that empty pages that have no cell contents or draw objects are not printed. 9 957481988 e3 Specifies that only contents from selected sheets are printed, even if you specify a wider range in the File - Print dialog or in the Format - Print Ranges dialog. Contents from sheets that are not selected will not be printed. 14 .uno%3ASdEditOptions ad Defines various settings for newly created presentation documents, such as the contents to be displayed, the measurement unit used, if and how grid alignment is carried out. 5 10434 ad Defines various settings for newly created presentation documents, such as the contents to be displayed, the measurement unit used, if and how grid alignment is carried out. 5 59789 26 Specifies the available display modes. 14 .uno%3AHelplinesMove 3a Specifies whether to display guides when moving an object. 5 59770 26 Specifies the available display modes. 9 546653186 ec Displays the control points of all Bézier points if you have previously selected a Bézier curve. If the All control points in Bézier editor option is not marked, only the control points of the selected Bézier points will be visible. 9 546653199 59 %PRODUCTNAME displays the contour line of each individual object when moving this object. 9 546653198 54 Specifies whether to display the rulers at the top and to the left of the work area. 9 546653185 3a Specifies whether to display guides when moving an object. 5 27153 3a Specifies whether to display guides when moving an object. 9 703202329 57 Snaps the edge of a dragged object to the nearest snap line when you release the mouse. 9 703202331 69 Specifies whether to align the contour of the graphic object to the border of the nearest graphic object. 9 703207971 7c Specifies that graphic objects can only be rotated within the rotation angle that you selected in the When rotating control. 9 703202337 16b Specifies that a square is created based on the longer side of a rectangle when the Shift key is pressed before you release the mouse button. This also applies to an ellipse (a circle will be created based on the longest diameter of the ellipse). When the Extend edges box is not marked, a square or a circle will be created based on the shorter side or diameter. 11 .uno%3ASnapBorder 58 Specifies whether to align the contour of the graphic object to the nearest page margin. 5 59769 3a Defines the grid settings for creating and moving objects. 11 .uno%3ASnapPoints 69 Specifies whether to align the contour of the graphic object to the points of the nearest graphic object. 9 703202338 7c Specifies that graphic objects can only be rotated within the rotation angle that you selected in the When rotating control. 5 27155 58 Specifies whether to align the contour of the graphic object to the nearest page margin. 9 703202332 69 Specifies whether to align the contour of the graphic object to the points of the nearest graphic object. 9 703202330 58 Specifies whether to align the contour of the graphic object to the nearest page margin. 9 703207973 26 Defines the angle for point reduction. 5 27156 69 Specifies whether to align the contour of the graphic object to the border of the nearest graphic object. 9 703207966 cc Defines the snap distance between the mouse pointer and the object contour. $[officename] Impress snaps to a snap point if the mouse pointer is nearer than the distance selected in the Snap range control. 5 27157 69 Specifies whether to align the contour of the graphic object to the points of the nearest graphic object. 10 .uno%3ASnapFrame 69 Specifies whether to align the contour of the graphic object to the border of the nearest graphic object. 5 27152 57 Snaps the edge of a dragged object to the nearest snap line when you release the mouse. 9 703202336 79 Specifies that graphic objects are restricted vertically, horizontally or diagonally (45°) when creating or moving them. 13 .uno%3AHelplinesUse 57 Snaps the edge of a dragged object to the nearest snap line when you release the mouse. 9 545866245 34 Specifies that you want to print in original colors. 9 545866247 41 Specifies that you want to print the document in black and white. 9 545866244 44 Select the Brochure option to print the document in brochure format. 5 59768 43 Specifies print settings within a drawing or presentation document. 9 545866246 35 Specifies that you want to print colors as grayscale. 9 545866241 44 Specifies that you do not want to further scale pages when printing. 9 545866762 52 Determines that the paper tray to be used is the one defined in the printer setup. 9 545866242 89 Specifies whether to scale down objects that are beyond the margins of the current printer, so that they fit on the paper in the printer. 9 545866753 55 Specifies whether to print the pages that are currently hidden from the presentation. 9 545866765 2c Select Back to print the back of a brochure. 9 545866243 a8 Specifies that pages are to be printed in tiled format. If the pages or slides are smaller than the paper, several pages or slides will be printed on one page of paper. 9 545866756 2b Specifies wither to print the current time. 9 545866754 37 Specifies whether to print the page name of a document. 9 545866755 2c Specifies whether to print the current date. 9 545866764 2e Select Front to print the front of a brochure. 10 .uno%3AQuickEdit 5d Specifies whether to immediately switch to the text editing mode when clicking a text object. 12 .uno%3APickThrough 3e Specifies whether to select a text frame by clicking the text. 9 546685976 5d Specifies whether to immediately switch to the text editing mode when clicking a text object. 9 546685980 68 Specifies that $[officename] Impress calculates the paragraph spacing exactly like Microsoft PowerPoint. 9 546685958 64 Specifies whether to activate the Wizard when opening a presentation with File - New - Presentation. 5 59790 42 Defines the general options for drawing or presentation documents. 9 546691588 26 Defines the spacing between tab stops. 5 27158 5d Specifies whether to immediately switch to the text editing mode when clicking a text object. 9 546685973 70 Maintains relative alignment of Bézier points and 2D drawing objects to each other when you distort the object. 9 546685961 3e Specifies whether to select a text frame by clicking the text. 9 546685978 4e Specifies that you always want a presentation to start with the current slide. 9 546688513 35 Determines the Unit of measurement for presentations. 5 27159 3e Specifies whether to select a text frame by clicking the text. 9 546689053 2b Determines the drawing scale on the rulers. 9 546685965 69 Specifies whether to automatically create a copy when you move an object while holding down the Ctrl key. 9 546685971 a6 Specifies that you want to move an object with the Rotate tool enabled. If Object always moveable is not marked, the Rotate tool can only be used to rotate an object. 9 546685977 4d Specifies whether to use the cache for displaying objects on the master page. 17 .uno%3ASdGraphicOptions ae Defines the global settings for drawing documents, including the contents to be displayed, the scale to be used, the grid alignment and the contents to be printed by default. 5 10447 ae Defines the global settings for drawing documents, including the contents to be displayed, the scale to be used, the grid alignment and the contents to be printed by default. 14 .uno%3ASmEditOptions 97 Defines the print format and print options for all new formula documents. These options apply when you print a formula directly from %PRODUCTNAME Math. 5 10436 97 Defines the print format and print options for all new formula documents. These options apply when you print a formula directly from %PRODUCTNAME Math. 9 864666637 3a Applies a thin border to the formula area in the printout. 9 864666636 5f Specifies whether to include the contents of the Commands window at the bottom of the printout. 9 864672280 56 Reduces or enlarges the size of the printed formula by a specified enlargement factor. 9 864665600 3e Defines formula settings that will be valid for all documents. 9 864666134 3c Adjusts the formula to the page format used in the printout. 9 864666655 56 Specifies that these space wildcards will be removed if they are at the end of a line. 9 864666133 3b Prints the formula without adjusting the current font size. 5 33124 3e Defines formula settings that will be valid for all documents. 9 864666135 56 Reduces or enlarges the size of the printed formula by a specified enlargement factor. 9 864666635 53 Specifies whether you want the name of the document to be included in the printout. 35 SCH%3APUSHBUTTON%3ATP_DEF_COLOR%3APB_RESET_TO_DEFAULT 4d Restores the color settings that were defined when the program was installed. 9 705613314 36 Displays all the colors available for the data series. 32 SCH%3ALISTBOX%3ATP_DEF_COLOR%3ALB_CHART_COLOR_LIST 36 Displays all the colors available for the data series. 9 705614341 4d Restores the color settings that were defined when the program was installed. 9 809174018 11a Specifies that the original Microsoft Basic code contained in the document is held in a special internal memory for as long as the document remains loaded in $[officename]. When saving the document in Microsoft format the Microsoft Basic is saved again with it in an unchanged form. 9 809174020 bf The VBA (Visual Basic for Applications) code will be loaded ready to be executed. If this checkbox is not checked, the VBA code will be commented out so it can be inspected, but will not run. 9 809174019 bf The VBA (Visual Basic for Applications) code will be loaded ready to be executed. If this checkbox is not checked, the VBA code will be commented out so it can be inspected, but will not run. 9 809174017 d8 Loads and saves the Basic code from a Microsoft document as a special $[officename] Basic module with the document. The disabled Microsoft Basic code is visible in the $[officename] Basic IDE between Sub and End Sub. 5 35146 ad The List Box field displays the entries for the pair of OLE objects that can be converted when loading into $[officename] (L) and/or when saving into a Microsoft format (S). 9 810569224 4b Specifies the language used for the spellcheck function in Asian alphabets. 9 810569233 7b Specifies the locale setting of the country setting. This influences settings for numbering, currency and units of measure. 9 810569247 c3 Select the language used for the user interface, for example menus, dialogs, help files. You must have installed at least one additional language pack or a multi-language version of %PRODUCTNAME. 2f OFFMGR_CHECKBOX_OFA_TP_LANGUAGES_CB_CURRENT_DOC 5a Specifies that the settings for default languages are valid only for the current document. 2e OFFMGR_CHECKBOX_OFA_TP_LANGUAGES_CB_CTLSUPPORT 7c Activates complex text layout support. You can now modify the settings corresponding to complex text layout in %PRODUCTNAME. 2d OFFMGR_LISTBOX_OFA_TP_LANGUAGES_LB_ASIAN_LANG 4b Specifies the language used for the spellcheck function in Asian alphabets. 9 810566669 70 Activates Asian languages support. You can now modify the corresponding Asian language settings in %PRODUCTNAME. 9 810566684 7a Specifies to use the decimal separator key that is set in your system when you press the respective key on the number pad. 9 810566671 7c Activates complex text layout support. You can now modify the settings corresponding to complex text layout in %PRODUCTNAME. 2c OFFMGR_LISTBOX_OFA_TP_LANGUAGES_LB_WEST_LANG 4d Specifies the language used for the spellcheck function in western alphabets. 9 810566667 5a Specifies that the settings for default languages are valid only for the current document. 9 810569222 4d Specifies the language used for the spellcheck function in western alphabets. 9 810569235 5c Specifies the default currency that is used for the currency format and the currency fields. 30 OFFMGR_CHECKBOX_OFA_TP_LANGUAGES_CB_ASIANSUPPORT 70 Activates Asian languages support. You can now modify the corresponding Asian language settings in %PRODUCTNAME. 2f OFFMGR_LISTBOX_OFA_TP_LANGUAGES_LB_COMPLEX_LANG 3e Specifies the language for the complex text layout spellcheck. 9 810569226 3e Specifies the language for the complex text layout spellcheck. 2b OFFMGR_LISTBOX_OFA_TP_LANGUAGES_LB_CURRENCY 5c Specifies the default currency that is used for the currency format and the currency fields. 30 OFFMGR_LISTBOX_OFA_TP_LANGUAGES_LB_LOCALESETTING 7b Specifies the locale setting of the country setting. This influences settings for numbering, currency and units of measure. 9 704741895 3c Specifies that punctuation and Japanese Kana are compressed. 9 704741894 32 Specifies that only the punctuation is compressed. 9 704744972 4e Specifies the language for which you want to define first and last characters. 9 704741890 37 Specifies that kerning is only applied to western text. 9 704741893 30 Specifies that no compression at all will occur. 9 704741891 4d Specifies that kerning is applied to both western text and Asian punctuation. 9 704743440 4b Specifies the characters that should not appear alone at the end of a line. 9 704743438 51 Specifies the characters that should not appear alone at the beginning of a line. 9 704742409 75 When you mark Default, the following two text boxes are filled with the default characters for the selected language: 9 714474602 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search. 9 714474601 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search. 9 714474597 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search. 9 714474599 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search. 9 714474700 27 Specifies the characters to be ignored. 9 714474609 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search. 9 714474610 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search. 9 714474600 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search. 9 714474603 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search. 9 714474697 27 Specifies the characters to be ignored. 9 714474605 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search. 9 714474608 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search. 9 714474611 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search. 46 SVX_CHECKBOX_RID_SVXPAGE_JSEARCH_OPTIONS_CB_IGNORE_PROLONGED_SOUNDMARK 27 Specifies the characters to be ignored. 9 714474607 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search. 9 714474598 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search. 9 714474699 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search. 9 714474606 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search. 9 714474604 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search. 9 714474698 27 Specifies the characters to be ignored. 9 704843296 ac Selects the type of numerals used within text, text in objects, fields, and controls, in all %PRODUCTNAME modules. Only cell contents of %PRODUCTNAME Calc are not affected. 9 704840715 3b Enables sequence input checking for languages such as Thai. 9 704840214 b2 Pressing the Right Arrow key moves the text cursor toward the end of the current text. Pressing the Left Arrow key moves the text cursor toward the beginning of the current text. 9 704840215 9d Pressing the Right Arrow key moves the text cursor in the right-hand direction. Pressing the Left Arrow key moves the text cursor in the left-hand direction. 2e OFFMGR_CHECKBOX_OFA_TP_LANGUAGES_CB_SEQU_CHECK 3b Enables sequence input checking for languages such as Thai. 3c OFFMGR_CHECKBOX_RID_OFAPAGE_CONNPOOLOPTIONS_CB_DRIVERPOOLING 73 Select a driver from the list and mark the Enable pooling for this driver checkbox in order to pool its connection. 5 38947 34 Specifies whether the chosen connections are pooled. 9 809206786 34 Specifies whether the chosen connections are pooled. 39 OFFMGR_CHECKBOX_RID_OFAPAGE_CONNPOOLOPTIONS_CB_POOL_CONNS 34 Specifies whether the chosen connections are pooled. 3a OFFMGR_NUMERICFIELD_RID_OFAPAGE_CONNPOOLOPTIONS_NF_TIMEOUT 45 Defines the time in seconds after which a pooled connection is freed. 9 809206791 73 Select a driver from the list and mark the Enable pooling for this driver checkbox in order to pool its connection. 2a OFFMGR_TABPAGE_RID_OFAPAGE_CONNPOOLOPTIONS 34 Specifies whether the chosen connections are pooled. 9 809211913 45 Defines the time in seconds after which a pooled connection is freed. 9 809226766 3a Opens the Database Link dialog to edit the selected entry. 9 809226770 29 Removes the selected entry from the list. 5 35153 67 Lists the registered name and database file of all registered databases. Double-click an entry to edit. 9 809226765 35 Opens the Database Link dialog to create a new entry. a 1346111489 52 Enter a name for the database. %PRODUCTNAME uses this name to access the database. a 1346114049 3b Opens a file dialog where you can select the database file. 9 705659405 49 Click No, I do not wish to participate to disable the automatic feedback. 9 705659404 4c Click Yes, I am willing to participate … to enable the automatic feedback. 9 705663507 9d Click the button to show the currently collected data. This data will be sent next time, plus any data that gets collected until you end the current session. 5 39997 b7 Select the JRE that you want to use. On some systems, you must wait a minute until the list gets populated. On some systems, you must restart %PRODUCTNAME to use your changed setting. 9 704857099 34 Allows you to run Java applications in %PRODUCTNAME. 9 704860692 38 Add a path to the root folder of a JRE on your computer. 33 SVX_CHECKBOX_RID_SVXPAGE_INET_SCRIPTING_CB_J_ENABLE 34 Allows you to run Java applications in %PRODUCTNAME. 9 704860694 1c Opens the Class Path dialog. 9 704860693 27 Opens the Java Start Parameters dialog. a 1241764373 35 Select a folder and add the folder to the class path. a 1241764374 64 Select an archive or a folder in the list and click Remove to remove the object from the class path. a 1241763339 3f Specifies the location of Java classes or Java class libraries. 30 SVX_EDIT_RID_SVXPAGE_INET_SCRIPTING_ED_CLASSPATH 3f Specifies the location of Java classes or Java class libraries. a 1241764372 4f Select an archive file in jar or zip format and add the file to the class path. a 1241747980 31 Adds the current JRE start parameter to the list. a 1241747991 29 Deletes the selected JRE start parameter. a 1241745419 8e Enter a start parameter for a JRE as you would on a command line. Click Assign to add the parameter to the list of available start parameters. a 1241746965 72 Lists the assigned JRE start parameters. To remove a start parameter, select the parameter, and then click Remove. 9 553370116 e6 Trusted sources can be set on the Trusted Sources tab page. Signed macros from a trusted source are allowed to run. In addition, any macro from a trusted file location is allowed to run. All other macros require your confirmation. 9 553370115 bf Trusted sources can be set on the Trusted Sources tab page. Only signed macros from a trusted source are allowed to run. In addition, any macro from a trusted file location is allowed to run. 9 553370117 c5 A macro can be set to auto-start, and it can perform potentially damaging actions, as for example delete or rename files. This setting is not recommended when you open documents from other authors. 9 553370114 7c Trusted file locations can be set on the Trusted Sources tab page. Any macro from a trusted file location is allowed to run. 9 553390597 47 Removes the selected certificate from the list of trusted certificates. 9 553390602 44 Removes the selected folder from the list of trusted file locations. 9 553389576 5f Document macros are only executed if they have been opened from one of the following locations. 9 553390596 3f Opens the View Certificate dialog for the selected certificate. 9 553390601 5e Opens a folder selection dialog. Select a folder from which all macros are allowed to execute. 5 43078 1f Lists the trusted certificates. 9 879363086 39 When available, uses a secure connection to send e-mails. 9 879364107 1b Enter the SMTP server name. 9 879363078 64 Uses the e-mail address that you enter in the Reply address text box as the reply-to e-mail address. 22 sw_ListBox_TP_MAILCONFIG_LB_SECURE 39 When available, uses a secure connection to send e-mails. 9 879364099 10 Enter your name. 9 879368205 14 Enter the SMTP port. 9 879364101 26 Enter your e-mail address for replies. 9 879366677 44 Opens the Test Account Settings dialog to test the current settings. 9 879366672 72 Opens the Server Authentication dialog where you can specify the server authentication settings for secure e-mail. 9 879364104 2c Enter the address to use for e-mail replies. 9 705593869 43 A check will be performed once a week. This is the default setting. 9 705597967 1e A check will be performed now. 9 705593868 25 A check will be performed once a day. 9 705594379 82 Mark to check for online updates periodically, then select the time interval how often %PRODUCTNAME will check for online updates. 9 705593870 27 A check will be performed once a month. a 1427146812 28 Enter the user name for the IMAP server. a 1427145284 32 Specifies that the incoming mail server uses IMAP. a 1427150861 2a Enter the port on the POP3 or IMAP server. a 1427145283 33 Specifies that the incoming mail server uses POP 3. a 1427146816 13 Enter the password. a 1427146807 28 Enter the user name for the SMTP server. a 1427146809 25 Enter the password for the user name. a 1427146763 38 Enter the server name of your POP 3 or IMAP mail server. a 1427145778 43 Enables the authentication that is required to send e-mail by SMTP. a 1427145267 3d Select if your SMTP server requires a user name and password. a 1427145268 50 Select if you are required to first read your e-mail before you can send e-mail. a 1427132964 36 Click the Stop button to stop a test session manually. a 1427130914 68 In the Errors list box you can read an explanation of any errors encountered while testing the settings. 5 54980 41 In the top list box you will see the results of the test session. 5 43074 71 The Certificate Path page of the View Certificate dialog displays the location and the status of the certificate. 9 553339395 71 The Certificate Path page of the View Certificate dialog displays the location and the status of the certificate. 5 43080 71 The Certificate Path page of the View Certificate dialog displays the location and the status of the certificate. 5 43073 64 The Details page of the View Certificate dialog displays detailed information about the certificate. 9 553323010 45 Use the value list box to view values and copy them to the clipboard. 5 43079 64 The Details page of the View Certificate dialog displays detailed information about the certificate. 5 43072 61 The General page of the View Certificate dialog displays basic information about the certificate.